Samsung GH68 37463A User Manual

P O R T A B L E  
M O B I L E  
Q U A D - B A N D  
P H O N E  
User Manual  
Please read this manual before operating your  
phone and keep it for future reference.  
GH68-37463A Printed in Korea  
THE BREACH OF THE EXPRESS WARRANTY, INCLUDING INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES, OR LOSS OF ANTICIPATED PROFITS OR BENEFITS.  
SAMSUNG IS NOT LIABLE FOR PERFORMANCE ISSUES OR INCOMPATIBILITIES CAUSED BY YOUR EDITING  
OF REGISTRY SETTINGS, OR YOUR MODIFICATION OF OPERATING SYSTEM SOFTWARE.  
USING CUSTOM OPERATING SYSTEM SOFTWARE MAY CAUSE YOUR DEVICE AND APPLICATIONS TO WORK  
IMPROPERLY.  
Samsung Telecommunications America (STA), LLC  
Headquarters:  
1301 E. Lookout Drive  
Richardson, TX 75082  
Customer Care Center:  
1000 Klein Rd.  
Plano, TX 75074  
Toll Free Tel: 1.888.987.HELP (4357)  
Internet Address:  
©2012 Samsung Telecommunications America, LLC. Samsung is a registered trademark of Samsung  
Electronics Co., Ltd.  
Do you have questions about your Samsung Mobile Device?  
For 24 hour information and assistance, we offer a new FAQ/ARS System (Automated Response System)  
at:  
Nuance®, VSuite™, T9® Text Input, and the Nuance logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of  
Nuance Communications, Inc., or its affiliates in the United States and/or other countries.  
ACCESS® and NetFront™ are trademarks or registered trademarks of ACCESS Co., Ltd. in Japan and  
other countries.  
The Bluetooth® word mark, figure mark (stylized “B Design”), and combination mark (Bluetooth word  
mark and “B Design”) are registered trademarks and are wholly owned by the Bluetooth SIG.  
microSD™ and the microSD logo are Trademarks of the SD Card Association.  
Openwave® is a registered Trademark of Openwave, Inc.  
Google, the Google logo, Android, the Android logo, Android Market, Gmail, Google Mail, Google Maps,  
Google Music, Google Talk, Picasa, YouTube and other marks are trademarks of Google Inc.  
Wi-Fi is a registered trademark of the Wireless Fidelity Alliance, Inc.  
Swype and the Swype logos are trademarks of Swype, Inc. © 2010 Swype, Inc. All rights reserved.  
Dynamic Noise Suppression from Audience  
Your phone is equipped with an advanced voice processing chip that delivers clear mobile calls by  
suppressing background noise, intermittent sounds (like a siren or nearby conversation), and echoes,  
allowing you to hear and be heard nearly anywhere.  
How Does It Work?  
Based on the intelligence of the human hearing system, the technology:  
Captures, evaluates and distinguishes all the sound signals surrounding your phone, and the person you're  
speaking with.  
Then isolates the primary voice in conversation and filters out the background noise - so the person you're calling  
hears only your voice, without disturbing background noise.  
Dynamically equalizes and adjusts voice volume to optimize your calling experience, so you can hear clearly and  
don't need to speak louder to overcome surrounding noise.  
The noise suppression technology is built-in and already enabled in your new mobile phone. So it's ready to  
provide unsurpassed voice clarity with every call.  
Table of Contents  
Section 4: Call Functions and  
Retrieving your Google Account  
Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17  
Section 2: Understanding  
Your Phone ......................................20  
Contacts List ....................................52  
1
Adding more Contacts via Accounts  
and Sync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92  
Section 9: Applications and  
Development ..................................132  
2
Enable Downloading for Web  
Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171  
3
Samsung Mobile Products and  
Section 12: Changing Your  
Settings ..........................................183  
Section 13: Health and Safety  
Recycling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility (HAC)  
Regulations for Wireless Devices . 230  
Restricting Children's Access to  
Your Mobile Device . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
End User License Agreement for  
Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION TO  
Information ....................................213  
Exposure to Radio Frequency (RF)  
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213  
Specific Absorption Rate (SAR)  
Certification Information . . . . . . . . 217  
THIRD PARTIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252  
4
CHAT ROOMS AND OTHER  
PUBLIC AREAS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254  
ACCURACY OF THE INFORMATION WE  
COLLECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255  
Social Hub End User License  
Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255  
5
Section 1: Getting Started  
This section explains how to get started with  
your phone by installing and charging the  
battery, installing the SIM card and optional  
memory card, and setting up your voice mail.  
Note: Instructions in this manual are based on  
default settings, and may vary from your  
phone, depending on the software version  
on your phone, and any changes to the  
phone’s Settings.  
Before using your phone for the first time, you’ll  
need to install and charge the battery and install  
the SIM card. The SIM card is loaded with your  
subscription details, such as your PIN, available  
optional services, and many other features. If  
desired, you can also install an SD card to store  
media for use with your phone.  
Unless stated otherwise, instructions in this  
User Manual start with the phone unlocked,  
at the Home screen.  
All screen images in this manual are  
simulated. Actual displays may vary,  
depending on the software version of your  
phone and any changes to the phone’s  
Settings.  
Understanding this User  
Manual  
The sections of this manual generally follow the  
features of your phone. A robust index for  
Special Text  
Also included is important safety information that  
you should know before using your phone. This  
information is available near the back of the  
guide, beginning on page 213.  
Throughout this manual, you’ll find text that is  
set apart from the rest. These are intended to  
point out important information, share quick  
methods for activating features, to define terms,  
and more. The definitions for these methods are  
as follows:  
This manual provides navigation instructions  
according to the default display settings. If you  
select other settings, navigation may be  
different.  
Notes: Presents alternative options for the current  
feature, menu, or sub-menu.  
Unless otherwise specified, all instructions in this  
manual assume you are starting from the Home  
screen and using the available keys.  
Tips: Provides quick or innovative methods, or  
useful shortcuts.  
6
     
Important: Points out important information about  
the current feature that could affect performance.  
Warning: Brings to your attention important  
information to prevent loss of data or functionality,  
or even prevent damage to your phone.  
Battery Cover  
The battery, SIM card and SD card are installed  
under the battery cover.  
Important! Before removing or replacing the  
battery cover, make sure the phone is  
switched off. To turn the phone off,  
Text Conventions  
This manual provides condensed information  
about how to use your phone. To make this  
possible, the following text conventions are used  
to represent often-used steps:  
hold down the  
power-off image displays, then tap  
Power off  
key until the  
.
Caution! Do not bend or twist the back cover  
excessively during instllation or removal.  
Doing so may damage the cover.  
Arrows are used to represent the  
sequence of selecting successive  
options in longer, or repetitive,  
procedures.  
To remove the battery cover:  
1. Hold the device firmly and locate the cover  
release latch.  
Example: “From the Home screen, press  
Menu Settings Wireless and  
network Bluetooth settings  
(
)
2. Place your fingernail in the opening (1) and  
firmly “pop” the cover off the device  
(similar to a soda can) (2).  
.
3. Carefully remove the cover (3).  
Getting Started  
7
     
Release Latch  
To replace the battery cover:  
1. Align the cover tabs into their respective  
slots along the top of the battery  
compartment (1).  
2. Carefully slide the cover into the top of the  
phone (2).  
3. Press down on the back of the battery  
cover until you hear a click (3).  
4. Squeeze along the edges of the cover to  
guarantee a secure fit.  
8
 
To remove the SIM card:  
SIM Card Overview  
1. Remove the battery cover.  
2. Carefully place your fingernail into the end  
of the SIM slot and push the card slightly  
out.  
Important! Before removing or replacing the SIM  
card, make sure the phone is switched  
off. To turn the phone off, hold down  
the  
key until the power-off  
3. Carefully slide the SIM card out of the SIM  
card socket.  
image displays, then tap Power off  
.
The SIM card is loaded with your subscription  
details such as your telephone number, PIN,  
available optional services, and many other  
features.  
Note: If the card is not inserted correctly, the  
phone will not detect it and no service will  
be available. If this happens, turn off the  
phone, remove the card, and reinstall the  
card in the correct orientation.  
Important! The SIM card and its information can  
be easily damaged by scratching or  
bending, so be careful when handling,  
inserting, or removing the card. Keep  
all SIM cards out of reach of small  
children.  
Installing and Removing the SIM card  
To install the SIM card:  
1. Carefully slide the SIM card into the SIM  
card socket until the card clicks into place.  
2. Make sure that the card’s gold contacts  
face into the phone and that the upper-left  
angled corner of the card is positioned as  
shown.  
Correct  
Incorrect  
Getting Started  
9
     
Installing the microSD Memory Card  
Your phone supports an optional (external)  
microSD™ or microSDHC™ memory card for  
storage of media such as music, pictures, video  
and other files. The SD card is designed for use  
with this mobile phone and other devices.  
Note: The microSD memory cards include  
capacities of up to 2GB.  
microSDHC™ memory card types can  
range from 4GB to up to 32GB.  
Correct  
Note: This device supports up to a 32GB  
Incorrect  
microSDHC memory card.  
Removing the microSD Memory Card  
1. Remove the battery cover.  
1. Remove the battery cover.  
2. Locate the microSD card slot on the inside  
of the device.  
2. Firmly press the card into the slot and  
release it. The card should pop partially out  
of the slot.  
3. Orient the card with the gold strips facing  
down.  
3. Remove the card from the slot.  
4. Replace the battery cover.  
4. Firmly press the card into the slot and  
make sure that it catches with the push-  
click insertion. For more information on  
how to use the SD card see “Using the SD  
Important! Be sure to align the gold contact pins  
on the card with the phone’s contacts.  
10  
         
Battery  
Before using your phone for the first time, install  
the battery and charge it fully.  
Installing Battery  
Important! Before removing or replacing the  
battery, make sure the phone is  
switched off. To turn the phone off,  
hold down the  
power-off image displays, then tap  
Power off  
key until the  
.
Installing the Battery  
1. Slide the battery into the compartment (1)  
so that the tabs on the end align with the  
slots at the bottom of the phone, making  
sure the connectors align.  
2. Gently press down to secure the battery  
(2).  
Removing Battery  
Removing the Battery  
Grip the battery at the top end (3) and lift it  
up and out of the battery compartment (4).  
Charging the Battery  
Your phone is powered by a rechargeable Li-ion  
battery. A wall charger, which is used for  
charging the battery, is included with your  
phone. Use only approved batteries and  
chargers. Ask your local Samsung dealer for  
further details.  
Before using your phone for the first time, you  
must fully charge the battery. A discharged  
battery recharges fully in approximately 4 hours.  
Getting Started  
11  
           
Note: Verify that the battery is installed prior to  
connecting the wall charger. If both the wall  
charger is connected and the battery is not  
installed, the handset will power cycle  
continuously and prevent proper operation.  
Failure to unplug the wall charger before  
you remove the battery, can cause the  
phone to become damaged.  
Important! It is recommended you fully charge the  
battery before using your device for  
the first time.  
Correct  
1. Locate the Charger/Accessory jack and  
slide open the cover (1).  
Incorrect  
2. Insert the USB cable into the device’s  
Charger/Accessory jack (2).  
Note: This illustration displays both the correct  
and incorrect orientation for connecting the  
charger. If the charger is incorrectly  
connected, damage to the accessory port  
will occur therefore voiding the phone’s  
warranty.  
3. Plug the charging head into a standard AC  
power outlet. The device turns on with the  
screen locked and indicates both its  
charge state and percent of charge.  
4. When charging is finished, first unplug the  
charger’s power plug from the AC wall  
outlet, then disconnect the charger’s  
connector from the phone.  
12  
Deactivate the GPS when not needed. Most  
applications using this function will periodically  
query the GPS satellites for your current location;  
each query drains your battery.  
Important! If your handset has a touch screen  
display, please note that a touch  
screen responds best to a light touch  
from the pad of your finger or a non-  
metallic stylus. Using excessive force  
or a metallic object when pressing on  
the touch screen may damage the  
tempered glass surface and void the  
Do not wait until your battery is completely depleted  
before charging your device. Repeating this process  
of a complete discharge and recharge can over time  
reduce the storage capacity of any battery.  
Turn off Automatic application sync.  
Use the Power Savings Widget to deactivate  
hardware functions such as Wi-Fi, Bluetooth, GPS,  
Synchronization, or LCD brightness setting.  
Check the Battery use screen to review what  
features or functions have been consuming your  
battery resources.  
Low Battery Indicator  
When the battery level is low and only a few  
minutes of talk time remain, a warning tone  
sounds and the “Low battery” message repeats  
at regular intervals on the display. In this  
condition, your phone conserves its remaining  
battery power, by dimming the backlight.  
Check the Running Services and close any  
unnecessary applications.  
Use the Task Manager feature to end/shutdown  
background applications that are still running.  
These minimized applications can, over time, cause  
your device to “slow down”.  
When the battery level becomes too low, the  
phone automatically turns off.  
Extending Your Battery Life  
Active applications, light levels, Bluetooth usage,  
and GPS functionality all act to drain your  
battery. The following is a list of helpful tips that  
can help conserve your battery power:  
Turn off any streaming services after use (see  
Running Services).  
Animated wallpapers use processing power,  
memory, and more power. Change your Live  
Wallpaper to a non-animated Wallpaper gallery or  
Gallery image.  
Reduce your backlight on time.  
Turn Bluetooth off when not in use.  
Turn Wi-Fi off when not in use.  
Getting Started  
13  
       
Power Savings  
Note: A green bar displayed beneath the icon  
means the application is active (turned on).  
The green bar is removed from beneath the  
icon when the feature is deactivated (turned  
off).  
Active applications, Wi-Fi, Bluetooth, GPS,  
Synchronization, Location consent, or the LCD  
Brightness functionality all act to drain your  
battery.  
The Power Savings application was designed to  
quickly activate (turn on), or deactivate (turn off)  
those functions or applications that use the most  
battery power.  
1. From the  
Home screen,  
touch and  
Initial Phone Configuration  
1. Tap the on-screen Android icon to begin  
the setup process.  
2. Tap Skip to ignore the Wi-Fi connection  
setup process.  
3. Select/deselect the desired Google location  
hold an empty  
area until the  
Add to Home  
screen menu  
displays.  
services and tap Next  
4. Configure the Data and Time settings and  
tap Next  
.
.
Note: Enabling Google location services can drain  
2. Tap Widgets  
Power  
savings. The  
Power Control  
5. Press and hold  
until the Phone  
shortcut is  
options screen appears.  
added to the current screen.  
3. Tap any of the icons on the Power Savings  
shortcut bar to activate/deactivate the  
feature.  
6. Tap Power off  
(
).  
14  
               
Switching the Phone On or Off  
If you have not already configured your phone  
after an initial firmware update, you will be  
prompted with a series of configuration screens.  
Locking and Unlocking the  
Phone  
By default, the phone screen locks when the  
backlight turns off.  
Once the phone has been configured, you will  
not be prompted with these screens again.  
Place your finger on the screen and swipe  
the glass in any of the directions shown  
unlock the phone.  
Important! Before the initial configuration, you  
quickly access emergency services by  
tapping Emergency call and using the  
on-screen dialer.  
1. Press and hold  
until the phone  
switches on.  
The phone searches for your network and  
after finding it, you can make or receive  
calls.  
Note: The display language is preset to English at  
the factory. To change the language, use the  
2. Press and hold  
until the Phone  
options screen appears.  
3. Tap Power Off  
(
).  
Getting Started  
15  
           
Note: You can choose to configure lock settings to  
prevent unauthorized use of your phone. For  
Note: If you already have a Google account, you  
only need to sign in.  
To create a new Google Account from the Web:  
1. From a computer, launch a Web browser  
Creating a New Google  
Account  
and navigate to www.google.com  
.
2. On the main page, click Sign-in  
Create  
You should create a GoogleAccount when you  
first use your device in order to fully utilize the  
functionality. This account provides access to  
several device features such as Gmail, Google  
Maps, Google Search, and the Android Market  
applications. Before you are able to access  
Google applications, you must enter your  
account information. These applications sync  
between your device and your online Google  
account.  
an account now  
.
3. Follow the on-screen prompts to create  
your free account.  
4. Look for an email from Google in the email  
box you provided, and respond to the email  
to confirm and activate your new account.  
Signing into Your Google  
Account  
1. Launch an application that requires a  
Google account (such as Android Market or  
Gmail).  
To create a new Google Account from your phone:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Market).  
2. Read the introduction and tap Next  
2. Click Next  
Sign in.  
Create to begin.  
3. Tap the Username and Password fields and  
enter your information.  
3. Follow the on-screen instructions to create  
a Google Account.  
– or –  
4. Tap Sign in. Your device communicates  
with the Google servers to confirm your  
information.  
If this is not the first time you are starting  
the phone, tap  
(Gmail).  
5. If prompted, create a new Gmail username  
by entering a prefix for your @gmail.com  
email address.  
16  
       
Retrieving your Google  
Account Password  
Note: Voicemail setup may be different depending  
on your network.  
A Google account password is required for  
Google applications. If you misplace or forget  
your Google Account password, follow these  
instructions to retrieve it:  
1. From your computer, use an Internet  
browser and navigate to http://google.com/  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
and then  
touch and hold the  
key until the  
1
phone dials voice mail. You may be  
prompted to enter a password.  
2. Follow the tutorial to create a password, a  
greeting, and a display name.  
2. Click on the Can’t access your account?  
link.  
Accessing Your Voice Mail  
You can access your Voice Mail by either  
3. Enter your full Gmail address and click  
Submit. Follow the password recovery  
procedure.  
pressing and holding  
on the keypad, or by  
1
using the phone’s Application icon, then touching  
the Voice Mail application.  
Voice Mail  
To access Voice Mail using the menu:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
and then  
Setting Up Your Voice Mail  
touch and hold  
voice mail.  
until the phone dials  
1
Your device automatically transfers all  
unanswered calls to voicemail, even if your  
device is in use or turned off. As soon as your  
battery is charged and the SIM card inserted,  
activate your voicemail account.  
1
Note: Touching and holding  
will launch  
Visual voicemail if it is already active on  
your phone.  
Important! Always use a password to protect  
2. When connected, follow the voice prompts  
against unauthorized access.  
from the voice mail center.  
For new users, follow the instructions below to  
set up voice mail:  
Getting Started  
17  
           
Accessing Your Voice Mail From  
Another Phone  
1. Dial your wireless phone number.  
2. When you hear your voicemail greeting,  
press the asterisk key on the phone you  
are using.  
Task Manager  
Your phone can run applications simultaneously,  
with some applications running in the  
background.  
Sometimes your device might seem to slow  
down over time, and the biggest reason for this  
are background applications. These are  
applications that were not properly closed or  
shutdown and are still active but minimized. The  
Task Manager not only lets you see which of  
these applications are still active in the  
background but also easily lets you choose  
which applications are left running and which  
are closed.  
3. Enter your passcode.  
Visual Voicemail  
Visual Voicemail enables users to view a list of  
people who left a voicemail message, and listen  
to the any message they want without being  
limited to chronological order.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) Visual Voicemail  
(
).  
Note: The larger the number of applications  
running on your phone, the larger the  
energy drain on your battery.  
2. Read the on-screen information and tap  
Next.  
3. Enter your new PIN code and tap Next to  
activate Visual Voicemail if this is the first  
time it was accessed. A list of the  
voicemail messages displays.  
Task Manger Overview  
From the Home screen, tap  
(Applications) Task manager  
(
).  
– or –  
Note: You must subscribe to Visual Voicemail  
service to use this feature. Charges may  
apply. Please contact your service provider  
for further details.  
Press and hold  
manager. This screen contains the  
following tabs:  
then tap Task  
• Active applications display those currently  
active applications running on your phone.  
4. Tap an on-screen voicemail message to  
play it back.  
18  
       
• Downloaded displays any installed packages or  
applications from the Market that are taking up  
memory space. Tap Uninstall to remove them  
from your phone.  
• RAM, which displays the amount of current RAM  
(Random Access Memory) currently being used  
and allow you to Clear Memory for either Level  
1 or Level 2 (both Level memory locations).  
• Storage displays a visual graph indicating the  
available and used space within the Random  
Access Memory (RAM), Program, and External  
SD card.  
• Help provides additional battery saving  
techniques.  
Shutting Down an Currently Active  
Application  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
manager ).  
Task  
(
2. From the Active applications tab, tap Exit to  
close selected applications or tap Exit all to  
close all background running applications.  
Getting Started  
19  
Section 2: Understanding Your Phone  
®
This section outlines key features of your phone.  
It also describes the phone’s keys, screen and  
the icons that display when the phone is in use.  
Pre-loaded Games including Bejeweled 2 and  
®
Tetris  
Over 250,000 Apps available to download from the  
Android Market™  
Features of Your Phone  
®
Your phone is lightweight, easy-to-use and offers  
many significant features. The following list  
outlines a few of the features included in your  
phone.  
Pre-loaded e-reader applications such as: Blio and  
®
Zinio  
Social Networking capabilities  
®
Polaris Office for document viewing and editing  
Touch screen with virtual (on-screen) QWERTY  
keyboard  
Assisted GPS (TeleNav GPS Navigation)  
Webkit-based browser  
High Speed Packet Access Plus (HSPA+) delivering  
data speeds faster than the current 3G network  
technology.  
Downloadable applications from Android Market  
Up to 32GB expandable memory slot  
Front Facing camera for Video Chat  
Mobile Hotspot Capability  
Android 2.3, Gingerbread Platform  
®
®
Compatible with Adobe Flash technology  
®
®
Lookout Anti-Virus (Security, Backup, Missing  
Wi-Fi Capability  
Device capabilities)  
USB Tethering-capable  
®
T-Mobile TV HD  
Bluetooth enabled  
®
Slacker Radio  
Full Integration of Google Mobile™ Services (Gmail,  
YouTube, Google Maps, Google Voice Search)  
Multiple Messaging Options: Text/Picture/Video  
Messaging, Google Talk, and SWYPE™  
Corporate and Personal Email  
Wi-Fi Calling  
3 Megapixel Camera and Camcorder with autofocus  
and multi-shot  
MP3 Player with multitasking features  
20  
       
While talking on the phone, the sensor detects  
talk activity and locks the keypad to prevent  
accidental key presses.  
Front View  
The following illustrations show the main  
elements of your phone:  
2. microSD Card Slot (internal) allows you use  
a microSD card to expand the memory of  
your phone.  
14  
13 12  
1
11  
10  
9
3.  
Volume key allows you to adjust the ringer  
volume in standby mode (with the phone  
open) or adjust the voice volume during a  
2
3
When receiving an incoming call:  
call.  
Pressing the volume key down mutes the ring  
tone.  
Pressing and holding the volume key rejects the  
call.  
4. Menu key displays a list of options  
available for the current screen. From the  
Home screen it displays Add, Wallpaper,  
Search, Notifications, Edit, and Settings  
options.  
8
7
4
5. Home key displays the Home screen when  
pressed. Touch and hold to display the  
Task manager.  
5
6
The following list correlates to the illustrations.  
1. Proximity Sensor detects how close an  
object is to the surface of the screen. This  
is typically used to detect when your face  
is pressed up against the screen, such as  
during a phone call.  
6.  
during phone calls and  
Microphone is used  
allows other callers to hear you clearly  
when you are speaking to them. It is also  
used to make voice note recordings.  
Understanding Your Phone  
21  
   
7. Quick search is used to search the device  
for applications, contact information, or  
searches the internet for information.  
8. Back key redisplays the previous screen or  
clears entries.  
13. Receiver allows you to hear the other caller  
and the different ring tones or sounds  
offered by your phone.  
14. Headset jack allows you to connect a  
hands-free headset so you can listen to  
music.  
9. Display shows all the information needed  
to operate your phone, such as the  
connection status, received signal  
strength, phone battery level, and time.  
10. Power/Reset/Lock key turns the device off  
(press and hold). Resets the device if it  
ever freezes (press and hold for  
Back View of Your Phone  
The following illustration shows the external  
elements of your phone:  
15-17 seconds). Access the Phone options  
menu (press and hold) to turn on/off Silent  
mode, Flight mode, or power off the  
device.  
11. Front Facing Camera allows you to take  
pictures while facing the screen and  
allows you to video conference.  
1
2
3
1. External speaker allows you to hear  
Note: Video recorded in Portrait mode is reversed  
ringers, music, and other sounds offered  
by your phone.  
during playback.  
2. Flash is used to take photos in lo-light  
conditions.  
12. USB Power/Accessory connector allows you  
to connect a power cable or optional  
3. Camera lens is used to take photos.  
accessories such as a USB/data cable.  
22  
       
Display settings  
Phone Display  
In this menu, you can change various settings for  
the for the wallpaper, cube, brightness or  
backlight.  
Your phone’s display provides information about  
the phone’s status, and is the interface to the  
features of your phone. The display indicates  
your connection status, signal strength, battery  
status and time. Icons display at the top of the  
phone when an incoming call or message is  
received and also alerts you at a specified time  
when an alarm was set.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Settings) ➔  
(
(
Status Bar  
The screen also displays notifications, and  
Application (or shortcut) bar with four icons:  
Phone, Contacts, Messaging, and Applications.  
The Status Bar shows information about the  
connection status, signal strength, phone battery  
level, and time, and displays notifications about  
incoming messages, calls and other actions.  
Signal strength  
Battery status  
Connection Status  
This list identifies the icons you see on your  
phone’s display screen:  
Status Bar  
Indicator Icons  
This list identifies the symbols you’ll see on your  
Time  
Google  
Search  
phone’s display and Indicator area:  
Notification  
area  
Displays your current signal strength.  
The greater the number of bars, the  
stronger the signal.  
Status  
area  
Home  
Screen  
Shortcuts  
IndicatesthattheFlightModeisactive.  
You cannot send or receive any calls or  
access online information.  
Indicates there is no signal available.  
Primary Shortcuts  
Understanding Your Phone  
23  
                 
Displays when there is no SIM card in  
the phone.  
Displays your current battery charge  
level. Icon shown is fully charged.  
Displays when there is a system error  
or alert.  
Displays your current battery is 100  
percent charged. This icon is followed  
by an audible beep.  
100%  
Displays when a call is in progress.  
Displays your battery is currently  
charging.  
Displays when a call is on hold.  
Displays your current battery charge  
level is very low.  
Displays when you have missed an  
incoming call.  
Shows your current battery only has  
threepercentpowerremainingandwill  
immediately shutdown. Represented  
as a blinking icon.  
Displays when the Auto reject mode  
feature is enabled and set to All  
numbers.  
A
Displays when connected to the EDGE  
network.  
Displayswhenyouhavereceivedacall  
from an unknown caller and the T-  
Mobile Name ID service is asking to  
name the contact.  
Displays when your phone is  
communicating with the EDGE  
network.  
Displayswhenthespeakerphoneison.  
Displays when connected to the 3G  
network.  
Displays when the microphone is  
muted.  
Displays when your phone is  
communicating with the 3G network.  
DisplayswhenconnectedtotheHSPA+  
network.  
Displays whenCall forwarding is set to  
Displays when your phone is  
communicating with the HSPA+  
network.  
24  
Displays when the phone is connected  
to a computer using a supported USB  
cable connection.  
Displays when the phone is in Silent  
mode.  
Allsoundsexceptmediaandalarmsare  
silenced,andVibratemodeissettoOnly  
Displays when there is a new text  
message.  
when not in silent mode  
.
Displays when an outgoing text  
message has failed to be delivered.  
Displays when the Sound profile is set  
to Silent mode and Vibrate is set to  
Always or Only in silent mode.  
Displayswhenthereisanewvoicemail  
message.  
Displays when there is a new visual  
voicemail message.  
Displays when data synchronization  
and application sync is active and  
synchronization is in progress  
Displays in the notifications window  
when there is a new Email message.  
for Gmail, Calendar, and Contacts.  
DisplayswhenBluetoothtechnologyis  
active and enabled.  
Displays in the notifications window  
when there is a new Gmail message.  
Displays when the Bluetooth  
technology is active and  
communicating with an external  
device.  
Displays when the time and date for a  
Calendar Event has arrived. For more  
Displays when the an outbound file  
transfer is in progress.  
Displays when an alarm is set.  
Displays when Wi-Fi is connected,  
active, and communicating with a  
Wireless Access Point (WAP).  
DisplayswhenWi-Fiisactiveandthere  
is an available open wireless network.  
Understanding Your Phone  
25  
DisplayswhentheWi-Ficallingfeature  
is active.  
Displays when the external SD card  
(internal microSD) has been  
disconnected (unmounted) from the  
phone and is now ready for either  
removal or formatting.  
DisplayswhentheWi-Ficallingfeature  
is in use and a call is currently active.  
Displays when the Portable Wi-Fi  
Hotspot feature is active and  
Displays when the contents of the  
microSD card are being scanned.  
Displays when the External SD card is  
being prepared for mounting to the  
device. This is required for  
communication with the External SD  
card.  
Displays when the USB Tethering  
feature is active and communicating.  
Displays when the phone’s microSD  
card has been improperly removed.  
Displays when your phone is  
connected to a PC using Kies air.  
Displayswhenthe phonehasdetected  
an active USB connection and is in a  
USB Debugging mode.  
Displays when your phone is  
connected to a Digital Living Network  
Alliance (DLNA) certified device using  
the AllShare application.  
Displays when Power saving mode is  
enabled.  
Displays in the notifications window  
when a song is currently playing.  
Displays when the Power saving alert  
notificationhasbeenactivated.Youare  
then prompted to view your current  
battery level.  
Displays when your phone’s GPS is on  
and communicating.  
For more details on configuring your phone’s  
26  
Clearing Notifications  
Notification Bar  
1. Tap the status bar to reveal the  
Notifications tab, and then drag the tab to  
the bottom of the screen to open the  
Notifications panel  
The Notification area indicates new message  
events (data sync status, new messages,  
calendar events, call status, etc). You can expand  
this area to provide more detailed information  
about the current on-screen notification icons.  
1. Tap the Status bar to reveal the  
2. Tap Clear. The notifications are cleared  
from the panel.  
Notifications tab, and then drag the tab to  
the bottom of the screen to open the  
Notifications panel (1).  
Accessing Additional Panel Functions  
In addition to notifications, this panel also  
provides quick and ready access to five device  
functions. These can be quickly activated or  
deactivated.  
2. Tap a notification entry to open the  
associated application (2).  
The following functions can either be activated  
(green) or deactivated (white): Wi-Fi  
,
BT  
(Bluetooth), GPS Silent mode, or Auto rotation  
,
.
Note: The Notifications panel can also be opened  
on the Home screen by pressing  
then tapping Notifications  
and  
.
Understanding Your Phone  
27  
   
Wallpaper  
(
) lets you to customize the current  
Note: Vibration mode is available after pressing  
the Volume key down.  
screen’s wallpaper image by choosing from either  
Gallery, Live Wallpaper or Wallpaper gallery).  
Silent mode (no vibration) is only available if  
You can obtain images from either your Pictures  
folder, from any of the available images within the  
device’s Wallpaper gallery, or from the animated  
Live Wallpapers.  
the Vibration setting (Settings  
settings Vibration) is set to Only when not  
in Silent mode  
>
Sound  
>
.
Search  
you can use to search for a key term online.  
Notifications ) allows you to expand popup  
notifications area to provide more detailed  
information about the current on-screen notification  
icons.  
(
) displays the Google Search box that  
Function Keys  
Your phone comes equipped with four main  
function keys that can be used on any screen:  
(
Home Menu, Back and Search.  
,
Home Key  
The Home key (  
) takes you back to your  
Edit  
(
) allows you to add or remove extended  
Home screen (#4 of the 7 available screens).  
screens from your device. You can have up to six  
extended screens (one Home screen and six  
Extended screens).  
Press and hold to launch the Recent apps/  
Task manager screen. For more  
Settings  
device’s settings menu.  
The Settings menu can also be accessed by  
pressing and then tapping  
Settings  
(
) provides quick access to the  
Menu Key  
The Menu key (  
) activates an available menu  
function for the current screen or application.  
When on the Home screen, the following menu  
options are available:  
.
Back Key  
The Back key (  
active screen. If the on-screen keyboard is  
currently open, this key closes the keyboard.  
) returns you to the previously  
Add  
(
) adds one of the following functions to a  
selected screen: Widgets, Shortcuts, Folders, and  
Wallpapers.  
28  
   
Notification area displays those icons associated  
with end-user notifications such as: email  
messages, calls (missed, call in progress), new  
voicemail, upcoming event, USB connection, emails,  
and Text/MMS messages.  
Search Key  
The Search key (  
Search box that can be used to search for a key  
term online.  
) displays the Google  
Home Screen  
These notifications appear at the top-left of the  
screen (within the Status bar area) and display  
important user information.  
The Home screen is the starting point for using  
the applications on your phone. There are initially  
five available panels, each populated with  
default shortcuts or applications. You can  
customize each of these panels.  
This information can be accessed by either  
swiping down from the Status bar (page 27) or by  
accessing the Notifications panel [  
Notifications )].  
>
Signal strength  
(
Connection Status  
Status Bar  
Battery status  
Status area displays those icons associated with  
the status of the device such as communication,  
coverage, Bluetooth, 4G/3G, Wi-Fi communication,  
battery levels, GPS, etc.  
Time  
Google  
Search  
Home Screen is a customizable screen that  
provides information about notifications and device  
status, and allows access to application Widgets.  
Extended Home Screens extend beyond the  
current visible screen width to provide more space  
for adding icons, widgets, and other customization  
features.  
Notification  
area  
Status  
area  
Home  
Screen  
Shortcuts  
There are six available extended screens (panels)  
each of which may be populated with its own  
shortcuts or widgets. These screens share the  
use of the three Primary Shortcuts.  
Primary Shortcuts  
Understanding Your Phone  
29  
         
The current screen is indicated at the bottom by a  
larger circle. Up to seven (7) total screens are  
available.  
Primary Shortcuts: are four shortcuts present  
throughout all of the available screens and can be  
used to both navigate within the device or launch  
any of the following functions:  
Note: Both the status bar and primary shortcuts  
Phone  
functions (Keypad, Logs, Favorites, and Groups).  
Contacts ) launches the Contacts-related  
(
) launches the phone-related screen  
are visible across all screens.  
(
Google search is an on-screen Internet search  
engine powered by Google™. Touch to access the  
Voice Search feature where you can verbally enter a  
search term and initiate an online search.  
screens (Keypad, Logs, Contacts, Favorites, and  
Groups).  
Messaging  
(
) launches the Messaging  
Tap Voice Search  
(
) to launch the Voice  
menu (create new messages or open an existing  
message string).  
Search function from within this Google widget.  
Widgets are self-contained on-screen applications  
(not shortcuts). These can be placed onto any of the  
available screens (Home or extended).  
Applications/Home toggles functionality  
between the Home and Application screens.  
Tap  
(Applications) to access the  
Shortcuts are icons that launch available device  
applications such as Camera, YouTube, Voicemail,  
Contacts, Phone, Email, Market, etc. These function  
the same as shortcuts on your computer.  
Application screens loaded with every available  
local application.  
While in the Applications screens, tap  
Although some may already be found on the  
Extended Home screens, the majority can also be  
found within the Applications screens.  
(
Home) to easily return to the Home screen.  
As you transition from screen to screen, the  
screen counter (located at the bottom) displays  
the current panel number in a circle.  
The Application screens can be accessed by  
tapping  
(Applications) from the Primary  
shortcuts area.  
Shortcuts can be removed from a screen and  
added back any number of times.  
30  
   
Navigating Through the Screens  
The following terms describe the most common  
hardware and on-screen actions.  
Press and hold  
Tap  
Touch and hold  
Widget  
Counter displays  
the currently  
active screen  
Press and hold: Pressing relates to use of the  
hardware keys and buttons to select or activate an  
item. For example: press the Navigation key to scroll  
through a menu. Some buttons and keys require you  
to press and hold them to activate a feature, for  
example, you press the Lock key to lock and unlock  
the phone.  
Screen Navigation  
Using the touch screen display and the keys, you  
can navigate the features of your phone and  
enter characters. The following conventions are  
used in this manual to describe the navigation  
action in the procedures.  
Tap: Use a brief touch to select items on the display  
or to enter text on the virtual QWERTY keyboard. For  
example: touch an Application icon to open the  
application. A light touch works best.  
Understanding Your Phone  
31  
     
Touch and hold: Touch and hold an icon or key to  
open the available options, or to access a pop-up  
menu. For example: press and hold from the Home  
screen to access a menu of customization options.  
Flick: Move your finger in lighter, quicker strokes  
than swiping. This finger gesture is always used in a  
vertical motion, such as when flicking through  
contacts or a message list.  
Flick  
Swipe or slide and Drag  
Swipe or slide: Quickly drag your finger vertically  
or horizontally across the screen. This allows you to  
move the area of focus or to scroll through a list. For  
example: slide your finger left or right on the Home  
screen to scroll among the seven panels.  
Drag: Press and hold your finger with some  
pressure before you start to move it. Do not release  
your finger until you have reached the target  
position.  
Rotate  
Rotate: Automatically change the screen orientation  
from portrait to landscape by turning the device  
sideways. For example: rotate to landscape  
orientation when entering text, to provide a larger  
keyboard, or when viewing web content to minimize  
scrolling.  
Pinch: “Pinch” the screen using your thumb and  
forefinger to zoom out when viewing a picture or a  
Web page. (Move fingers inward to zoom out.)  
32  
Spread: “Spread” the screen using your thumb and  
forefinger to zoom in when viewing a picture or a  
Web page. (Move fingers outward to zoom in.)  
Note: Motion must be enabled for this feature to  
Pinch (Zoom Out)  
Menu Navigation  
You can tailor the phone’s range of functions to  
fit your needs using both menus and  
applications. Menus, sub-menus, and features  
are accessed by scrolling through the available  
on-screen menus. Your phone defaults with  
seven home screens.  
Navigating Through the Application  
Menus  
There are four default Application Menus  
available. As you add more applications from the  
Android Marketplace, more screens are created  
to house these new apps.  
Spread (Zoom In)  
1. Press  
Applications). The first Application Menu  
displays.  
To close the Applications screen, tap  
press  
and then tap  
Note: These screens can be re-arranged in any  
(
or  
.
Motion Navigation and Activation: The phone  
comes equipped with the ability to assign specific  
functions to certain phone actions that are detected  
by the accelerometer.  
2. Sweep the screen to access the other  
menus.  
3. Tap any of the on-screen icons to launch  
the associated application.  
Understanding Your Phone  
33  
   
Using Sub-Menus  
Sub-menus are available from within most  
screen and applications.  
1. Press  
. A sub-menu displays at the  
bottom of the phone screen.  
2. Tap an option.  
Context Menu  
Sub-Menu items  
Accessing Recently-Used  
Applications  
1. Press and hold  
to open the recently-  
used applications window.  
Note: This recent applications screen also  
provides access to the Task manager  
.
Using Context Menus  
2. A pop-up displays the six most recently  
used applications.  
Context menus (also called pop-up menus)  
contain options that apply to a specific item on  
the screen. They function similarly to menu  
options that appear when you right click your  
mouse on your desktop computer.  
3. Tap an icon to open the recent application.  
Touch and hold an item on-screen to open  
its context menu.  
34  
         
Applications  
Accounts and sync  
The Application menu provides quick access to  
the most frequently used applications.  
Applications display on each of the four panels  
on the Applications screens.  
Allows you to add applications and  
determine which type of account  
information you want to synchronize  
with your Contact list. For more  
Note: Some applications might be updated after  
connection. This would require a user to  
follow the on-screen instructions to update  
the related application icon and features.  
AllShare  
Allowsyoutoshareyouron-devicemedia  
contentwith otherexternal devices using  
DLNA (Digital Living Network Alliance)  
and built-in AllShare™ technology.  
Samsung’s AllShare makes staying  
connected easy.  
The following table contains a description of  
each application available via both the Primary  
shortcuts area and via the Applications screens.  
If the application is already described in another  
section of this user manual, then a cross  
reference to that particular section is provided.  
For information on navigating through the  
Applications icons, see “Navigating Through the  
Application Menus” on page 33  
Bejeweled 2  
Bejeweled 2 is a free web-based game,  
sequeltoBejeweled.Startbyclickingtwo  
adjacentpiecestocreatealineofthreeor  
more identical gems. For more  
411 & More  
Providesmorethanjustsingletapaccess  
to directory assistance and other portals.  
Available categories include: 411  
Directory Assistance, Current Weather,  
and more.  
Understanding Your Phone  
35  
           
Blio®  
Calendar  
Blio is an eReading application that  
presents eBooks just like the printed  
version, in full color, and with all of the  
features you’d want from an eReader.  
Launches a calendar application that  
syncs to your Facebook™, Google™, or  
Microsoft Exchange work calendars.  
Camera  
Bonus Apps  
Launches the built-in 3.0 megapixel  
camera application from where you can  
take a picture with either the front or rear  
facing cameras.  
Once added to your Home screen, this  
Widget helps you discover free T-Mobile  
services and apps that are compatible  
with your phone.  
Note: An SD card must be inserted  
before the camera will take and  
store photos.  
Books  
Use Google Books to read over 3 million  
ebooks on the go.  
In addition to taking photos, the built-in  
cameraalso doublesasacamcorder that  
also allows you to record, view, and send  
high definition videos.  
Calculator  
Launches the on-screen calculator  
application. The calculator provides the  
basic arithmetic functions; addition,  
subtraction, multiplication, and division.  
You can also use this as a scientific  
calculator.  
36  
           
Contacts  
Files  
The default storage location for saving  
phone numbers to your Contacts List is  
your phone’s built-in memory.  
Lets you view supported image files and  
text files on your microSD card. Organize  
and store data, images, and more in your  
own personal file folders. Files are stored  
to the memory card in separate (user  
defined) folders.  
Clock  
Allows you to set an alarm, configure and  
viewtheWorldclock, useastopwatch, or  
set a timer. The applications display in a  
tabularformatandquicklyaccessedwith  
the touch of a finger.  
Gallery  
Displays a Gallery of camera images and  
video stored in the microSD card. For  
Gmail  
Downloads  
Provides access to your Gmail account.  
GoogleMail(Gmail)isaweb-basedemail  
service. Gmail is configured when you  
first set up your phone. For more  
Provides quick access to tabs containing  
a list of your current downloaded files  
(Internet and Other).  
Email  
Google Search  
Provides access to both your Outlook  
(ExchangeServer-based)workemailand  
Internet email accounts (such as Gmail  
and Yahoo! Mail). For more information,  
Provides an on-screen Internet search  
engine powered by Google™.  
Understanding Your Phone  
37  
               
Highlight  
Latitude  
This downloadable application/widget  
allows you to stay up to date on relevant  
news, Android Market apps and games  
(specific to your phone), T-Mobile  
ringtones, CallerTunes and more. For  
Lets you see your friends’ locations and  
share yours with them. The application  
alsoletsyouseeyourfriendslocationson  
a map or in a list. It also lets you send  
instant messages and emails, make  
phone calls, and get directions to your  
friends’ locations.  
Kies air  
Allows you to sync your Windows PC  
wirelessly with your phone (as long as  
both are on the same Wi-Fi network). You  
can now have real-time access of your  
phone through your PC to view call logs,  
videos,  
photos, bookmarks, IMs, and even send  
SMS messages directly from your home  
computer.  
Lookout Anti-Virus  
Lookout™ Anti-Virus application  
provides mobile device-specific security  
features that are coupled with a minimal  
Maps  
Launches a Web-based dynamic map  
that helps you find local businesses,  
locate friends, view maps and get driving  
38  
         
Market  
Mini Diary  
Allows you to find and download free and  
for-purchase applications on Android  
Allows you to create a mini diary where  
you can add a photo, and text to describe  
an event or other memorable life event.  
Media Hub  
More for Me  
Provides you with a one stop shop for the  
hottest movie and TV content. You can  
now rent or purchase your favorite  
content and then watch it from the  
convenience of anywhere. For more  
Provides customized offers, discounts  
and deals right to your phone. For more  
Music  
Launches the built-in Music Player that  
allows you to play music files that you  
have stored on your microSD card. You  
can also create playlists. For more  
Memo  
Creates new text memos. For more  
Messaging  
My Account  
Provides access to text and multimedia  
messaging (SMS and MMS). For more  
Provides you with account specific  
information such as: current status,  
Activity, Set Alerts, Bill Summary, Plan  
Services, and FAQ’s Info. For more  
Understanding Your Phone  
39  
               
My Device  
Places  
Allows you to configure device settings,  
view Personalize your CallerTunes,  
Ringtones, or Wallpapers, View Quick  
Tools, Support, and battery storage  
Displays company logos on a layer of  
Google Maps. When viewing an area you  
can quickly locate a business or person,  
find out more information about the  
business,seecoupons,publicresponses,  
Navigation  
Polaris Office  
Launches a Web-based navigation  
application.  
Polaris Office® Mobile for Android is a  
Microsoft Office compatible office suite.  
This application provides a central place  
for managing your documents online or  
offline.  
Caution! Traffic data is not real-time  
and directions may be wrong,  
dangerous, prohibited, or  
involve ferries.  
Settings  
Accesses the device’s built-in Settings  
News & Weather  
Launches a Web-based news and  
weather feed based on your current  
Slacker  
Slacker® offers free, internet radio for  
mobile phones.  
40  
               
Social Hub  
Talk  
Allows you to easily and intuitively satisfy  
all of your communication needs from  
within a single-user interface. E-mails,  
instant messaging, social network  
contents, and calendar contents from all  
majorserviceprovidersareavailable. For  
Launches a Web-based Google Talk  
application that lets you chat with family  
and friends over the Internet for free. For  
Task  
Allows you to keep track of both your  
currentandupcomingtasks.Youcanalso  
sync these tasks with different accounts.  
T-Mobile Mall  
This downloadable application provides  
access to several phone features and  
Task Manager  
Use Task Manager to see which  
applications are running on your phone,  
andtoendrunningapplicationstoextend  
battery life.  
T-Mobile Name ID  
Allowsyoutomodifytheon-screenCaller  
ID information.  
T-Mobile TV HD  
Allows you to watch live mobile HD TV on  
your phone.  
TeleNav GPS  
Thisapplicationisasubscriptionservice.  
Thisdrivingaidprovidesbothaudibleand  
visual navigation instructions for GPS  
Understanding Your Phone  
41  
                 
Tetris  
Voice Recorder  
Tetris® is a puzzle video game in which  
falling tetrominoes must be manipulated  
to form complete lines, which are then  
cleared from the grid. For more  
Allowsyoutorecordanaudiofileuptoone  
minutelongandthenimmediatelysendit  
Voice Search  
Video Chat  
Launches your phone’s built-in voice  
recognition software and initiates a  
Google search based on the recognized  
Allowsyoutorecordandsharelivevideos  
on your device with your friends, family,  
and your favorite social networks. For  
Web  
Videos  
Openthebrowsertostartsurfingtheweb.  
Thebrowserisfullyoptimizedandcomes  
with advanced functionality to enhance  
the Internet browsing feature on your  
phone.  
Launches your device’s built-in video  
applicationthatplaysvideofilesstoredon  
your microSD card.  
Visual Voicemail  
Visual Voicemail enables users to view a  
list of people who left a voicemail  
message, and listen to the any message  
they want without being limited to  
chronological order.  
Wi-Fi Calling  
Provides the ability to use your available  
Wi-Fi data connection to make outbound  
calls that count against your phone  
minutes. Similar to VOIP (Voice Over IP).  
42  
               
Customizing the Screens  
Yelp  
You can customize the Home screens (panels) to  
display the Widgets, Shortcuts, Folders, or  
Wallpapers. For example, one screen could  
contain the Music Player shortcut and other  
forms of media, while another screen might  
contain communication apps such as Gmail.  
Launches the Yelp application that  
provides access to an online urban city  
guidethathelpspeoplefindcoolplacesto  
eat, shop, drink, relaxandplay. Itsthefun  
and easy way to find, review and talk  
aboutwhat'sgreatinyourworld.Formore  
You can customize your Home screen by doing  
the following:  
YouTube  
Adding, Deleting, and Rearranging screens  
Adding and Removing Shortcuts  
Adding and Removing Widgets  
Creating Folders  
Launches the YouTube webpage via the  
browser.  
Zinio Reader  
Changing the Background (Wallpapers)  
Launches a digital magazine reader.  
Zinio®hastransformedyourfavoriteprint  
magazines into digital format. For more  
Adding and Deleting Screens  
Your phone comes with seven screens. You can  
delete these screens and then add them back  
later.  
Note: These screens can be deleted and  
re-arranged.  
Important! Your phone can only contain at most  
seven screens and at least one screen.  
Understanding Your Phone  
43  
             
To delete a screen:  
1. Press  
Rearranging the Screens  
1. Press and then tap  
Edit).  
and  
(
then tap  
2. Touch and hold a screen and then drag it  
into its new location. Upper-left is screen  
position #1 and bottom-right is screen last  
screen.  
(Edit).  
2. Touch and  
hold, then  
drag the  
Adding and Removing Primary  
Shortcuts  
undesired  
screen  
down to the  
Remove tab  
The device comes with four Primary shortcuts:  
Phone, Contacts, Messaging, and Applications/  
Home. As long as the menu is displayed in a  
Customizable grid, you can replace the Phone,  
Contacts, and Messaging shortcuts with other  
applications so you access the shortcuts that are  
most frequently used.  
(
).  
3. Press  
to return to the main Home screen.  
To add a screen:  
1. Press  
Edit).  
2. Tap the Add icon (  
1. Press  
and then tap  
and then tap  
(Applications).  
(
2. Press  
and then tap View Type  
). The newly added  
Customizable grid  
.
screen appears as the last page.  
3. Press to return to the main Home  
screen.  
3. Press  
and then tap Edit  
OK. The  
application pages then appear at the top of  
the screen, the primary shortcuts appear  
at the bottom, and you have the option to  
also generate a new folder or page to  
house these application shortcuts.  
4. Scroll through the application pages at the  
top and locate the desired application.  
44  
   
5. Touch and hold the on-screen icon, then  
drag it over one of the four primary  
shortcuts to replace it.  
To add a shortcut from the Applications screen:  
1. Press  
to go to the  
Home  
screen.  
The new primary shortcut displays at the bottom  
of the screen. The previous primary shortcuts  
switches places with your selected icon.  
2. Select a  
location  
6. Press  
and then tap Save  
.
(screen) for  
your new  
shortcut by  
scrolling  
across your  
available  
screens  
7. Tap  
to return to the Home screen.  
Managing Shortcuts  
Note: To move a shortcut from one screen to  
another, you must carefully touch and hold  
the shortcut and slowly drag it to the edge  
of the screen. As the shortcut turns light  
blue, you can begin to move it to the  
adjacent screen.  
until you reach the desired one.  
3. Tap Applications  
(
) to reveal all your  
If this does not work, delete it from its  
current screen. Activate the new screen and  
then add the selected shortcut.  
current available applications. By default,  
applications are displayed as an  
Alphabetical grid.  
4. Scroll across the screens and locate your  
desired application.  
Understanding Your Phone  
45  
   
5. Touch and hold the on-screen icon. The  
new shortcut then appears to hover over  
the current screen.  
2. Touch and hold the desired shortcut. This  
unlocks it from its location on the current  
screen.  
6. While still holding the on-screen icon,  
position it on the current screen. Once  
complete, release the screen to lock the  
shortcut into its new position.  
3. Drag the shortcut over the Remove tab  
(
) and release.  
Adding and Removing Widgets  
Widgets are self-contained applications that can  
be placed on any screen. Unlike shortcuts,  
widgets appear as applications.  
To add a shortcut via the Add to Home screen:  
1. Press  
to go to the  
To add a Widget:  
Home  
1. Press  
screen.  
to go to the  
2. Navigate to  
Home  
a screen  
screen.  
with an  
2. Navigate to  
empty area.  
a screen  
3. Touch and  
with an  
hold an  
empty area.  
empty area  
3. Touch and  
of the  
hold an  
screen.  
empty area  
4. From the Add to Home screen window tap  
of the  
Shortcuts  
.
screen.  
5. Scroll up or down the list and tap a  
4. From the Add to Home screen window tap  
Widgets. The available widgets appear  
within a scrollable area across the bottom  
of the screen.  
selection.  
To delete a shortcut:  
1. Press  
to go to the Home screen.  
46  
     
5. Scroll left or right across the bottom of the  
screen and then tap an available Widget to  
place it on your current screen.  
To remove a Widget:  
1. Touch and hold a Widget until it unlocks  
from the current screen.  
2. Drag the widget over the Remove tab  
(
) and release it.  
As you place the Widget into the Trash, both  
items turn red.  
This action doesn’t delete the Widget, it just  
removes it from the current screen.  
To place a widget onto a different screen:  
1. Touch and hold the widget until it becomes  
transparent.  
2. Slowly drag it past the edge of the screen  
until the adjacent page appears  
highlighted and it then snaps onto the new  
page.  
3. Drag the widget to its desired position on  
the new screen.  
4. Repeat these steps to continue moving it to  
other screens.  
Understanding Your Phone  
47  
 
Creating and Managing a Folder  
Folders hold items that you want to organize and  
store together on the workspace.  
Managing Wallpapers  
Wallpapers consist of either Gallery images (user  
taken), Live wallpapers (animated backgrounds),  
or Wallpaper gallery (default phone wallpapers).  
To create a new on-screen folder:  
1. Press  
to go to the Home screen.  
Note: Selecting animated Live wallpapers will  
2. Touch and hold an empty area of the  
screen.  
require additional battery power.  
3. From the Add to Home screen window tap  
To change the current wallpaper:  
Folders  
.
1. Press  
to go to the Home screen.  
4. Tap an available folder type and place it on  
2. Touch and hold an empty area of the  
screen.  
the current screen.  
3. From the Add to Home screen window tap  
Renaming a folder  
Wallpapers  
.
1. Tap the desired folder you want to rename.  
This opens its contents on an on-screen  
popup window.  
4. Select a Wallpaper:  
Tap Gallery to select from a user image stored in  
the camera image gallery, crop the image, and  
tap Save  
2. With the folder open, touch and hold the  
grey Folder title bar (top of the Folder  
window) until the Rename folder pop-up  
displays.  
.
Tap Live wallpapers to select from a list of  
animated backgrounds, once done tap Set  
wallpaper  
.
3. Enter a new title for this folder and tap Yes  
.
Tap Wallpaper gallery, scroll through the  
Deleting a folder  
images, tap a wallpaper image, then tap Set  
1. Touch and hold a desired folder. This  
unlocks it from its location on the current  
screen.  
wallpaper  
.
2. Drag the folder over the Remove tab (  
)
and release it.  
48  
         
Section 3: Memory Card  
Your device lets you use a microSD(SD) or  
microSDHCcard (also referred to as a memory  
card) to expand available memory space. This  
secure digital card enables you to exchange  
images, music, and data between  
SD card Overview  
After mounting an SD card in the device you can  
use your computer to access and manage the SD  
card.  
SD-compatible devices. This section addresses  
the features and options of your device’s SD  
functionality. The device has a USB SD card  
mode.  
Important! If access to the external SD card is not  
available, download and install the  
USB drivers.  
microSD card storage: up to 2GB in size  
SDHC card storage: up to 32GB in size  
microSD Icon Indicators  
The following icons show your microSD card  
connection status at a glance:  
Using the SD Card  
There are several methods for using the SD card:  
1. Connecting to your PC to store files (such  
as music, videos, or other types of files  
and media).  
the contents of the microSD card  
are being scanned.  
the card is being prepared for use  
and for mounting.  
2. To activate the camera, video, music  
player, and other dependant media or  
applications.  
the card has been improperly  
removed.  
Important! Your device can support SDHC cards  
up to 32GB capacity.  
Memory Card  
49  
       
3. Verify the phone is not in a USB Debugging  
Mode. This mode is used by developers  
and prevents access to the phone’s  
4. Connect the USB cable to the phone and  
connect the cable to the computer.  
Important! DO NOT remove a microSD card while  
the device is accessing or transferring  
files. Doing so will result in loss or  
damage of data. Make sure your  
battery is fully charged before using  
the microSD card. Your data may  
become damaged or lost if the battery  
runs out while you are using the  
microSD card.  
Unmounting the SD card  
Unmounting the SD card prevents corruption and  
damage to the SD card while removing it from  
the slot.  
Mounting the SD Card  
To store photos, music, videos, and other  
applications. You must mount (install) the SD  
card prior to use. Mounting the SD card  
establishes a USB connection with your  
computer.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Storage.  
2. Tap Unmount SD card OK.  
3. When the “SD card will be unmounted  
message displays and the Mount SD card  
now appears in the menu list, remove the  
Important! You must enable USB storage to mount  
the SD card.  
1. Press  
Settings) Storage.  
2. Tap Mount SD card  
and then tap  
(
SD card Memory Status  
.
To view the memory allocation for your external SD  
card:  
Connecting to the SD card  
1. Insert the SD card into the external, SD  
Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Storage. The available  
memory displays under the Total space  
and Available space headings.  
2. Verify the card is properly mounted.  
50  
         
4. Tap Reset phone  
Erase everything  
.
Erasing Files from the SD card  
You can erase files from the SD card using the  
phone.  
1. Ensure the SD card is mounted. For more  
2. Press  
Settings) Storage Unmount SD card  
3. Tap Format SD card Format SD card  
and then tap  
(
.
Erase everything to format the SD card. The  
SD card formats and erases all the data  
stored on it.  
Factory Data Reset  
From this menu you can reset your phone and  
sound settings to the factory default settings.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Privacy  
.
2. Tap Factory data reset. This action erases  
all data from your device except current  
system software and bundled applications,  
or SD card files such as music or photos.  
Note: This feature provides an option to format the  
internal USB storage, not the microSD card.  
3. Tap Format USB storage to erase all data  
stored on the device’s internal storage  
area.  
Memory Card  
51  
   
Section 4: Call Functions and Contacts List  
This section describes features and functionality  
Note: When you activate the Auto redial (Call >  
associated with making or answering calls, and  
the Contacts list, which is used to store contact  
information.  
Additional options) option in the Call settings  
menu, the phone automatically redials up to  
10 times when the person does not answer  
the call or is already on the phone, provided  
your call is not sent to voice mail.  
Displaying Your Phone Number  
Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) About phone  
Status. Your  
Quick Dialing a Number from the  
Contacts List  
phone number displays in the My phone  
number field.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Note: The phone’s Settings menu can also be  
activated by pressing and then  
tapping Applications) ➔  
Settings).  
(
Contacts).  
2. Locate a contact from the list.  
3. In a single motion, touch and slide your  
finger over the number by going to the  
right. This action places a call to the  
recipient.  
(
(
Making a Call  
You can store phone numbers that are regularly  
used to the SIM card or to the phone’s memory.  
These entries are referred to as the Contacts list  
Ending a Call  
.
Briefly tap  
key to end the call.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
.
Note: To redial a recent number, tap  
end of the call or locate the number from  
the Logs list, tap the entry and tap Call  
at the  
2. Enter the phone number and then tap  
.
.
If you make a mistake while dialing, tap  
to clear the last digit. Touch and  
If you exit the current call screen and return to  
the Home screen, You are visually notified that  
you are still on an active call by the green phone  
icon within the Status bar (highlighted in green).  
hold  
to clear the entire sequence.  
52  
                     
Making Emergency Calls  
In Call Notification  
If you do not have a SIM card installed the first  
time you turn on the phone, the Insert SIM card to  
make calls message displays and an animated  
tutorial shows you how to install the SIM card.  
Without a SIM card, you can only make an  
emergency call with the phone; normal cell  
phone service is not available.  
Making an Emergency Call Without a SIM  
card installed  
1. Tap Emergency call from the on-screen  
Ending a Call from the Status Bar  
1. Tap the Status bar to reveal the  
Notifications tab, and then drag the tab to  
the bottom of the screen to open the  
Notifications panel (1).  
display to make an emergency call.  
2. Complete your call. During this type of call,  
you will have access to the Speaker mode,  
Keypad, and End Call features.  
2. Tap End to end the currently active call (2).  
Note: Selecting Location consent may drain  
3. Tap  
to exit this calling mode.  
Making an Emergency Call With a SIM card  
installed  
1. Swipe the Lock screen and access the  
Home screen.  
2. Press  
3. Enter the emergency number (ex: 911) and  
then tap  
and then tap  
.
.
Call Functions and Contacts List  
53  
           
4. Complete your call. During this type of call,  
you will have access to the Speaker mode,  
Keypad, and End Call features.  
To view additional dialing options:  
Tap  
:
• Add to Contacts to add the current number to  
either a new or existing Contacts entry.  
Note: Selecting Location consent may drain  
• Speed dial setting to access the Speed Dialing  
menu where you can assign a speed dial  
location to a current Contacts entry.  
• Send message to send the current caller a text  
message while still maintaining the current call  
active.  
5. Tap  
to exit this calling mode.  
Dialing Options  
When you enter  
numbers on the  
Keypad, you will  
see three  
• Add 3 sec pause to insert a two-second pause  
to enter a 3-second delay within a number string  
(the phone continues dialing after 2 seconds  
without any additional keys being pressed).  
• Add wait to insert a hard pause within the  
number string (the phone waits for your input). A  
wait requires that any consecutive numbers be  
on-screen  
options.  
From the keypad  
screen, use one  
of the following  
options:  
manually sent by tapping Send  
.
Call  
(
) to  
call the entered  
number.  
Delete  
(
)
to delete digits from the current number.  
Voice Mail  
service.  
(
) to access your Voice Mail  
) to send the current number  
Text Message  
(
a new text message.  
54  
   
Answering a Call  
When somebody calls you, the phone rings and  
displays the incoming call image.  
Touch and  
drag to  
The caller's phone number, picture, or name if  
stored in Contacts List, displays.  
Touch and  
slide it  
reject with a  
message  
At the incoming call screen:  
to answer  
the call  
Touch and slide  
the call.  
anywhere to answer  
Touch and  
slide to reject  
the call  
Touch and slide  
call.  
anywhere to reject the  
Touch and drag the Reject call with message  
tab upward and tap a predefined rejection  
message or tap Create new message to create  
a new custom outgoing response.  
Managing Reject Calls  
This feature allows you to categorize both known  
and unknown callers as rejected contacts. These  
Contacts are then added to you Rejection list  
which can be managed for individual entries  
from within the Contacts list or as a whole from  
the Call rejection scree.  
Pressing the Volume down button mutes the  
ringer.  
If the incoming call is from a number stored in  
your Contacts, the entry’s name is displayed. You  
may also see the caller’s phone number, if  
available.  
1. From the Home screen, press  
and  
Call  
then tap  
rejection  
(
Settings) Call  
.
2. Tap Auto reject mode to configure your  
automatic rejection settings. Rejected calls  
are routed automatically to your voicemail.  
Choose from:  
• Off: disables the automatic rejection feature. You  
must then manually reject incoming phone calls.  
Call Functions and Contacts List  
55  
           
• All numbers: enables the features for all known  
and unknown number, including those contacts  
that are not assigned to the rejection list.  
• Auto reject numbers: automatically rejects all  
entries assigned to the Reject list.  
3. Tap Save to complete the assignment.  
International Calls  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
, then  
touch and hold  
displays.  
. The + symbol  
Adding numbers to the rejection list  
2. Use the on-screen keypad to enter the  
country code, area code, and phone  
number.  
Entries can be added to the list via either the  
Contacts menu or via the Auto reject list menu.  
The Contacts menu option assigns all numbers  
for an individual as rejected. The Auto reject list  
allows to assign individual numbers.  
If you make a mistake, tap  
a single digit.  
once to delete  
Touch and hold  
to delete all digits.  
To assign multiple numbers as rejected via  
Contacts:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
3. Tap  
.
Pause Dialing  
You can dial or save phone numbers with pauses  
for use with automated systems, such as  
voicemail or financial phone numbers.  
(
Contacts).  
2. Locate an entry and tap it to open the  
Contact Overview Screen (page 87).  
3-Second Pause automatically sends the next set  
3. Press  
and then tap Add to black list.  
of numbers after a three-second pause. This is  
All phone numbers associated with this  
entry are then added to the reject list.  
indicated in the number string as a comma (  
Wait sends the next set of numbers only after  
tapping . This is indicated in the number  
,).  
To assign single numbers as rejected via Auto  
reject list:  
1. From the Home screen, press  
Send  
string as a semicolon (  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
;
).  
and  
Call  
and use  
then tap  
(
Settings) Call  
Black list  
Add) and either enter the phone  
the on-screen keypad to enter the phone  
number.  
rejection  
.
2. Tap  
(
number or select a Contact from your Logs  
or Contacts list.  
56  
                   
2. Press  
and then tap Add 3 sec pause  
.
2. Press  
and then tap Add wait. This  
This feature adds an automatic three-  
second pause.  
feature causes the phone to require your  
acceptance before sending the next set of  
entered digits.  
3. Use the keypad to enter the additional  
numbers that will be dialed automatically  
after the second pause.  
3. Tap  
.
4. Once prompted, tap  
remaining digits.  
to dial the  
Send  
Tip: You can create pauses longer than three  
Redialing the Last Number  
seconds by entering multiple 3-sec pauses.  
The phone stores the numbers of the calls you’ve  
dialed, received, or missed if the caller is  
identified.  
4. Tap  
.
Wait Dialing  
To recall any of these numbers:  
Inserting a Wait  
into your dialing  
sequence means  
that the phone  
waits until it  
hears a dial tone  
before  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. Tap the Logs tab to display the list of recent  
calls.  
3. Tap the name/number and tap  
.
proceeding with  
the next  
sequence of  
numbers.  
1. From the  
Home  
screen, tap  
and use the on-screen keypad to  
enter the phone number.  
Call Functions and Contacts List  
57  
             
4. Tap a contact and select a number to  
assign to the speed dial location. The  
selected contact number/image is  
Speed Dialing  
Once you have stored phone numbers from your  
Contacts List, you can set up to 8 speed dial  
entries and then dial them easily whenever you  
want, simply by touching the associated numeric  
key.  
displayed in the speed dial number box.  
Changing a Speed Dial Entry Order  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Setting Up Speed Dial Entries  
2. Press  
and then tap Speed dial setting.  
Important! Speed dial location #1 is reserved for  
Voicemail. No other number can be  
assigned to this slot.  
Important! The number 1 is reserved for Voicemail  
and another number cannot be  
assigned to this slot.  
1. From the  
3. Press  
and then tap Change order  
.
Home  
screen, tap  
4. In a single motion, touch and drag an entry  
over another location on the virtual  
keypad.  
.
2. Press  
5. Tap Save to store the new assignment.  
and then tap  
Speed dial  
setting. The  
Speed dial  
screen  
6. Press  
screen.  
to return to the previous  
Removing a Speed Dial Entry  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. Press  
and then tap Speed dial setting.  
displays a  
virtual  
keypad with  
the numbers 1 through 9.  
3. Tap an unassigned number. The Contacts  
screen displays.  
3. Touch and hold a existing on-screen speed  
dial location and select Remove from the  
context menu.  
– or –  
Press  
and then tap Remove. Tap an  
entry and select Remove  
.
58  
       
4. Press  
screen.  
to return to the previous  
Important! Wi-Fi must first be active and  
communicating prior to launching Wi-  
Fi Calling.  
Making a Call Using Speed Dial  
You can assign a short cut number to a phone  
number in the Contacts List for speed dialing.  
Activating Wi-Fi:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Wireless and network  
Wi-Fi  
2. Touch and hold a speed dial location  
(numbers 2-9, or 1 if you are dialing voice  
mail) until the number begins to dial.  
3. If you are not certain of the speed dial  
settings.  
2. Tap Wi-Fi to turn it on. A checkmark  
displays to indicate activation.  
location, tap  
setting and touch a speed dial number to  
view the assigned phone number.  
Speed dial  
3. Tap an available WAP (Wireless Access  
Point) from within the Wi-Fi networks area  
of the page. Follow the on-screen  
instructions to complete connection.  
Wi-Fi Calling  
Wi-Fi Calling is a free feature for T-Mobile  
customers with a Wi-Fi capable phone. Wi-Fi  
Calling is an excellent solution for coverage  
issues in and around the home or wherever  
cellular coverage is limited. Minutes used while  
connected to the Wi-Fi network count against  
available rate plan minutes.  
Note: To avoid international data roaming fees  
when using Wi-Fi calling when outside the  
United States, the Data Roaming feature on  
your device must be turned off.  
Note: With certain rate plans, minutes used while  
connected to the Wi-Fi network count  
against available rate plan minutes.  
The benefits of Wi-Fi Calling include the following:  
Wi-Fi Calling provides a coverage option to improve  
upon your current in-home coverage experience  
Wi-Fi Calling works anywhere you can connect to an  
available Wi-Fi network.  
Call Functions and Contacts List  
59  
       
3. If prompted to  
register onto  
the T-Mobile  
network prior  
to use, tap  
Launching Wi-Fi Calling  
Note: Verify you are currently connected to a  
Wireless Access Point.  
1. Ensure that the Wi-Fi connected icon  
displays on the status bar. The network  
names and security settings (Open  
network or Secured with WEP) of detected  
Wi-Fi networks display in the Wi-Fi  
networks section.  
Register to  
complete the  
process.  
4. Tap the slider  
to activate Wi-  
Fi Calling. The  
slider shows  
On. Your  
Wi-Fi Calling  
activation  
slider  
Note: When you select an open network you are  
automatically connected.  
device  
connects to  
the T-Mobile Network.  
Wi-Fi Connected  
Displays when Wi-Fi is connected,  
active, and communicating with a  
Wireless Access Point (WAP).  
Note: If prompted with a connection error, move  
the slider back to Off then back to On to re-  
establish the connection.  
Wi-Fi Communication Issue  
DisplayswhenWi-Fiisactiveandthere  
is an avialable Wireless Access Point  
(WAP).  
2. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Wi-Fi Calling).  
60  
In Call Options  
Your phone provides a number of features that  
are available for use during a call.  
When Action  
Then  
Displays on the Youareconnectedtothe  
screen status T-Mobile network and  
bar.  
can make Wi-Fi calls.  
Displays on the Thefeatureisactiveand  
screen status you are using with  
Dials the  
number  
bar.  
within your current  
active call.  
Place a call  
on hold  
Call  
duration  
Doesnotdisplay Youarechargednormal  
on the screen callingrateminutes.For  
Adds a  
new call  
status bar.  
Ends the  
call  
5. Use the phone Dialer, call log, or contacts  
list to make a call. For more information,  
Activates or  
Deactivates  
Activates or  
Deactivates  
Bluetooth  
Headset  
Mutes or Unmutes  
the call  
speakerphone  
6. Confirm you established a Wi-Fi calling  
connection to the T-Mobile network by  
Adjusting the Call Volume  
During a call, use the Volume keys on the left  
side of the phone, to adjust the earpiece volume.  
making sure  
the screen before you place your new call  
and appears during the call.  
appears at the top of  
Press the Up volume key to increase the  
volume level and the Down volume key to  
decrease the level.  
– or –  
During a call, press the Up Volume key on  
the side of the device.  
Call Functions and Contacts List  
61  
     
From the Home screen, you can also adjust the  
ring volume using these keys.  
Turning the Speakerphone on and off  
While on a call, you can use your Speakerphone  
Placing a Call on Hold  
by following these steps:  
Speaker  
1. Tap  
(Speaker off) to turn the  
You can place the current call on hold whenever  
you want. If your network supports this service,  
you can also make another call while a call is in  
progress.  
speakerphone on.  
Speaker  
2. Tap  
(
Speaker on) to turn the  
speakerphone off.  
To place a call on hold:  
Tip: When the speaker is turned On, the color of  
the speaker is green. When the speaker is  
turned Off, the color of the speaker is gray.  
1. Tap Hold to place the current call on hold.  
2. Tap Unhold to activate the call that is on  
hold.  
To make a new call while a call is in progress:  
1. Enter the new phone number that you wish  
to dial or look it up in Call history.  
Muting a Call  
Mute  
1. Tap  
(Mute off) to turn mute on so  
the other caller cannot hear you speaking.  
2. Tap Add call to dial the second call.  
Mute  
2. Tap  
(Mute on) to turn mute off and  
3. Dial the new phone number and tap  
.
resume your conversation.  
To switch between the two calls:  
Switching to Bluetooth Headset  
1. While on a call, switch to the Bluetooth  
headset instead of speaker by tapping  
Once the caller answers, tap Swap.  
The In call number turns gray and displays  
On hold. The active call displays a green  
background behind the number.  
Headset  
.
2. At the prompt, tap Yes to enable Bluetooth  
if it is not already activated.  
62  
         
Setting up a Multi-Party Call  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
More In-call Options  
During a call you can save the current caller’s  
information to the Contacts list, or create a  
Memo.  
.
2. Dial the number for the first participant and  
tap  
3. Tap Add call, enter the second phone  
.
Viewing the Contacts List  
During a call you can look up a number in the  
Contacts list.  
number and tap  
placed on hold.  
. The first caller is  
1. Press  
and then tap Contacts.  
4. Wait for the second caller to answer the  
incoming call and tap Merge. The two calls  
are now joined into a multi-party call and  
display in the order in which they were  
called.  
2. Browse the Contacts list for the  
information you need.  
3. Press  
to return to the active call.  
Creating a Memo During a Call  
During a call it may be necessary to record  
information (a Note).  
Important! A maximum of two callers can be  
joined to a single multi-party line.  
Additional callers participate in a new  
Multiparty session and are held in  
conjunction with the previous  
1. Press  
2. Use the keyboard to enter the note then  
tap Save  
If desired, press  
background color before saving.  
and then tap Memo.  
.
and select a new memo  
multiparty call. You can swap or place  
each multi-party call on hold.  
Multi-Party calls  
Making a Multi-Party Call  
A multi-party call is a network service that  
allows up to six people to participate in a multi-  
party or conference call.  
For further details about subscribing to this  
service, contact T-Mobile customer service.  
Call Functions and Contacts List  
63  
           
Having a Private Conversation With One  
Participant  
Split  
Caller  
End  
Call  
When you have  
two participants  
in a multi-party  
session, it might  
be necessary to  
place one of  
Manage Conference  
Call  
thoseparticipants  
on hold so that a  
private  
conversation can  
be held with a  
single caller.  
While you are in a  
multi-party call:  
1. Press  
3. Tap the participant to which you want to  
speak privately. You can now talk privately  
to that person while the other participants  
can continue to converse with each other.  
If there is only one other participant, that  
person is placed on hold.  
4. To return to the multi-party call, tap the  
Merge icon. All of the multi-party call  
participants can now hear each other.  
Dropping One Participant  
and then  
tap Manage conference call  
– or –  
.
1. Press  
and then tap Manage  
conference call  
.
Tap the Conference Call image shown on  
2. Tap End to the right of the number to  
drop.  
2. Tap  
adjacent to the participants you  
would like to split from the current multi-  
line call. The list displays the callers in the  
order they were dialed.  
The participant is disconnected and you  
can continue the call with the other  
participant.  
3. Tap  
to end your conversation with  
the remaining caller.  
64  
       
Call Waiting  
Important! The currently active call is displayed  
You can answer an incoming call while you have  
a call in progress, if this service is supported by  
the network and you have previously set the Call  
waiting option to Activate.  
with a green background.  
4. Tap Swap again to switch back.  
Logs Tab  
You are notified of an incoming call by a call  
The Logs tab is a list of the phone numbers (or  
Contacts entries) for calls you placed, accepted,  
or missed. The Logs tab makes redialing a  
number fast and easy. It is continually updated  
as your device automatically adds new numbers  
to the beginning of the list and removes the  
oldest entries from the bottom of the list.  
To answer a new call while you have a call in  
progress:  
1. In a single motion, touch and slide  
in any direction to answer the new  
incoming call.  
The Notification area of the Home screen (upper-  
left) displays phone notifications, status, or alerts  
such as:  
2. Tap an option from the on-screen menu:  
• Putting XX on hold to place the previous caller  
on hold while you answer the new incoming call.  
• Ending call with XXX to end the previous call  
and answer the new call.  
Displays when a call is in progress.  
Displays when a call was missed.  
Note: The new caller appears at the top of the list.  
The previous caller is placed on hold and  
appears at the bottom of the list.  
Accessing the Logs Tab  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Logs tab).  
3. Tap Swap to switch between the two calls.  
This places the new caller on hold and  
activates the previous call.  
Logs  
2. Tap an entry to view available options.  
Call Functions and Contacts List  
65  
         
3. Tap the Missed call entry to open the Logs  
Note: The Logs tab only records calls that occur  
while the phone is turned on. If a call is  
received while it is turned off, it will not be  
included in your calling history.  
screen (2).  
Each entry contains the phone number (if it is  
available) and Contacts entry name (if the  
number is in your Contacts).  
Indicates all outgoing calls made from  
your device.  
Indicates any received calls that were  
answered.  
Indicates a missed call.  
Tip: Press  
panel.  
and tap Notifications to open the  
Indicates a rejected call.  
This list provides easy access to redial an entry,  
or you can also choose to access two types of  
history entry lists depending on how they are  
touched.  
AccessingLogsfromTheNotifications  
Area  
1. Locate  
from the Notifications area of  
the Status bar.  
2. Tap the Status bar to reveal the  
Notifications tab, and then drag the tab to  
the bottom of the screen to open the  
Notifications panel (1).  
66  
 
• Time provides the time and date of the call and  
its duration.  
Call Logs - Caller Overview  
• Create contact to save the number if it is not  
already in your Contacts.  
Call options (tap)  
Call Log screen  
• Update existing to add the number to an  
existing Contacts entry.  
Touch and hold an entry to display the entry-specific  
context menu:  
• Call [Number] to redial the current phone  
number.  
• Send message allows you to create a new text  
message to the selected entry.  
• Edit number before call to make alterations to  
the current phone number prior to redial.  
• Add to Contacts to save the number if it is not  
already in your Contacts.  
• Send log info to send the Log entry information  
via text message.  
Entry-specific  
context menu  
(touch and hold)  
• View contact to view the information for the  
currently stored Contacts entry.  
• Add to black list to add the current phone  
number to an automatic rejection list. Similar to a  
block list, the selected caller will be blocked from  
making an incoming calls to your phone.  
• Delete to delete the entry from the Logs list.  
Tap a contact entry name or number to reveal the  
Call options screen:  
• Call allows you to redial the entry by name or  
number.  
• Send message allows you to create a new text  
message to the selected entry.  
Call Functions and Contacts List  
67  
     
Altering Numbers from the Logs List  
Viewing Missed Calls from Lock  
Screen  
If you need to make a call from the Logs screen  
and you need to alter the number prior to dialing,  
you can add the appropriate prefix by prepending  
the number.  
When you are  
unable to answer a  
call for any reason  
and your screen is  
locked, the number  
of missed calls are  
displayed on the  
Lock screen  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Logs  
2. Touch and hold an entry to access the  
entry-specific context menu.  
3. Tap Edit number before call  
.
immediately after a  
call is missed.  
4. Edit the number using the on-screen  
keypad or delete digits by pressing  
to erase the numbers.  
To view a missed call  
immediately:  
1. Press  
5. Tap  
changed.  
once the number has been  
to  
reactive the screen.  
Erasing the Logs List  
2. Touch and drag the button (with the  
number of missed calls on it) to the  
right.The Logs tab is then displayed.  
You can delete either an individual call log entry  
or all current entries from the Logs list.  
To clear a single entry from the list:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Logs  
2. Touch and hold an entry and select Delete  
.
To clear all entries from the list:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Logs  
2. Press  
Delete.  
Delete  
3. Tap Select all  
OK.  
68  
       
Section 5: Entering Text  
Thissectiondescribeshowtoselectthedesiredtext  
input method when entering characters into your  
phone. This section also describes the predictive  
text entry system that reduces the amount of key  
strokes associated with entering text.  
Selecting the Text Input  
Method  
The Text Input Method can be assigned from  
within one of two locations:  
Settings Menu:  
Your phone comes equipped with an orientation  
detector that can tell if the phone is being held in an  
upright (Portrait) or sideways (Landscape)  
Press  
Settings) Language and keyboard  
Select input method  
Text Input field:  
and then tap  
(
orientation. This is useful when entering text.  
.
Your phone also provides several on-screen keypad  
text entry options to make the task of text entry that  
much easier.  
1. From a screen where you can enter text,  
touch and hold the text input field to open  
the context-menu.  
Text Input Methods  
There are two text input methods available:  
Samsung keypad (default): an on-screen  
QWERTY keypad that can be used in both  
portrait and landscape orientation.  
2. Select the input method (Samsung keypad  
or Swype).  
Swype: a new way to enter text on touch  
screens. Instead of tapping each key, use your  
finger to trace over each letter of a word.  
Default Text  
Input Method  
The on-screen QWERTY keypad works the same  
in both portrait and landscape mode.  
Entering Text  
69  
             
Enabling Accessibility settings  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) (Accessibility).  
Enabling and Configuring SWYPE  
If you configure another text input method  
(Samsung keypad) you must re-enable SWYPE  
before using the SWYPE keyboard.  
(
2. Tap Accessibility to activate or deactivate  
accessibility services. When activated, a  
check mark appears in the box.  
3. If prompted, tap OK to download  
accessibility applications from the Android  
Market.  
When SWYPE is enabled there can also be  
normal keyboard functionality.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Language and keyboard  
.
2. Tap Select input method  
Swype.  
SWYPE Settings  
4. Follow the on-screen instructions.  
To configure Swype settings:  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Swype  
Language and keyboard  
.
Entering Text Using Swype  
2. Locate the Preferences section to alter  
Swype™ is a text input method that allows you  
to enter a word by sliding your finger or stylus  
from letter to letter, lifting your finger between  
words. SWYPE uses error correcting algorithms  
and a language model to predict the next word.  
SWYPE also includes a touch predictive text  
system.  
these settings:  
• Language: allows you to select the current text  
input language. Default language is US English.  
• Audio feedback: turns on sounds generated by  
the Swype application.  
• Show tips: turns on helpful on-screen tips from  
Swype.  
The on-screen keyboard options are different  
between the Android keyboard and Swype on-  
screen input methods.  
3. Locate the Swype Advanced Settings  
section to alter these settings:  
• Word suggestion: suggests words as you are  
typing.  
• Auto-spacing: automatically inserts a space  
between words. When you finish a word, just lift  
your finger or stylus and start the next word.  
70  
           
• Auto-capitalization: automatically capitalizes  
the first letter of a sentence.  
Swype Text Entry Tips  
You can  
• Show complete trace: once enabled, sets  
wether or not to display the complete Swype  
path.  
access the  
SwypeTips  
application  
and watch a  
video or  
tutorial on  
using Swype.  
You can also  
use the  
• Speed vs. accuracy: sets how quickly Swype  
responds to on-screen input. Move the slider  
between Fast Response (speed) or Error  
Tolerant (accuracy) and tap OK  
.
4. Locate the Help section to alter these  
settings:  
following  
Swype text  
entry tips.  
• Swype help: allows you to view the on-line user  
manual for Swype.  
Create a  
Tutorial: a short tutorial that helps you to get  
started using Swype.  
squiggle (like  
an S shape) to  
5. Locate the About section to review the  
Swype application information:  
• Version: lists the Swype version number.  
create a double letter (such as pp in apple).  
Touch and hold a key to view the punctuation menu  
then make a selection.  
Move your finger or stylus over the apostrophe to  
enter contractions.  
Double-touch on the word you want to change to  
correct a misspelled word, then touch the delete key  
to erase one character. Touch and hold the delete  
key to erase an entire word.  
Entering Text  
71  
Text Input mode: There are two available  
modes: 123ABC and SYM.  
Selecting a Text Input Mode in Swype  
1. From a screen where you can enter text,  
tap the text input field to reveal the  
on-screen keyboard.  
123ABC mode contains alphanumeric  
characters and a few common punctuation  
marks. Text mode button indicates SYM  
SYM mode contains only symbols and numbers.  
Text mode button indicates 123ABC  
.
2. With Swype as your text entry method,  
select one of the following text mode  
options:  
• 123 ABC  
.
123  
ABC  
to use Swype with  
• SWYPE tips: Tapping this button displays the  
alphanumeric characters from the on-screen  
Swype tips and tutorial screen.  
keyboard.  
123  
SYM  
• SYM (Symbol)  
to enter numbers and  
Recipients  
symbols from the on-screen keyboard.  
Note: After typing an initial uppercase character,  
Text input  
field  
the  
key changes to  
and all letters  
that follow are in lower case.  
Current  
Mode  
Predictive  
text  
Swype Keyboard Overview  
• Recipients: a field where you can enter the  
recipients of the current message. You can  
CAPS/ALT  
key  
choose from Contacts  
,
Recent, Group or  
Delete  
Favorites  
.
Text Input field: a field where text, number, or  
other characters can be entered.  
SWYPE Tips  
Text Input mode  
Voice actions  
• CAPS/ALT key: When in 123ABC mode, this key  
changes the capitalization of the subsequent  
entered characters. When in SYM mode, this key  
can show additional symbol characters.  
72  
Using 123ABC Mode in SWYPE  
All lowercase  
In 123ABC mode, you can enter only letters and a  
few common punctuation marks from the  
onscreen keyboard. The text mode key shows  
Displays when the next character is  
entered in lowercase. Pressing this  
while in 123SYM mode, reveals  
additional numeric-symbols keys.  
123  
SYM  
.
1. From a screen where you can enter text,  
Initial Uppercase  
tap the text input field to reveal the on-  
Displays when the first character of  
eachwordisenteredasuppercasebut  
all subsequent characters are  
lowercase.  
screen keyboard.  
123  
ABC  
2. Tap  
to configure the keyboard for  
123ABC mode (showing letters and  
numbers on the onscreen keys). Once in  
this mode, the text input type shows  
All Uppercase  
Displays when all characters will be  
entered as uppercase characters.  
123  
SYM  
.
Note: After typing an initial uppercase character,  
By default, the first letter of an entry is  
the  
key changes to  
and all letters  
capitalized and the following letters are lower  
case. After a word is entered and you lift your  
finger, the cursor automatically adds a space  
after the word.  
that follow are in lower case.  
3. Swipe your finger continuously over the  
letters to form a word.  
If you make a mistake, tap  
single character. Touch and hold  
an entire word.  
to erase a  
to erase  
Note: If multiple word choices exist for your  
Swype entry, an on-screen popup appears  
to provide additional word choices.  
4. Tap  
to send the message.  
Send  
Entering Text  
73  
 
Entering Numbers and Symbols in  
SWYPE  
By using the on-screen keyboard in portrait  
mode, some symbols are not available (such as  
Emoticons or Smileys). In SYM mode using  
Swype, you can only enter symbols and numbers  
Using the Samsung Keypad  
This QWERTY keypad is the default text input  
method and can be used to enter text in either a  
Portrait or landscape orientation. The only  
difference between the two orientations are the  
sizes of the keys.  
from the on-screen keyboard. Once in SYM  
From a screen where you enter text, rotate your  
phone counterclockwise to a landscape  
orientation. The on-screen QWERTY keypad  
displays.  
123  
mode, the text mode key shows  
.
ABC  
1. From a screen where you can enter text,  
tap the text input field to reveal the on-  
screen keyboard.  
123  
2. Tap  
to configure the keyboard for  
SYM  
SYM mode. Once in this mode, the text  
input type shows  
123  
.
ABC  
3. Tap the on-screen key for the number or  
symbol you want to enter.  
4. Touch and hold an on-screen key to enter  
the secondary symbol (above the main one  
on the same key).  
The Samsung Keypad  
5. Tap  
symbols.  
For example:  
to choose from additional  
This phone has a built-in, QWERTY keypad  
(portrait mode) or keyboard (landscape mode).  
Using the QWERTY keypad/ keyboard, you can  
type letter, numbers, punctuation, and other  
characters.  
To enter  
&: tap 123SYM and select the  
&
key.  
To enter  
over the  
or  
~: tap 123SYM and draw a small circle  
To use the Samsung keypad you must first  
configure the settings to default to the Samsung  
keypad.  
&
~
key.  
To enter  
hold the  
: tap 123SYM and then touch and  
&
key.  
74  
     
1. Press  
and then tap  
Changing the Text Input Mode in  
Keypad  
1. From a screen where you can enter text,  
tap the text input field to reveal the on-  
screen keyboard.  
(Settings) Language and keyboard  
Select input method  
– or –  
Samsung keypad.  
From a screen where you can enter text,  
tap and hold the text input field and tap  
Input method  
2. With Samsung keypad as your text entry  
method, select one of the following text  
mode options:  
Samsung keypad.  
2. The virtual keyboard is then assigned to  
the Samsung keypad configuration for all  
subsequent text input.  
ABC  
• Abc  
the on-screen keyboard. In this mode, the text  
?123  
: to use alphabetic characters from  
mode button displays  
• Symbol/Numeric  
.
Recipients  
Text input field  
Shift key  
: to enter numbers by  
?123  
pressing the numbers selecting them on the  
on-screen keyboard. In this mode, the text mode  
ABC  
button displays  
There are up to 3 available pages of numeric  
1/3  
.
symbols available by tapping  
.
Note: After typing an initial uppercase character,  
tap to toggle capitalization.  
Input Mode  
Indicator  
Current Mode  
Delete  
Settings  
Entering Text  
75  
 
3. Enter your text using the on-screen  
All lowercase  
keyboard.  
Displays when the next character is  
entered in lowercase.  
If you make a mistake, tap  
single character. Touch and hold  
an entire word.  
to erase a  
to erase  
Initial Uppercase  
Displays when the first character of  
eachwordisenteredasuppercasebut  
all subsequent characters are  
lowercase.  
4. Tap  
to send the message.  
Send  
Using Symbol/Numeric Mode  
Use the Symbol/Numeric Mode to add numbers,  
symbols, or emoticons. While in this mode, the  
text mode key displays  
All Uppercase  
.
ABC  
Displays when all characters will be  
entered as uppercase characters.  
1. From a screen where you can enter text,  
tap the text input field to reveal the on-  
screen keyboard. Rotate the phone  
counterclockwise to a landscape  
orientation, if desired.  
By default, the first letter of a new entry is  
capitalized and the following letters are  
lowercased. After a character is entered, the  
cursor automatically advances to the next space.  
?123  
2. Tap  
Symbol mode. Once in this mode, the text  
input type shows  
to configure the keyboard for  
Using ABC Mode in Samsung Keypad  
1. From a screen where you can enter text,  
tap the text input field to reveal the on-  
screen keyboard.  
.
ABC  
3. Tap a number, symbol, or emoticon  
character.  
4. Tap  
to return to ABC mode.  
ABC  
ABC  
2. Tap  
ABC mode. Once in this mode, the text  
input type shows  
to configure the keyboard for  
.
?123  
Note: After typing an initial uppercase character,  
the key changes to and all letters  
that follow are in lower case.  
76  
   
To enter symbols:  
?123  
2. Set any of the following options:  
• Portrait keypad types allows you to choose a  
keypad configuration (Qwerty Keypad [default] or  
3x4 Keypad).  
1. Tap  
to configure the keyboard for  
Symbol mode.  
2. Tap the appropriate symbol key.  
– or –  
• Input languages sets the input language. Tap a  
language from the available list. The keyboard is  
updated to the selected language.  
1/3  
Tap  
button to cycle through  
additional pages.  
• XT9 enables predictive text entry mode. This  
must be enabled to gain access to the advanced  
settings.  
The first number on this key indicates which  
page (1, 2, or 3) of additional characters is  
active.  
• XT9 advanced settings configuration of more  
advanced XT9 features. For more information,  
Using XT9 Predictive Text  
XT9 is a predictive text system that has next-  
letter prediction and regional error correction.  
• Keypad sweeping allows changing between the  
input modes without having to use the Input  
Mode key. You can "sweep" the displayed  
keypad aside, in a similar manner to scrolling  
through the Home screens.  
Note: XT9 is only available when ABC mode is  
selected. XT9 advanced settings are  
available only if the XT9 field has been  
selected.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
• Auto-capitalization automatically capitalizes  
the first letter of the first word in each sentence  
(standard English style).  
Language and keyboard  
keypad.  
Samsung  
– or –  
• Voice input activates the Voice input feature.  
This is an experimental feature that uses  
Google’s networked speech recognition  
application.  
From within an active text entry screen,  
tap from the bottom of the screen to  
reveal the Samsung keypad settings  
screen.  
• Auto full stop automatically inserts a full stop by  
tapping the space bar twice.  
Entering Text  
77  
     
Tutorial launches a brief onscreen tutorial  
covering the main concepts related to the  
Samsung keypad.  
• Spell correction enables the automatic  
correction of typographical errors by selecting  
from a list of possible words that reflect both the  
characters of the keys you touched, and those of  
nearby characters. (A green check mark  
indicates the feature is enabled.)  
Using XT9 Predictive Text  
XT9 is a predictive text system that has next-  
letter prediction and regional error correction,  
which compensates for users pressing the  
wrong keys on QWERTY keyboards.  
• Next word prediction predicts the next word  
you are like to enter. (A green check mark  
indicates the feature is enabled.)  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Language and keyboard  
keypad.  
Samsung  
• Auto-append automatically adds predictions to  
the word you are typing. (A green check mark  
indicates the feature is enabled.)  
2. Tap the XT9 field. A checkmark indicates  
activation.  
• Auto-substitution allows the device to  
automatically replace misspelled or miskeyed  
words. This option reduce “typos.” (A green  
check mark indicates the feature is enabled.)  
• Regional correction automatically tries to  
correct errors caused when you tap keys  
adjacent to the correct keys. (A green check  
mark indicates the feature is enabled.  
3. Tap the XT9 advanced settings and  
configure any of the following advanced  
options:  
• Word completion tells your device to attempt to  
predict how to complete the word you have  
started. (A green check mark indicates the  
feature is enabled.)  
• Word completion point sets how many letters  
should be entered before a word prediction is  
made. Choose from 2 letters, 3 letters, 4 letters,  
or 5 letters.  
• Recapture sets the device to redisplay the word  
suggestion list after selecting the wrong word  
from the list.  
78  
   
• XT9 my words allows you to add new words to  
the built-in XT9 dictionary.  
Tap Add word.  
Use the Register to XT9 my words field to  
enter the new word.  
Tap Done to store the new word.  
• XT9 auto-substitution allows you to create a  
word rule by adding words for automatic  
substitution during text entry (for example youve  
becomes you’ve).  
Tap the XT9 auto-substitution field. Flick up or  
down to review the current list of word  
substitutions.  
Press  
and tap Add.  
Enter the original word that will be replaced in  
the Shortcut field (for example, youve).  
Enter the substitute word that will be used in the  
Substitution field (for example, you?fve).  
Tap Done to save the substitution rule.  
4. Press  
screen.  
to return to the previous  
Entering Text  
79  
Section 6: Contacts  
This section explains how to use and manage  
your Contacts List. You can save phone numbers  
to your phone’s memory.  
4. From the Manage accounts area, tap  
next to the account you want to  
synchronize.  
Accounts  
– or –  
From the Accounts menu you decide if you want  
applications to synchronize, send, and receive  
data at any given time, or if you want the  
applications to synchronize automatically. After  
determining how you want the accounts to  
synchronize, indicate which account to  
synchronize with your Contacts list.  
Tap Add account to create a new account.  
5. Tap an account type to add.  
6. Follow the on-screen instructions. The  
selected account type synchronizes with  
your Contacts list.  
Contacts List  
Creating a Contact  
1. Sign in to your Google account.  
2. Press  
and then tap  
The default  
(Settings) Accounts and sync  
.
storage location  
for saving phone  
numbers to your  
Contacts List is  
your phone’s  
– or –  
From the Home screen, tap  
(Applications) ➔  
(Settings) ➔  
Accounts and sync  
.
built-in memory.  
3. From the General sync settings section, tap  
one of the following options:  
If existing Google  
and Corporate  
email accounts  
• Background data: allows your phone to use  
data in the background.  
have been  
• Auto-sync: automatically synchronizes your  
data with the phone.  
synchronized to  
your phone, these  
will be made  
available to your device during the creation of  
80  
         
new entries. These new Contacts entries can be  
assigned or saved to synced accounts such as  
Phone, SIM, Google, or Corporate.  
T-Mobile Contacts Backup contacts are stored  
remotely on the T-Mobile servers and can later be  
retrieved even if your phone has been damaged or  
reset.  
Your phone automatically sorts the Contacts  
entries alphabetically. You can create either a  
Google contacts are shared with your existing  
Google account and can also be imported to your  
phone after you have created a Google Mail  
account.  
Phone  
,
SIM, T-Mobile Contacts Backup, Google, or  
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync contact.  
Note: Before you can save a contact to the Phone,  
Contact settings must be set to Save new  
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync (also known as  
Work or Outlook) contacts are those contacts that  
are intended to be shared with either an Exchange  
contacts to Phone  
.
®
®
Server or from within Microsoft Outlook  
.
Important! The Google and Microsoft Exchange  
ActiveSync account types are only  
visible after creating an email account  
of those types on your phone.  
Remember this choice assigns the desired default  
account storage location for new Contact entries.  
Note: When storing an entry into your SIM card,  
note that only the Name, and Number are  
saved. To save additional information for a  
particular contact, such as notes, email,  
dates, etc., it is important to save that  
Phone contacts are stored locally on the device.  
Note: If the phone is ever reset to its factory  
default parameters, contacts stored on the  
phone can be lost.  
Contact into your phone’s onboard memory.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
SIM contacts are stored within the SIM Card.  
(
Contacts).  
2. Tap  
contact.  
Note: SIM contacts only store the Name and  
(Create contact) to create a  
Phone number for an entry.  
Contacts  
81  
   
Tap  
on the QWERTY keyboard to remove  
Note: You can also add a new contact by entering  
a previously entered phone number.  
a number from the keypad and pressing  
Tap  
to enter an additional phone number  
to remove a previously entered phone  
and then tap Add to Contacts  
Create  
Tap  
contact. Continue with step 3.  
number.  
3. Tap a destination type (Phone  
,
SIM,  
T-  
8. Enter additional information such as:  
Internet call, Email IM Groups, Ringtone  
Postal address Organization or More fields  
to input additional category information.  
Mobile Contacts backup, Google, or  
,
,
,
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync) (depending  
on where you want to save the new  
contact information).  
,
The More field contains the following options:  
Notes, Nickname, Website, Birthday, and  
Anniversary.  
4. Tap the Given name and Family name fields,  
and enter a name for this contact using the  
displayed keypad.  
Use your finger to slide the page up or down to  
see additional fields and categories.  
5. Tap the image icon and select a photo for  
this contact. Selections are: Album, or Take  
9. Tap Save to complete and store the new  
photo  
.
entry.  
6. Tap the label button (to the left of the  
To save a Number from your Keypad:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Phone number field) to select a category  
(Phone).  
such as Mobile (default), Home  
Fax Home Fax Pager Other Custom, or  
Callback  
,
Work, Work  
2. Enter a phone number using the on-screen  
,
,
,
,
keypad.  
.
3. Tap Add to Contacts  
Create contact or  
Update existing (select the Contact entry  
from the on-screen list).  
– or –  
Note: These label entries can change and are  
dependant on the selected destination type  
(ex: Callback might not appear with a  
Google account destination type).  
Press  
Create contact or Update existing (select  
the Contact entry from the on-screen list).  
and then tap Add to Contacts  
7. Tap a phone number field and enter a  
phone number.  
82  
     
If you're updating an existing contact, tap the  
entry from the list and proceed to step 5.  
Finding a Contact  
You can store phone numbers and their  
4. Tap a destination type (Phone  
,
SIM, T-  
corresponding names onto either your SIM card,  
your phone’s built-in memory, or an external  
location (such as Google, Exchange, or T-Mobile  
Backup). They are all physically separate but are  
used as a single entity, called Contacts.  
Mobile Contacts backup, Google, or  
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync) (depending  
on where you want to save the new  
contact information).  
Depending on the storage size of the particular  
SIM card, the maximum number of phone  
numbers the card can store may differ.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
5. Tap the Given name and Family name fields,  
and enter a name for this contact.  
6. Tap the label button (to the left of the  
Phone number field) to select a category  
(Contacts).  
such as Mobile (default), Home  
Fax Home Fax Pager Other Custom, or  
Callback  
,
Work, Work  
2. Swipe up or down until you see the contact  
,
,
,
,
displayed.  
– or –  
.
Note: These label entries can change and are  
dependant on the selected destination type  
(ex: Callback might not appear with a  
Google account destination type).  
Tap the Search contacts field and begin  
entering the entry’s name. Matching  
entries are then displayed. This process  
filters through all of your current account  
Contact entries to only show you the  
matching entries.  
7. Tap Save to complete and store the new  
entry.  
– or –  
Note: For further details about how to enter  
In a single motion, touch and hold the  
letter tab area (on the right) until on-screen  
letters appear, then scroll through the list.  
You are then taken to that section of the  
Contacts list. Touch the contact entry.  
Contacts  
83  
 
Editing Contact Information  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Search  
Contacts  
field  
.
2. Tap a contact name from the list.  
Tabs  
3. Press  
and select Edit.  
Create  
Contact  
Note: You can also access an entry’s context  
menu by touching and holding an entry then  
tapping Edit  
.
4. Edit the contact information then tap Save  
.
Tabbed  
Navigation  
Contacts  
Context Menu  
84  
 
The More field contains the following options:  
Notes, Nickname, Website, Birthday, and  
Anniversary.  
Adding a Number to an Existing  
Contact  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Touch and  
hold an  
.
Use your finger to slide the page up or down to  
see additional fields and categories.  
entry and  
5. Tap Save to complete and store the new  
select Edit  
to reveal  
the Contact  
entry’s  
entry.  
Deleting Contacts  
This option allows you to delete your contacts.  
You can delete all your entries from your phone’s  
memory, your SIM card, FDN, or All.  
details  
screen  
Important! Once Contacts List entries are deleted,  
3. Tap a  
phone  
they cannot be recovered.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Touch and hold a contact name from the  
list and select Delete OK  
.
number  
field and  
enter a  
Contact Details Screen  
.
Contact List Options  
phone number.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Tap  
on the QWERTY keyboard to remove  
2. Press  
. The following options display:  
a previously entered phone number.  
• Delete: allows you to delete 1 or more of your  
contacts.  
Tap  
to enter an additional phone number  
to remove a previously entered phone  
Tap  
• My profile allows you to set up a profile for yourself.  
:
number.  
The information will be the same that you can add for a  
new contact.  
4. Enter additional information such as:  
Internet call, Email IM Groups, Ringtone  
Postal address Organization or More fields  
to input additional category information.  
,
,
,
Press  
and tap Edit to alter this profile information.  
,
Contacts  
85  
       
• Sync contacts: allows you to manually  
synchronize all of your current contacts with their  
respective accounts.  
Send message: allows you to send a text or  
picture message.  
Display options: allows you to choose to only  
display contacts that have phone numbers, sort  
by Given or Family name, display contacts Given  
(first) name first or Family (last) name first,  
display contacts stored to your SIM card, display  
contacts stored on your phone, and/or display  
contacts stored to other accounts. For more  
• Merge with Google: allows you to merge all of  
your current Contact entries with your active  
Google/Gmail account. If several of your contacts  
are from other sources such as Corporate email,  
Internet email, Facebook, etc.., this allows you to  
“back them up” or copy them to your Gmail  
account. Tap Merge to continue or Cancel to  
exit.  
• Import/Export: imports or exports contacts to or  
from the SIM card or SD card, you can also send  
namecards via methods such as Bluetooth,  
Email, Gmail, or Messaging.  
Settings: allows you to configure where you  
save new contacts, or view your Own numbers,  
or Service numbers.  
Contact Menu Options  
• More  
:
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
View Friends: allows you to view only those  
Contact entries that have been added from  
Social Networking Sites (SNS) such as Facebook.  
Accounts: allows you to add and manage  
mobile accounts on Facebook, Twitter, or  
MySpace. You can also add Corporate or Google  
accounts.  
2. Touch and hold an entry to reveal the  
context menu. The following options  
display:  
• Edit: allows you to edit the currently selected  
Contacts entry.  
• Delete: allows you to delete the currently  
selected Contacts entry.  
Speed dial setting: allows you to set up speed-  
dialing.  
• Join contact: allows you to link the current  
contact to another current contact. Similar to a  
“see also” feature. If you can’t remember a  
contact’s information, linking entries can help  
you find the person you are looking for.  
Send email: allows you to send an email using  
your Google account.  
86  
               
• Send contact information: allows you to send  
the current entry info via text message.  
• Add to Favorites: allows you to copy the current  
Contacts entry to the list within the Favorites tab.  
• Remove from Favorites: allows you to remove  
the current Contacts entry from the Favorites  
tab.  
Contact Entry Options  
1. From the  
Home  
screen,  
tap  
.
2. Tap an entry  
to reveal the  
Contact  
• Add to group: allows you to add the current  
Contacts entry to an existing group.  
entry’s  
Overview  
Screen. This  
screen  
• Add to black list/ Remove from black list  
:
allows you to add or remove the current Contacts  
entry to a list of automatically rejected incoming  
phone numbers.  
contains  
Name,  
contact  
• Send namecard via: allows you to send the  
current Contact entry’s information to an external  
Contact Overview Screen  
numbers,  
recipient via either Bluetooth  
,
Email (Exchange  
email, and linked contact information.  
3. Press to reveal the context menu  
specific to this entry.  
4. Tap an available option.  
or Internet), Gmail, or Messaging  
.
Contacts  
87  
         
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Joining Contact Information  
2. Tap a contact name (the name you want to  
Most people now maintain multiple email  
accounts, social networking logins, and other  
similar account information. For example, a  
Facebook account login name might differ from a  
corporate email account login because they are  
maintained separately and for different groups of  
people.  
link to another entry) to reveal the Contact  
entry’s Overview Screen  
.
Note: Typically this is the same contact with a  
different name or account information.  
3. Press  
and then tap Join contact.  
This device can synchronize with multiple  
accounts (such as Facebook, Twitter, Linkedin,  
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync, Google, or  
T-Mobile). When you synchronize your phone  
with those accounts, each account creates a  
separate contact entry in the Contacts list.  
4. Tap the second contact entry (the entry in  
which to link). The second contact is now  
linked with the first and the account  
information is merged into one screen.  
Note: The information is still maintained in both  
entries, but displays in one record for easier  
viewing when you link the contacts.  
If one of your contacts (Amy Smith) has a regular  
email account that you maintain in Gmail, but  
also has a Facebook account under her maiden  
and married name, as well as a Video! chat  
account, when you merge those accounts into  
your Contacts list you can join all of her entries  
and view the information in one record.  
Important! It is the second contact image that is  
displayed for both, but the first  
contact’s name that is used.  
Joining contact information makes sending  
messages easy. You can select any account  
email address or information all from one screen,  
versus searching multiple, individual screens to  
locate the desired account information.  
For example: If Amy (original entry) is  
joined with Julie (second entry). Julie  
appears to disappear and only Amy  
remains. Tap the Amy entry (showing  
the Julie image) to view both.  
Next time you synchronize your phone with your  
accounts, any updates contacts make to email  
account names, email addresses, etc.  
automatically update in your contacts list.  
88  
   
5. Tap the main linked contact to view the  
contact information you linked. The  
contacts and information displays with an  
icon next to the contact name to indicate  
what type of account information is  
contained in the entry.  
Marking a Contact as Default  
When you use applications such as the Voice  
Dialer or other messaging type applications, the  
application needs to know which information is  
primary (default) in a contact entry list. For  
example, when you say “Call John Smith”, if you  
have three phone records for John Smith, the  
Voice dialer is looking for the “default” number  
or entry.  
Unjoining a Contact  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. Tap a contact name (the account name  
from which you want to unjoin an entry).  
This reveals the details for entry.  
The Mark as default option marks one entry in a  
contact record to use as the default. This comes  
in handy when you have multiple entries for the  
same person.  
Note: Typically this is the same contact with a  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
different name or account information.  
2. Tap a Contact entry.  
3. Press  
and then tap Mark as default.  
3. Tap the Joined contacts area.  
The Mark as default screen displays radio  
buttons next to the contact name, phone  
number, or other contact information.  
4. Tap the radio button next to the entry  
information you want to be the primary  
information (such as name, phone number,  
– or –  
Press  
and then tap Separate contact.  
4. Tap  
next to the entry you want to  
unjoin. The contacts are “unjoined” or  
separated and no longer display in the  
merged record screen. Both contacts now  
go back to being separately displayed.  
or email) and select Save  
.
Note: If there are multiple phone numbers  
assigned to an entry, assigning one as the  
default will automatically dial that number  
when the contact is selected for dialing.  
Contacts  
89  
 
4. Tap Send and select a delivery method:  
• Bluetooth to transmit this contact to another  
bluetooth-compatible device.  
Sending a Namecard  
A Namecard contains contact information, and  
can be sent to recipients as a Virtual Business  
Card (V-card) attachment using Bluetooth,  
Google Mail, or as a message.  
• Email to attach the contact card to a new  
outgoing email (Exchange or Internet).  
• Gmail to attach the contact card to a new  
outgoing Internet-based email.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. Tap a Contact entry.  
3. Press  
via and select a delivery method:  
Bluetooth Email Gmail, or Messaging.  
and then tap Send namecard  
• Messaging to attach the contact card to a new  
outgoing text message.  
,
,
Sending a namecard using Bluetooth  
You must create a Contact prior to sending a  
namecard to a recipient. For more information,  
refer to “Creating a Contact” on page 80.  
The Namecard attaches to the selected  
message type and is delivered when you  
send the message.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Note: Email appears as an option only after an  
Internet or Exchange email account has  
been created.  
2. Touch and hold the entry to reveal the on-  
screen context menu.  
3. Tap Send namecard via  
Bluetooth.  
Sending All Current Namecards  
Rather than selecting once Contact entry at a  
time, you can send all of your current entries at  
once.  
Important! You must activate Bluetooth to use this  
feature.  
4. Tap the Bluetooth device in which to send  
this name card. Bluetooth forwards the  
namecard to the recipient.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Press and then tap Import/Export Ô  
Send namecard via  
.
.
3. Tap Select all to place a check mark  
alongside all currently displayed Contact  
entries.  
90  
             
Copying Contact Information  
Note: These must be contacts stored on the  
phone. External entries (Google, Exchange,  
etc...) can not be transferred in this manner.  
Copying Contact Information to the  
SIM Card  
The default storage location for saving phone  
numbers to your Contacts list is your phone’s  
built-in memory. This procedure allows you to  
copy numbers saved to the phone’s memory,  
onto the SIM card.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. From the Contacts List, press  
and  
then tap Import/Export  
card  
Export to SD  
.
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
3. Tap OK to choose all current phone contact  
2. From the Contacts List, press  
and  
entries.  
then tap Import/Export  
card  
Export to SIM  
Synchronizing Contacts  
.
Syncing data from your managed accounts  
allows you to add and manage a new or existing  
contact from your online or remote accounts to  
your phone. Prior to syncing, you must first have  
an active Google or Microsoft Exchange account  
with current Contact entries, and be signed into  
your account via the phone.  
3. Tap Select all to choose all current phone  
contact entries.  
– or –  
Select a specific entry by touching an  
entry. A check mark indicates a selection.  
4. Tap Export. The name and phone number  
for the selected contact is then copied to  
the SIM.  
With syncing, any Contacts entries (with phone  
numbers, email addresses, pictures, etc.) are  
updated and synced with your phone. For more  
information about syncing existing managed  
Copying Contact Information to the  
microSD Card  
This procedure allows you to copy entry  
information saved on the phone’s memory, onto  
the SIM card.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Accounts and sync  
.
2. Locate the email account containing the  
contacts you wish to synchronize.  
Contacts  
91  
           
3. Tap  
within the adjacent account field  
• Only contacts with phones allows you to  
display only those contacts containing phone  
numbers.  
to reveal the account’s synchronization  
settings screen.  
4. To synchronize Contacts, tap Sync  
Contacts. A green checkmark indicates the  
feature is enabled.  
• Sort by defines how the current list of Contacts  
are sorted: Given name or Family name  
.
• Display contacts by defines how the current list  
of Contacts are listed: Given name first (ex:  
Steve Smith) or Family name first (Smith,  
Steve).  
Note: The process of updating your Contacts tab  
can take several minutes. If after 10-20  
minutes, your list has not been updated,  
repeat step 2-3.  
• Select contacts to display allows you to filter  
Contacts based on category entries from within  
the locations such as: Phone  
Contacts Backup Google, and Microsoft  
Exchange ActiveSync  
3. Tap Done  
,
SIM, T-Mobile  
5. Your Contacts tab then reflects any  
,
updated Contact information.  
.
Note: Syncing of contacts requires you are logged  
into your Gmail and Corporate accounts via  
the device.  
.
Adding more Contacts via  
Accounts and Sync  
When you synchronize applications such as  
Facebook, Twitter, Linkedin, a corporate email  
account, or Google, using the Accounts and sync  
option synchronizes the data from the selected  
account type with your Contacts list.  
Display Options  
The Display options menu allows you to allows  
you to choose whether to display contacts saved  
from the Phone, SIM, T-Mobile Contacts Backup,  
external source, or all. You can also choose to  
display only contacts that have phone numbers.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Add account  
Accounts and sync  
.
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Press and then tap More  
.
Display  
options. Configure any of the following  
options:  
92  
                   
2. Determine which type of account  
information you want to synchronize with  
your Contact list. Selections are: Facebook,  
Twitter, Linkedin, Microsoft Exchange  
ActiveSync, Google, Blio (T-Mobile),  
Samsung account, Video Chat, or  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Add account  
Accounts and sync  
Facebook.  
2. Accept the terms of the Social Hub, tap the  
I accept all terms above field, then select  
Agree  
3. Read the on-screen descriptions and tap  
Next  
4. Log into your Facebook account:  
Enter your account’s access Email and  
Password information and tap Log in  
.
T-Mobile Contacts Backup  
.
3. Tap an account type to add.  
.
4. Follow the prompts. The selected account  
type synchronizes with your Contacts list.  
5. After synchronizing accounts you may  
want to link contact information. For more  
.
5. Tap those contact settings you wish to  
synchronize (all are enabled by default). A  
green circle indicates the feature is  
enabled.  
To add Facebook content to your Contacts list:  
Choose from: Sync contacts  
,
Sync message,  
You can now add your Facebook contact  
information, such as pictures, email, and phone  
numbers directly to your Contacts list. All of their  
current contact information is then migrated over  
to your phone. If a Contacts entry already exists  
with a slightly different name, separate entries  
are created and can later be linked (joined)  
together into a single entry.  
or Sync calendar  
.
6. Tap Done to complete the login and sync  
process.  
7. Tap  
to confirm your Facebook  
contacts are now synchronized and appear  
in your Contacts list.  
To resync Social Network Contacts:  
Important! This process not only synchronizes  
your contact information but also your  
status, events, and more.  
1. Press  
Accounts and sync.  
2. Tap within the adjacent SNS account  
field to reveal the account’s  
and then tap  
synchronization settings screen.  
Contacts  
93  
         
3. Tap Sync Contacts  
.
3. Tap the contact(s) to which you want to  
send an email. A check mark displays next  
to the selection.  
My Profile  
You can send this Virtual Business Card (V-card)  
to other contacts as an attachment. My Profile is  
the first Contact listed in the Contacts list.  
Note: The select contact must have an email as  
part of their details screen.  
Note: As with any profile, your profile can be  
4. Tap Send  
.
associated with a group.  
5. Select an email account type.  
To create My Profile:  
6. Compose the email and tap Send  
.
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Export/Import  
2. Press  
and then tap My profile.  
To edit My Profile:  
1. With My profile displayed, press  
then tap Edit  
2. Modify any of the information contained in  
My Profile, then tap Save  
and  
Contact List Settings  
.
From this menu you can determine the default  
storage location for Contacts, display your  
phone’s primary number, and view service  
numbers listed in your Contact list.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Press and then tap More  
.
Additional Contact Options  
Sending an Email to a Contact  
.
Settings.  
Note: Contacts must contain and email account  
and address before you can use the Send  
email feature.  
Important! The Google and Microsoft Exchange  
ActiveSync account types are only  
visible after creating an email account  
of those types on your phone.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Press and then tap More  
.
Send  
3. Select one of the following options:  
email. Contacts that contain an email  
address display.  
94  
               
• Save new contacts to: defines the default  
4. Tap Ringtone and select a ringtone for the  
storage location of new Contacts. Choose from:  
group. Selections are: Default ringtone,  
Always ask  
Backup Google, or Microsoft Exchange  
ActiveSync  
,
Phone  
,
SIM  
,
T-Mobile Contacts  
Select sound from My files, or Phone  
ringtone.  
,
.
5. Tap Save to store the newly created group.  
• Service numbers: displays the available service  
numbers.  
Note: Some externally maintained group types  
(such as Google) can only be managed or  
updated remotely online vs via the phone.  
These external types will not allow editing  
or deleting members locally via the phone.  
• Send contact: allows you to define what set of  
namecards are sent when you choose to send  
namecards to other sources.  
Read the on-screen description of this feature  
and tap Next  
Select either Send all namecards or Send  
individual namecards  
.
Adding an Existing Entry to a Current  
Caller Group  
.
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Groups  
Groups  
2. Tap a group entry ➔  
(
Add group  
This feature allows you to add a new or existing  
contact to a call group. This group can be one of  
the already present groups (Family, Friends, or  
Work) or a user-created group.  
member).  
3. From the available list of contacts, tap the  
contact(s) you want to add. A check mark  
displays next to contact entry.  
Creating a New Caller Group  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
4. Tap Add. The selected contacts are added  
to the group.  
(Groups tab).  
Groups  
RemovinganEntryFromaCallerGroup  
2. Press  
and then tap Create  
.
1. From the Home screen, tap  
3. Tap the Group name field and use the on-  
screen keypad to enter a new group name.  
.
Groups  
2. Tap a group entry.  
3. Press  
and then tap Remove member  
.
Contacts 95  
           
4. Tap all of the contacts you want to remove  
from this group. A checkmark displays  
next to contact entry.  
Sending a Message to a Group  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Groups  
5. Tap Remove.The contacts are removed  
from the group.  
2. Tap an  
existing  
group, and  
press  
Editing a Caller Group  
To edit a Group entry, there must be at least one  
and then tap  
Send  
member as part of the selected group.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
message  
– or –  
.
.
Groups  
2. Touch and hold a group entry then select  
Edit group  
Touch and  
hold a group  
entry and  
select Send  
message  
.
3. Make modifications to the Group name or  
Ringtone fields. For more information, refer  
to “Creating a New Caller Group” on page  
95.  
.
4. Tap Save  
.
3. Select the recipients of the new message  
(indicated by a green checkmark). If an  
entry contains multiple phone numbers,  
each must be selected individually.  
Deleting a Caller Group  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
Groups  
4. Tap Send  
.
2. Press  
and then tap Delete.  
5. Type your message, and tap Send  
.
3. Select either Select all or tap the desired  
group.  
4. Tap Delete  
.
96  
       
The Favorites Tab  
The Favorites tab is a list of the phone numbers  
that have been designated as favorite contacts.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Tap Favorites tab).  
.
(
Favorites  
Adding a contact to your favorites list:  
3. From within the Favorites tab, press  
and select Add to favorites  
.
4. Place a check mark alongside those  
current Contacts entries you wish to assign  
as favorites.  
5. Tap Add to complete the process.  
Contacts  
97  
     
Section 7: Messaging  
This section describes how to send or receive  
different types of messages. It also explains the  
features and functionality associated with  
messaging.  
and from other mobile phones or email  
addresses. To use this feature, you may need to  
subscribe to your service provider’s multimedia  
message service.  
Types of Messages  
Important! When creating a message, adding an  
image, a sound file, or a video clip to a  
text message changes the message  
from a text message to a multimedia  
message.  
Your phone provides the following message  
types:  
Text Messages  
Multimedia (Picture, Video, and Audio) Messages  
Email and Gmail Messages  
Google Talk  
Messaging icons are displayed at the top of the  
screen and indicate when messages are  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Message Icons on the Status Bar  
Icons are displayed on the Status Bar at the top  
of the display when new messages are received.  
(Messaging) ➔  
(New message).  
2. Tap the Enter recipient field to manually  
Creating and Sending  
Messages  
enter a recipient.  
– or –  
The Short Message Service (SMS) lets you send  
and receive text messages to and from other  
mobile phones or email addresses. To use this  
feature, you may need to subscribe to your  
service provider’s message service.  
Tap  
following:  
to select from one of the  
• Contacts: to select a recipient from your  
Contacts list (valid entries must have a wireless  
phone number or email address).  
The Multimedia Messaging Service (MMS) lets  
you send and receive multimedia messages  
(such as picture, video, and audio messages) to  
• Recent: to select a recipient from a list of  
recently sent messages.  
98  
               
• Groups: to select a recipient from the Group list.  
• Favorites: to select a recipient from the  
Favorites list.  
Message Options  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Messaging).  
3. If adding a recipient from either Recent,  
Contacts, or Group, tap the contact to  
place a checkmark then tap Add. The  
contact displays in the recipient field.  
2. From within an open message, press  
to display additional messaging options:  
• Insert smiley: allows you to add insert  
smiley icons images (emoticons).  
• Call: places an outgoing call to the sender.  
• Add text: allows you to add text items from  
sources such as: Location, Contacts,  
Calendar, Memo, Text, and Text templates.  
• Add to Contacts: allows you to add the new  
recipient to your current Contacts list as a new  
entry.  
Note: Delete any unnecessary members in the list  
by selecting the trash can icon and deleting  
unwanted entries.  
4. Tap the Tap to enter message field and use  
the on-screen keypad to enter a message.  
• Add/Remove slide: converts an SMS message  
into an MMS (Multimedia) message and allows  
you to attach an existing slideshow.  
5. Add more recipients by tapping either the  
Enter recipient field or  
and selecting  
recipients.  
Once the message has been converted into in an  
MMS message, press and tap More to  
6. Review your message and tap Send.  
choose from these options: Add slide, Remove  
slide, Add subject, Duration (5 sec), Layout  
(bottom), or Delete message.  
Note: If you exit a message before you tap send  
the message automatically saves as a draft.  
• More: (when in an SMS message - plain text)  
provides additional options such as: Add subject  
and Delete messages.  
Messaging  
99  
         
To reply to a text  
message:  
1. From the  
Home  
Viewing Newly Received  
Messages  
Current Recipient  
My Text  
When you receive a message, your phone  
notifies you by displaying  
within the  
screen, tap  
.
Notification area at the top left of your Home  
screen.  
2. While the  
message is  
open, tap  
To read a message:  
1. Open the Notification Bar and select the  
– or –  
the Type to  
compose  
field and  
then type  
From the Home screen, tap  
then tap  
your reply  
message.  
3. Compose  
your reply.  
Your texts  
the new message to view its contents. The  
selected message displays on the screen.  
Reply Bubble  
Text Message Thread  
2. Tap  
to play a multimedia message.  
3. In a single motion, touch and scroll up or  
down the page to scroll through the  
are colored Blue and your caller’s replies are  
Yellow.  
message (if additional pages were added).  
Message Threads  
4. Tap Send to review your reply.  
Sent and received text and picture messages are  
grouped into message threads. Threaded  
messages allow you to see all the messages  
exchanged (similar to a chat program) and  
displays a contact on the screen.  
– or –  
Press  
and then select one of the  
available message options (page 99).  
To access message thread options:  
Message threads are listed in the order in which  
they were received, with the latest message  
displayed at the top.  
From the main Messaging screen, touch  
and hold the message to display the  
following options:  
100  
           
• View contact: displays the Contact’s Overview  
page.  
Deleting Messages  
Deleting a message thread  
• Add to Contacts: begins the process of adding  
the new number to your Contacts list.  
• Delete thread: deletes the currently selected  
message thread.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. Touch and hold a message from the  
Messages list, then select Delete thread  
.
3. At the prompt, tap OK to delete or Cancel to  
To access additional Bubble options:  
exit.  
From within the message string screen,  
touch and hold the message bubble to  
display the following options:  
• Delete message: deletes the currently selected  
message bubble from the thread.  
Deleting a single message  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. Open a message to reveal the message  
string.  
3. Touch and hold a message bubble, then  
• Add to Contacts: adds the current caller to your  
Contacts list.  
select Delete message  
.
4. At the prompt, tap OK to delete or Cancel to  
• Copy message text: copies the currently  
selected message bubble from the thread.  
• Lock/Unlock message: locks or unlocks the  
currently selected message bubble from being  
accidentally deleted.  
exit.  
Deleting multiple messages  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. Press  
and then tap Delete threads.  
3. Tap each message thread you want to  
• Forward: allows you to forward the currently  
selected message bubble to an external  
recipient.  
delete. A checkmark displays beside each  
selected message.  
4. Tap Delete  
.
• Copy to SIM: copies the currently selected  
message bubble as a single text message within  
the SIM card.  
5. At the prompt, tap OK to delete or Cancel to  
end the process.  
• View message details: displays details for the  
currently selected message bubble.  
Messaging  
101  
           
Storage settings  
Message Search  
• Delete old messages: deletes old messages  
You can search through your messages by using  
the Message Search feature.  
when the limit is reached, rather than overwriting  
them.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Press and then tap Search  
.
Text message limit: allows you to set a limit on  
how many text messages are allowed in one  
conversation.  
.
3. Use the on-screen keypad to enter a word  
or phrase in which to search, then tap  
.
• Multimedia message limit: allows you to set a  
limit on how many multimedia messages are  
allowed in one conversation.  
4. All messages that contain the entered  
search string display.  
Text message (SMS) settings  
Messaging Settings  
• Delivery reports: when this option is activated,  
To configure the settings for text messages,  
multimedia messages, Voice mails, and Push  
messages.  
the network informs you whether or not your  
message was delivered.  
• Manage SIM card messages: allows you to  
manage the messages stored on the SIM card.  
• Message Center: allows you to enter the  
number of your message center where your  
messages reside while the system is attempting  
to deliver them.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
2. Press and then tap Settings  
.
.
The following Messaging settings are available:  
Settings  
• Message font size: enables the phone to  
change the display size for the on-screen front.  
Choose from: Normal, Small, or Tiny.  
• Input mode: allows you to set the input mode for  
your text messages. Choose from: GSM  
Alphabet, Unicode, or Automatic.  
• Background color: enables the phone to display  
the messages using different contrasting colors  
schemes. The background color options are:  
Black or White.  
102  
             
Multimedia message (MMS) settings  
Notification settings  
• Delivery reports: when this option is activated,  
• Notifications: allows you to see message  
the network informs you whether or not your  
message was delivered.  
notifications on your status bar.  
• Select ringtone: allows you to set the ringtone  
for your message notifications.  
• Read reports: when this option is activated, your  
phone receives a request for a read reply along  
with your message to the recipient.  
Text Templates  
This screen displays your available text message  
reply templates. This is a readily accessible list  
of both default and user-defined text snippets  
that can be used to quickly reply to incoming  
messages.  
• Auto-retrieve: allows the message system to  
automatically retrieve messages.  
• Roaming auto-retrieve: allows the message  
system to automatically retrieve while roaming.  
• Creation mode: allows you to select the creation  
mode: Free, Restricted, or Warning.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
2. From the Messaging list, press  
and  
then tap Text templates  
.
Restricted: you can only create and submit  
messages with content belonging to the Core  
MM Content Domain.  
3. Tap a message to immediately insert it into  
your current message conversation.  
To create your own text template:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Warning: the phone will warn you via pop up  
messages that you are creating a multimedia  
message which does not fit the Core MM  
Content Domain.  
.
2. From the Messaging list, press  
and  
then tap Text templates  
3. Tap Create template).  
4. Enter a new text string and tap Save  
.
Free: you may add any content to the message.  
(
Push message settings  
.
• Push message: allows you to receive push  
messages from the network.  
• Service loading: allows you to set the type of  
service loading notification. Choose from:  
Always, Prompt, or Never.  
Messaging  
103  
       
Creating an Internet Email Account  
Email  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Email (or Internet Email) enables you to review  
and create email using several email services.  
You can also receive text message alerts when  
you receive an important email. Your phone’s  
Email application lets you access and manage  
multiple email accounts simultaneously in one  
convenient location.  
(Applications) ➔  
(Email).  
2. If you already have other email account  
setup:  
Tap the account name field (upper-right) to open  
the complete email account list page.  
Press  
and then tap Add account.  
There are currently three main types of email  
accounts on your phone: Gmail, Internet-based  
email (Gmail, Yahoo, etc..), and Microsoft  
Exchange (Corporate email or Outlook®).  
Account name  
To send and receive email messages through an  
ISP (Internet Service Provider) account, or if you  
wish to use your device to access your corporate  
email through a VPN (Virtual Private Network),  
you will first need to set up an IMAP or POP  
account.  
– or –  
IMAP (Internet Message Access Protocol) - This  
protocol is frequently used in large networks and  
commercial settings. IMAP4 is the current standard.  
POP3 (Post Office Protocol) - This protocol is  
supported by most ISPs (Internet service providers)  
and common among consumer applications. POP3  
is the current standard.  
Enter your Email address and Password  
information. Tap Show password to view  
the password string as you enter it.  
• Email address: your Outlook work email  
address.  
• Password: typically your network access  
password (case-sensitive).  
Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync - This protocol is  
frequently used with a large corporate email server  
system and provides access to email, contact, and  
calendar synchronization.  
104  
             
3. Tap Send email from this account by default  
to make this not only your default email  
account, but also link it to your Social Hub  
Important! Only some “Plus” accounts include  
POP access allowing this program to  
connect. If you are not able to sign in  
with your correct email address and  
password, you may not have a paid  
“Plus” account. Launch the Web  
4. Tap Next. If prompted to sign up to Social  
Hub, tap OK  
.
browser to access your account.  
Tap Manual setup to configure your connection  
settings manually (POP3 or IMAP). Follow the  
on-screen prompts and enter the information  
specific to your email provider.  
Opening an Email  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Email).  
The unique account name is used to differentiate  
this account from other email accounts  
accessed by your device.  
2. Tap the account name field (upper-right) to  
open the complete email account list page.  
3. Select an email account and tap an email  
message.  
5. At the Set up email screen, name the  
account and enter a screen name to  
identify yourself on this account. If you  
have already setup this account, skip to  
step 7.  
Refreshing Email messages  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Email).  
6. Messages for this account display on the  
Inbox tab. You can also view Personal  
information for this account, Receipts (if  
you setup the account to return receipts),  
Travel information, and more (if available).  
7. Tap Done to store the new account.  
2. Select an email account.  
If you are already in an email account, tap the  
account name field (upper-right) to open the  
complete email account list page.  
Select an available email account.  
3. Press  
and then tap Refresh.  
Messaging  
105  
     
Tap  
to delete the attached file.  
Composing Email  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
To insert a Gallery, Contacts, Location, Calendar,  
and Memo item, tap Insert and make a  
selection.  
(Email).  
2. Tap the account name field (upper-right) to  
open the complete email account list page.  
Tap the file you wish to attach.  
3. Tap Inbox  
(Compose).  
Note: If you attach an image to your email, you  
have the option to resize it prior to delivery.  
Choose from: Original, Large (70%),  
4. Enter the recipient’s email address in the  
To field.  
If you are sending the email message to several  
recipients, separate the email addresses with a  
comma. You can add as many message  
recipients as you want.  
Medium (30%), or Small (10%). Once  
chosen, tap OK  
.
8. Once complete, tap Send  
.
5. Press  
and then tap Add Cc/Bcc to add  
Configuring Email Settings  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
additional carbon copy recipients.  
Use the Cc field to carbon copy additional  
recipients.  
(
Email).  
2. Select an account.  
Use the Bcc field to blind copy additional  
recipients.  
3. From the email list screen, press  
and  
then tap More  
Account settings.  
6. Tap the Subject field and enter the email  
subject.  
4. Alter any of the following settings:  
• Account name: displays your uniquely created  
account display name.  
7. Tap the email text field and compose your  
email message.  
Your name: displays the name used in the From  
field of your outgoing email messages.  
To add a n attachment (such as image, video,  
audio, etc..), tap Attach (from the bottom of the  
screen) and make a category selection.  
• Add signature: Lets you attach a customized  
signature to the bottom of all outgoing emails.  
• Signature: Lets you create an email signature  
for your outgoing Gmail email messages.  
Tap the file you wish to attach. If selecting an  
image, you can choose to select a variation of  
the image size.  
106  
   
• Email check frequency: adjusts the time  
interval used by your device to check your email  
account for new email messages.  
Microsoft Exchange Email  
(Outlook)  
Your phone also provides access to your  
company’s Outlook Exchange server. If your  
company uses either Microsoft Exchange Server  
2003 or 2007, you can use this email application  
to wirelessly synchronize your email, Contacts,  
and Calendar information directly with your  
company’s Exchange server.  
• Default account: Assign this account as the  
default email account used for outgoing  
messages.  
• Always Cc/Bcc myself allows you to include  
your own email address in either the CC, Bcc, or  
None fields. Lets you always receive a copy of  
outgoing emails.  
SettingUpaMicrosoftExchangeEmail  
account  
• Email notifications: Activates the email  
notification icon to appear within the Notifications  
area of the status bar when a new Internet mail  
(Gmail, etc..) is received.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Email).  
(
2. If you already have other email account  
setup:  
• Select ringtone: Plays a selected ringtone when  
a new email message is received.  
Tap the account name field (upper-left) to open  
the complete email account list page.  
• Vibrate: Activates a vibration when a new email  
message is received.  
Press  
and then tap Add account.  
• Incoming settings: Lets you specify incoming  
email settings, such as User name, Password,  
IMAP server, Security type, Port, and IMAP path  
prefix.  
Account name  
• Outgoing settings: Lets you specify incoming  
email settings, such as SMTP server, Security  
type, Port, Require sign-in, User name, and  
Password.  
• Forward with files: Lets you include  
attachments when forwarding an email.  
– or –  
Messaging  
107  
     
Enter your Email address and Password  
information. Tap Show password to view  
the password string as you enter it.  
If your network requires SSL encryption, tap the  
Use secure connection (SSL) field to place a  
check mark in the box and activate this  
additional level. Most often, this option should be  
enabled.  
• Email address: your Outlook work email  
address.  
If your network requires you accept SSL  
certificates, tap the Accept all SSL certificates  
field to place a check mark in the box and  
activate this additional level. Most often, this  
option is not required. Confirm this information  
with your IT Administrator.  
• Password: typically your network access  
password  
(case-sensitive).  
3. Tap Send email from this account by  
default, to make this not only your default  
email account, but also link it to your  
Important! If your exchange server requires this  
feature, leaving this field unchecked  
can prevent connection.  
4. Tap Done  
Next. Consult your Network or  
IT Administrator for further details and  
support.  
7. Manually updated or re-enter your  
Exchange server information within the  
appropriate field. This field can often be  
populated with incorrect or out of date  
information.  
5. Tap Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync (from  
the add new email account screen).  
6. When prompted to provide additional  
detailed information, enter an updated  
Domain, and confirm your User name and  
Password information.  
• Exchange Server: your exchange server remote  
email address. Typically starts with  
Important! It will be necessary for you to enter  
your domain information before the “\”  
in front of your user name.  
mail.XXX.com. Obtain this information from  
your company network administrator. Do not  
accept the default entry as this is a guess based  
on returned information.  
108  
Composing Exchange Email  
Important! The Exchange server field may not  
reflect the desired server information.  
It is recommended that you confirm  
this information and re-enter if  
necessary.s  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Email).  
2. Tap the account name field (upper-right) to  
open the complete email account list page.  
3. Select an exchange email account.  
8. With the new server information entered,  
4. Tap Inbox and tap  
(Compose).  
tap Next  
9. Read the on-screen activation disclaimer  
and, if prompted, tap OK  
10. Adjust the various on-screen configuration  
fields and tap Next  
11. Identify your new work email account with  
.
5. Enter the recipient’s email address in the  
To field.  
.
If you are sending the email message to several  
recipients, separate the email addresses with a  
comma. You can add as many message  
recipients as you want.  
.
a unique name (Ex: Work), then tap Done  
.
6. Press  
and then tap Add Cc/Bcc to add  
Opening an Exchange Email  
additional carbon copy recipients.  
Use the Cc field to carbon copy additional  
recipients.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Email).  
Use the Bcc field to blind copy additional  
recipients.  
2. Tap the account name field (upper-right) to  
open the complete email account list page.  
3. Select an exchange email account and tap  
an email message.  
7. Tap the Subject field and enter the email  
subject.  
8. Tap the email text field and compose your  
email message.  
Refreshing Exchange Email  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
To add a picture attachment, tap Attach (from  
the bottom of the screen) and make a category  
selection.  
(
Email).  
2. Select an exchange email account.  
3. Press and then tap Refresh  
.
Messaging  
109  
     
Tap the file you wish to attach. If selecting an  
image, you can choose to select a variation of  
the image size.  
3. Toggle either the Sync Contacts or Sync  
Calendar fields to force the device to  
manually resync either the exchange  
Contacts or Calendar entries.  
– or –  
Tap  
to delete the attached file.  
Note: If you attach an image to your email, you  
have the option to resize it prior to delivery.  
Choose from: Original, Large (70%),  
Tap Account settings and specify any other  
email settings you wish to synchronize:  
• Account name displays the name used by the  
device to track the account.  
Medium (30%), or Small (10%). Once  
chosen, tap OK  
.
• Add signature activates the email signature  
feature.  
9. Once complete, tap Send  
.
Deleting an Exchange Email Message  
• Signature allows you to create an outgoing  
email signature attached to new email  
messages sent from your phone.  
Touch and hold an email (from your inbox  
list) and select Delete from the on-screen  
context menu.  
• Default account assigns this account as the  
default used when sending out new email  
messages.  
– or –  
With the email message displayed, tap  
• Always Cc/Bcc myself allows you to include  
your own email address in either the CC, Bcc, or  
None fields. Lets you always receive a copy of  
outgoing emails.  
(
Delete).  
ConfiguringMicrosoftExchangeEmail  
Settings  
1. Press  
Accounts and sync.  
2. Tap adjacent to the Microsoft  
Exchange account field to reveal the  
account’s synchronization settings screen.  
and then tap  
• Period to sync email to assign the sync range  
for your incoming and outgoing email messages  
between your phone and your external exchange  
server. How many days worth of email messages  
should the phone and server synchronize.  
Choose from: 1 day  
,
3 days, 1 week, 2 weeks,  
or 1 month  
.
110  
   
• Empty server trash: allows you to delete your  
email account’s trash bin remotely.  
• Vibrate assigns a vibration when a new or  
upcoming event is pending.  
• Sync schedule allows you to configure your  
email sync schedule.  
• Incoming settings provides access to the  
Domain, password, and Exchange server  
settings.  
• Out of office settings allows you to configure  
your email’s out of office notification settings.  
• Period to sync Calendar assigns a period for  
your phone to sync calendar events.  
• Sync Contacts synchronizes the contacts  
between your phone and the remote exchange  
server.  
• Sync Calendar synchronizes your exchange  
calendar entries between your phone and the  
remote exchange server.  
• Size to retrieve emails configures the incoming  
email size allowed to pass through to your phone  
automatically without user interaction. Emails  
with attachments larger than configured will  
have to be retrieved manually.  
• Sync Tasks synchronizes your exchange tasks  
entries between your phone and the remote  
exchange server.  
• Security options: allows you to enable several  
security options such as: Encryption, Encryption  
algorithm, Sign, Sign algorithms, Email  
certificates, and Security policy list. These  
security policies could restrict some functions  
from corporate servers.  
4. Press  
to return to the previous page.  
Using Google Mail  
Google Mail (Gmail) is Google’s web-based  
email. When you first setup the phone, Gmail is  
configured. Depending on the synchronization  
settings, Gmail is automatically synchronized  
with your Gmail account.  
Security policy list: lists the current email’s  
security policy. These policies could restrict some  
functions from corporate servers.  
Signing into Google Mail  
1. rom the Home screen, tap  
• Email notifications enables the device to  
display a status bar icon when new email  
messages have been received.  
(Gmail).  
Note: You must sign in to your Gmail account in  
order to access features such as Google  
Mail and Android Market.  
• Select ringtone assigns an audible ringtone  
when a new or upcoming event is pending.  
Messaging  
111  
             
2. Tap Next to add a Google account.  
4. Press  
and select Add Cc/Bcc to add a  
carbon or blind copy.  
3. Tap Create if you do not have a Google  
account.  
– or –  
5. Enter the subject of this message in the  
Subject field.  
6. Tap the Compose Mail field and begin  
composing your message.  
Tap Sign in if you have a Google account.  
The Inbox loads conversations and email.  
7. Once complete tap  
(Send).  
Opening Gmail  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Viewing a Gmail Message  
1. From the Gmail Inbox, tap a message to  
view the following options:  
• Archive: archives the selected Email.  
• Delete: deletes the Email.  
(
Gmail).  
2. Tap an existing email message.  
Refreshing Google Mail  
From within the Gmail message list, press  
• <: displays older Emails.  
and then tap Refresh to send and  
• >: displays newer Emails.  
receive new emails and synchronize your  
email with the Gmail account.  
2. Press  
to select one of the following  
additional options:  
• Change labels: changes the label on the email  
or conversation.  
Composing a Gmail Message  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Gmail).  
2. From the Gmail Inbox, press  
tap Compose  
• Mark unread: unread messages or threads with  
unread messages display in boldface text in the  
Inbox.  
and then  
.
3. Enter the recipients Email address in the To  
• Mark important/Not important: to change the  
important state of an email.  
field.  
• Go to inbox: displays the Google Mail Inbox.  
• Mute: mutes the conversation.  
Tip: Separate multiple recipient email addresses  
with a comma.  
112  
         
• Add/Remove star: click a message's star to  
add or remove the star (just like clicking flags in  
Outlook).  
3. Tap Add account and follow the same steps  
as referenced in the previous section. For  
• More  
:
Report spam: reports the Email message as  
spam.  
Google Talk  
Google Talk™ is a free Windows and web-based  
application for instant messaging offered by  
Google. Conversation logs are automatically  
saved to a Chats area in your Gmail account.  
This allows you to search a chat log and store  
them in your Gmail accounts.  
Settings: allows you to configure the General, or  
Notification settings.  
Help: launches the browser and displays Google  
Mobile Help information.  
Select text: allows you to select text to copy and  
paste.  
You can now use Google Talk to not only have  
voicechats but also video conferences with  
connected friends.  
Creating an Additional Gmail Account  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Gmail).  
Note: Before using this application, you must first  
have an active Gmail account available and  
be currently logged in.  
(
2. If you already have other email account  
setup:  
Tap the account name field (upper-right) to open  
the complete email account list page.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Talk).  
(
Account name  
Note: If you are not already logged into Google,  
refer to the instructions for signing in on  
2. Begin using Google Talk.  
Messaging  
113  
       
Note: The Network confirms your login and  
processes. This could take up to 5 minutes  
to complete.  
114  
Section 8: Multimedia  
This section explains how to use the multimedia  
features of your phone, including the Camera/  
Camcorder, Music Player, and how to manage  
your photos, images and sounds.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Camera).  
2. Using the phone’s main display screen as a  
viewfinder, adjust the image by aiming the  
camera at the subject.  
This section explains how to use the camera on  
your phone. You can take photographs and shoot  
video by using the built-in camera functionality.  
Your camera produces photos in JPEG format.  
3. If desired, before taking the photo, use the  
left area of the screen to access various  
camera options and settings.  
4. You can also tap the screen to move the  
focus to a desired area of interest.  
Important! Do not take photos of people without  
their permission.  
5. Press  
(Camera key) until the shutter  
Do not take photos in places where  
cameras are not allowed.  
Do not take photos in places where  
you may interfere with another  
person’s privacy.  
sounds. (The picture is automatically  
stored within your designated storage  
location. If no microSD is installed, all  
pictures are stored on the Phone.) For  
Using the Camera  
Taking Photos  
1
8
Taking pictures with your device’s built-in  
camera is as simple as choosing a subject,  
pointing the camera, then pressing the camera  
key.  
2
3
7
6
Note: When taking a photo in direct sunlight or in  
bright conditions, shadows may appear on  
the photo.  
4
5
Multimedia  
115  
           
Camera and Camcorder  
Options  
Options are represented by icons across both  
sides of the screen.  
Settings:  
Edit shortcuts: allows you to set shortcut  
icons for the settings that you use the  
most.  
Camera Options  
The following shortcuts are available for the  
camera:  
Self portrait: allows you to set the front  
camera so you can take pictures of  
yourself or video chat.  
Flash: allows you to set the flash options  
to Off, On, or Auto flash.  
Note: The options disappear after a few seconds.  
Touch the screen to display the tab, then  
touch the tab to view these options.  
Shooting mode: allows you to set the  
shooting mode. Options are:  
Single shot: takes a single photo and  
view it before returning to the  
shooting mode.  
Focusarea:displaystheareaoftheimage  
used as the main focus area.  
Smile shot: the camera focuses on  
the face of your subject. Once the  
camera detects the person’s smile, it  
takes the picture.  
Self portrait: allows you to set the front  
camera so you can take pictures of  
yourself or video chat.  
Panorama: takes a landscape photo  
by taking an initial photo and then  
adding additional images to itself.  
The guide box lets you view the area  
where the second part of the  
Flash: allows you to set the flash options  
to Off, On, or Auto flash.  
A
panoramic picture should fall within.  
116  
     
Settings (continued):  
Resolution: allows you to set the image  
size to either: 3.2M (2048x1536), 2M  
(1600x1200), or 0.3M (640x480).  
Scene mode: allows you to set the Scene  
to help take the best pictures possible.  
Options include None, Portrait,  
Landscape, Night, Sports, Party/Indoor,  
Beach/Snow, Sunset, Dawn, Fall color,  
Firework, Text, Candlelight, and  
Backlight.Helpfultipsareshownforeach  
scene mode at the bottom of the display  
screen.  
White balance: allows you to set this  
option to one of the following choices:  
Auto, Daylight, Cloudy, Incandescent, or  
Fluorescent.  
Metering: allows you to set how the  
camera measures or meters the light  
source: Centre-weighted, Spot, or  
Matrix.  
Exposure value: allows you to adjust the  
brightness level by moving the slider.  
GPS tag: allows you to turn GPS On or Off  
(alsoknownasGeotagging).Thelocation  
of where the picture is taken is attached  
to the picture. (Only available in Camera  
mode.)  
Focus mode:allows you to set this option  
to Auto focus, Macro, or Face detection.  
Use Auto focus for all other focal  
situations.  
Auto focus: automatically focuses the  
image based on the on-screen focus  
area.  
Shutter sound: allows you to set the  
Shutter sound to On or Off.  
Storage: allows you to configure the  
default storage location for images or  
videosaseitherPhoneorMemorycard(if  
inserted).  
Macro: allows you to take close-up  
pictures.  
Timer: allows you to set a timer for how  
long to wait before taking a picture.  
Options include:Off, 2sec, 5sec, and 10  
sec.  
Reset: allows you to reset all camera or  
camcorder settings to the default values.  
Effects: allows you to change the color  
toneorapplyspecialeffectstothephoto.  
Options include: None, Negative,  
Grayscale, and Sepia.  
Multimedia  
117  
Video options  
Camera / Camcorder Mode: allows you to  
take a photo in various modes. Once you  
change the mode, the corresponding  
indicator appears at the top left of the  
display.SlidethebuttonupforCamera,or  
down for Camcorder.  
• Share: allows you to share a video using  
AllShare, Messaging, YouTube, Bluetooth, Gmail,  
Email, Kodak, and Snapfish.  
• Play: allows you to playback the current video  
file.  
• Delete  
:
allows you to delete the current video.  
Camera button: takes a photo when  
pressed in Camera mode.  
• More: provides additional options.  
Send to: allows you to send the file to a  
Contacts entry, New Email address, or New  
Phone number.  
Image viewer: allows you to access the  
Image viewer and the various viewing  
options for a selected picture. The last  
picture you took, will be displayed as a  
thumbnail in the Image viewer icon.  
Set Default Destination: allows you to assign a  
default action to take after taking an image  
(Contacts, New Email address, or New Phone  
number).  
Pictures and Videos Image Viewer  
Options  
After you take a photo or record a video, you can  
access various options.  
Play: allows you to replay the current video file.  
Rename: allows you to rename one or more  
video files.  
Photo options  
• Share: allows you to share a picture using  
AllShare, Messaging, Picasa, Bluetooth, Gmail,  
Email, Kodak, or Snapfish.  
• Delete  
:
allows you to delete the current picture.  
Tap OK to delete or Cancel  
.
• More: provides additional options. For more  
118  
     
Camera Gallery Options  
The Gallery is where you can access the Gallery  
of stored camera images.  
1. From the  
Home screen,  
tap  
Camera Image Options  
When you take a picture, the file is saved in the  
Photo folder. You can view your pictures  
immediately or view them anytime in the Photo  
folder.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Gallery).  
(Applications)  
2. Select a folder location and tap a file to  
open it in the Image viewer. Touch and  
drag a picture to the left to see the next  
picture or to the right to see the previous  
picture.  
(Gallery).  
2. Select a  
folder  
location (ex:  
3. Tap the on-screen image and use either of  
the following image menu options:  
• Send via: allows you to share a picture using  
Bluetooth, Email, Gmail, Messaging, Kodak, or  
Snapfish.  
Camera) and  
select an  
image by  
tapping it  
once to place  
a green check mark on the file.  
• Delete  
:
allows you to delete the current image.  
3. Press  
to reveal gallery-specific options Send via  
Delete, and More  
from this main Gallery screen  
4. Press  
and then tap Set as to select  
,
additional options:  
• Share via: allows you to share a picture using  
AllShare or Picasa.  
.
• Set as: allows you to assign the current image  
as either as Contact icon, Home screen  
Wallpaper, or Lock screen Wallpaper.  
Multimedia  
119  
                 
Rotate left: allows you to rotate the view of the  
current image in a counterclockwise direction.  
Rotate right: allows you to rotate the view of the  
current image in a clockwise direction.  
Slideshow: adds the selected photo to a  
custom slideshow.  
Rename: allows you to change the name of the  
current file.  
Send to: allows you to send the file to a  
Contacts entry, New Email address, or New  
Phone number.  
Set Default Destination: allows you to assign a  
default action to take after taking an image  
(Contacts, New Email address, or New Phone  
number). The default storage location for  
pictures is DCIM > Camera folder.  
Details: files details such as Title, Type, Date  
taken, Album, Location, Latitude, Longitude,  
etc..  
Assigning an Image as a Contact Icon  
• More: provides you with the additional options  
such as:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Gallery).  
Copy: allows you to copy one or more pictures to  
a different folder.  
2. Select a folder location and tap a file to  
open it.  
Crop: provides an on-screen box that allows you  
to crop the current picture. Tap Save to update  
the image with the new dimensions or tap  
Discard to ignore any changes.  
3. With the image displayed, press  
then tap Set as Contact icon  
4. Tap a contact to make a selection.  
and  
.
120  
 
5. Crop the image and tap Save  
.
Note: To ensure the Camcorder can record the  
Assigning an Image as a Wallpaper  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
video, use an SDHC memory card.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Gallery).  
Shooting Video  
2. Select a folder location and tap a file to  
Tip: When shooting video in direct sunlight or in  
bright conditions, it is recommended that you  
provide your subject with sufficient light by  
having the light source behind you.  
open it.  
3. With the image displayed, press  
then tap Set as.  
and  
4. Select one of the two options:  
• Home screen Wallpaper assigns the current  
image to the home screen background. This  
image is spread across all available screens.  
• Lock screen Wallpaper assigns the selected  
image to the background for the lock screen.  
5. Touch and drag the crop box anywhere on  
the picture. Touch and drag the sides of  
the crop box to zoom in or out to create a  
cropped area.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Camera)  
to activate the camera mode.  
2. Tap and slide the Camera mode button  
down to Camcorder Mode.  
3. Using the phone’s main display screen as a  
viewfinder, adjust the image by aiming the  
camcorder at the subject.  
4. Tap the Video key (  
) to begin shooting  
video. The red light will blink while  
recording.  
6. Tap Save to assign the wallpaper image.  
– or –  
5. Tap the Video key (  
) again to stop the  
Tap Discard to stop without updating the  
wallpaper image.  
recording and save the video file to your  
Camera folder.  
6. Once the file has been saved, tap the  
Using the Camcorder  
In addition to taking photos, the camera also  
doubles as a camcorder that also allows you to  
record, view, and send high definition videos.  
image viewer, then tap  
video for review.  
to play your  
7. Press  
to return to the viewer.  
Multimedia  
121  
         
Camcorder Options  
You can change options using your keypad in  
capture mode. The following short cuts are  
available:  
Settings:  
Edit shortcuts: allows you to set shortcut  
icons for the settings that you use the  
most.  
Flash: allows you to set the flash options  
toOfforOn.WhenyousettheflashtoOn,  
it stays on continually while you are  
taking a video.  
Recording mode: allows you to set the  
recording mode to: Normal, which is  
limited only by available space on the  
destination location, Limit for MMS,  
whichislimitedbyMMSsizerestrictions,  
and Self recording which activates the  
front-facing camera so you can video  
yourself.  
Recording mode: allows you to set the  
recording mode to:  
Normal: is limited only by available  
space on the destination location.  
Limit for MMS: is limited by MMS size  
restrictions.  
Flash: allows you to set the flash options  
toOfforOn.WhenyousettheflashtoOn,  
it stays on continually while you are  
taking a video.  
Self-recording: activates the front-  
facing camera so you can video  
yourself.  
Exposure value: allows you to adjust the  
brightness level by moving the slider.  
Timer: allows you to set a timer for how  
long to wait before taking a video.  
Optionsinclude:Off, 2sec, 5sec, and10  
sec.  
122  
 
Settings (continued):  
Image viewer: allows you to access the  
Image viewer and the various viewing  
options for a selected video. Image  
viewer options are described in the  
following section. The last video you  
took, will be displayed as a thumbnail in  
the Image viewer icon.  
Effects: allows you to change the color  
toneorapplyspecialeffectstothephoto.  
Options include: None, Negative,  
Grayscale, and Sepia.  
Resolution: allows you to set the image  
size to either: 640x480, 320x240, or  
176x144.  
Accessing Videos  
White balance: allows you to set this  
option to one of the following choices:  
Auto, Daylight, Cloudy, Incandescent, or  
Fluorescent.  
When you shoot a video, the file is saved in the  
Camera folder. You can view your videos  
immediately or view them anytime in the Camera  
folder.  
Storage: allows you to configure the  
default storage location for images or  
videosaseitherPhoneorMemorycard(if  
inserted).  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Gallery).  
2. Select a folder location and tap a video  
icon to begin video playback.  
– or –  
Reset: allows you to reset all camera or  
camcordersettingstothedefaultvalues.  
Touch and hold the video icon from the  
main Gallery to select the video (green  
check mark) and display the following  
video menu context options:  
Camera / Camcorder Mode: allows you to  
take a photo in various modes. Once you  
change the mode, the corresponding  
indicator appears at the top left of the  
display. Slide the button up for Camera  
mode or down for Camcorder mode.  
• Send via: allows you to share a video using  
Bluetooth, Email, Gmail, Messaging, Kodak, and  
Snapfish.  
Camcorder button: shoots and stops  
video recording when pressed in  
Camcorder mode.  
Multimedia  
123  
 
• Delete  
:
allows you to delete chosen/selected  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Files).  
pictures. Tap the checkmark, to turn it green, next to  
(
(
any file or folder you want to delete, then tap Confirm  
Note: Navigation in this viewer works on a  
hierarchy structure with folders, subfolders,  
etc.  
deletions  
.
• More: provides you with the additional options  
such as:  
Share via: allows you to share your file via  
YouTube.  
Opening and Navigating within Files  
DCIM is the default location for pictures or video  
taken by the device. These files are actually  
stored in the DCIM folder location.  
Play via: allows you to play your selected via  
AllShare.  
Rename: allows you to rename one or more  
video files.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Files).  
Send to: allows you to send the file to a  
Contacts entry, New Email address, or New  
Phone number.  
2. Tap a folder and scroll down or up until you  
locate your selected file.  
• Up tab allows you to back up into a higher  
directory.  
Set Default Destination: allows you to assign a  
default action to take after taking an image  
(Contacts, New Email address, or New Phone  
number).  
• Home tab allows you to back up to the root  
directory.  
Press  
way the files are displayed on-screen. Choose  
from: List List and details, or Thumbnail  
Press for these additional options: Share  
Create folder Delete View by List by, and  
More (Move, Copy, Rename, and Settings).  
and then tap View by to change the  
Details: displays video file information.  
,
.
Files  
,
Files allows you to manage your sounds, images,  
videos, Bluetooth files, Android files, and other  
memory card data in one convenient location.  
This application allows you to launch a file if the  
associated application is already on your phone  
(ex: MP4).  
,
,
,
3. Once you have located your file, tap the file  
name to launch the associated application.  
124  
   
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Videos). A list of  
The Gallery  
(
(
The Gallery is where you view photos and play  
back videos. For photos, you can also perform  
basic editing tasks, view a slideshow, set photos  
as wallpaper or caller image, and share as a  
picture message.  
videos sorted on the SD card displays in  
the Video list.  
2. Tap a video file to begin viewing.  
Media Hub  
Samsung Media Hub is your one stop for the  
hottest movie and TV content. With hundreds of  
titles available, entertaining your family on the go  
was never easier. You can rent or purchase your  
favorite content and watch from any location.  
Featuring the stunning viewing quality Samsung  
is known for, Samsung Media Hub is your  
gateway to mobile video like you've never  
experienced it before.  
Note: If the phone displays a memory full  
message when accessing the Gallery,  
access Files and remove some of the media  
files from the folders, and then open the  
Gallery.  
Opening the Gallery  
From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) Gallery). For more  
(
Note: Media Hub usage is based on service  
availability.  
Note: If you stored your files in folders (directories)  
on the storage card, Gallery displays these  
folders as separate albums. The top left  
album contains all the pictures in the  
storage card.  
Important! You must be using an active Wi-Fi/4G  
connection to preview and download a  
media file.  
You must have a microSD card  
installed prior to initiating the service.  
This card acts as a storage location for  
your downloaded rental or purchase.  
Using the Video Player  
TheVideoPlayerapplicationplaysvideofilesstored  
on the SD card.  
Multimedia  
125  
               
• My Media: allows you to view all of the media  
that you have purchased or rented. Touch a  
media entry to view it.  
Creating a New Media Hub Account  
Before you can rent or buy media, you must first  
create an account. Enter the required  
information.  
• Movie Store: displays movies that are available  
for rent or purchase. Scroll through the movie  
categories at the top of the screen. Touch a  
category and movies of that type display.  
• TV Store: displays TV shows that are available  
for purchase. Scroll through the movie  
categories at the top of the screen. Touch a  
category and TV shows of that type display.  
4. Scroll through the media listings and tap  
on an item you would like to purchase or  
rent.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(MediaHub).  
2. If prompted, read the End-User License  
Agreement (EULA) and tap Accept to  
continue or Decline to exit.  
3. Press  
and then tap My Account.  
4. Use the keypad to enter the required  
information, then tap Create Account  
Follow the on-screen instructions to  
complete your registration.  
.
5. From the My Account screen, you can edit  
5. Tap WATCH PREVIEW to watch a short  
parameters such as: My Details  
Purchases My Payment Methods  
My Devices Log out, or Reset Media Hub  
,
My  
preview or tap Rent or Own.  
,
,
Manage  
6. Choose a payment method and then follow  
the on-screen instructions. The media  
stores to the My Media folder.  
,
.
Using Media Hub  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Media Hub Notices  
Any media item (Media Content) may be rented or  
purchased after you create an account in Media  
Hub.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(MediaHub).  
2. Read the End-User License Agreement  
(EULA) and tap Accept to continue or  
Decline to exit.  
Media Content that is downloaded may be viewed  
concurrently on up to five (5) devices with Media  
Hub that are also registered to the same account.  
You may choose to remove a device from your  
account no more than once every 30 days.  
3. At the Media Hub screen select one of the  
following options:  
• What’s new: shows recently added media that  
is available for rent or purchase.  
126  
   
You may remove Media Content from a device as  
many times as you’d like. You will have the ability to  
re-download the Media Content at a later point in  
time subject to content re-download availability and  
studio permissions.  
In no event will rented Media Content be  
available for a period of more than thirty (30)  
days (or shorter on a title-by-title basis) after the  
Media Content has been rented (e.g., if you  
begin viewing rented Media Content on the 29th  
day after the rental transaction, but do not finish  
viewing the entire title, that rented Media  
Content may not be available for the entire  
twenty-four (24) consecutive hour period if such  
period would extend the viewable time beyond  
the thirty (30) day rental window).  
You MUST be in network coverage to license Media  
Content you have acquired through the Service.  
You must have Wi-Fi connectivity in order to  
download Media Content.  
Unlike purchased Media Content, rented Media  
Content will be viewable on only 1 device in your  
account.  
You cannot play any media content downloaded  
from Media Hub through any output on your mobile  
phone, including All Share.  
Media Content is downloaded and saved onto the  
SD card.  
Music  
Your Media Content may pause/stop or not  
download in networks where there is a weak signal.  
You may begin watching downloaded Media Content  
as soon as a) license acquisition has occurred and  
b) sufficient amount of the Media Content has been  
buffered.  
Playing Music  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
player tips display.  
2. Tap Done  
3. Tap a tab to select the music category: All  
Playlists Albums, or Artists  
(Music). Music  
.
You must finish watching rented Media Content  
within 24 consecutive hours of start of playback.  
,
,
.
Stopping, pausing or restarting rented Media  
Content does not extend the available viewing  
time.  
4. Scroll through the list and tap an entry to  
begin playback.  
Note: The 5.1 channel sound effect works when  
earphones or sound is connected through  
the headset jack only.  
Multimedia  
127  
     
5. The following controls are available once a  
Making a Song a Phone Ringtone  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
song is played:  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Music).  
Pause the song.  
2. Tap the All tab.  
Start the song after pausing.  
3. Touch and hold a song from the list to  
Pressandholdtorewindthesong.Tap  
to go to previous song.  
reveal the on-screen context menu.  
4. Tap Set as  
Phone ringtone.  
Press and hold to fast-forward the  
song. Tap to go to next song.  
Volume control.  
Music Player Options  
The Music Player Settings menu allows you to  
set preferences for the music player such as  
whether you want the music to play in the  
background, sound effects, and how the music  
menu displays.  
5.1Ch  
Allowsyoutolistentomusicusing5.1  
Virtual Surround Sound.  
( ( ) )  
Plays the entire song list once.  
With the music player application  
displayed and playing a song, press  
and select one of the following options:  
• Add to quick list: adds the selected music file to  
a quick playlist.  
Replays the current list when the list  
ends.  
Repeats the currently playing song.  
shuffles the current list of songs  
randomly.  
• Via Bluetooth: plays the music through a  
Bluetooth stereo headset.  
songs play in order and are not  
shuffled.  
• Share music via: shares a music file via  
AllShare, Bluetooth, Email, Gmail, or Messaging.  
• Set as: sets this song as a Phone ringtone,  
Caller ringtone, or Alarm tone.  
lists the current playlist songs  
List  
[song name]  
displaysthecurrentsongintheplayer  
window  
• Add to playlist: adds a song to the playlist.  
• More  
:
128  
           
Settings: allows you to activate or deactivate the  
Equalizer, Sound effects, Music menu, or  
Visualization. The Music menu allows you to  
decide what you want to display. Selections are:  
Albums, Artists, Genres, Folders, Composers,  
Years, Most played, Recently played, or Recently  
added. Tap each item that you want to display in  
the Music menu.  
Adding Music to a Playlist  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Music).  
2. Tap the Playlists tab.  
3. Tap the playlist name in which to add  
music.  
4. Press  
and then tap Add.  
– or –  
Details: displays details about the selected  
music.  
Tap  
(Add music).  
Stop playing music: stops playing the  
currently selected song or playlist.  
Note: If a playlist is empty, add a song by touching  
a holding a song name from the main  
screen to open the context menu. Select  
Using Playlists  
Add to playlist  
.
Playlists are used to assign music files into  
groups for playback. These Playlists can be  
created using the Music player on this device, or  
using a third-party application (such as Windows  
Media Player) and downloading those files to an  
SD card inserted into the device.  
5. Tap a music file, or tap Select all to add all  
the music tracks to this playlist then tap  
Add  
.
Removing Music from a Playlist  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Creating a Playlist  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Music).  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. Tap the Playlists tab.  
3. Press and then tap Create  
(Music).  
2. Tap the Playlists tab.  
3. Tap the playlist name in which to delete  
music.  
.
4. Touch and hold a song to reveal the on-  
screen context menu.  
4. Backspace over the default playlist title  
and type a new name for this playlist, then  
tap Save  
.
5. Tap Remove  
OK.  
Multimedia  
129  
             
Editing a Playlist  
Besides adding and removing music files in a  
playlist, you can also share, delete, or rename  
the playlist.  
Removing Music Files  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Music).  
2. Tap the All tab.  
Only those playlist you have created can be  
edited. Default playlists can not be renamed.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
3. Touch and hold a song entry to reveal the  
on-screen context menu.  
4. Tap Delete  
OK. The music file(s) is  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Music).  
deleted.  
2. Tap the Playlists tab.  
T-Mobile TV HD  
T-Mobile TV HD is an application that allows you  
to get both live Standard and High definition TV  
and Video on Demand.  
3. Touch and hold a playlist entry to reveal  
the on-screen context menu.  
4. Tap Edit title  
5. Enter a new name for this playlist and tap  
Save  
.
1. From the Home screen, tap  
.
(
Applications) ➔  
(T-Mobile TV HD).  
Transferring Music Files  
Music files can be downloaded to the phone  
using one of two methods:  
The T-Mobile Terms and Conditions page  
displays.  
Note: A data plan is required to use this feature.  
Charges may apply. Please contact your  
service provider for further details.  
1. Downloaded to the phone from or Android  
Market. Music files are directly stored on  
your phone.  
2. Downloaded to the phone via a direct USB  
connection. Music files are stored into a  
Music folder on the SD card.  
2. Tap Accept if you accept the Terms and  
Conditions.  
– or –  
Tap Exit to close the application.  
Note: It is recommended that you place your  
music into either a media or music folder. If  
these doe not currently exist in your card,  
you should create them prior to transfer.  
130  
               
Note: T-Mobile TV must be initialized over a  
cellular network before it can be used.  
During this initial registration process, any  
current Wi-Fi connections must be disabled.  
3. Tap Disable Wi-Fi if you currently have an  
active Wi-Fi connection.  
4. Tap Start Trial to begin a free 30-day trial of  
the service.  
5. Tap any of the following categories to  
begin viewing: Live TV  
,
On Demand, My  
media More Info Browse, or Live Channels.  
,
,
YouTube  
YouTube is a video sharing website on which  
users can upload and share videos, and view  
them in MPEG-4 format.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. Tap Accept if you accept the Terms and  
Conditions, or tap Exit  
(YouTube).  
.
3. When the screen loads you can begin  
searching and viewing posted videos.  
4. Press  
Settings  
High quality on  
mobile if you prefer high quality output.  
Multimedia  
131  
     
Section 9: Applications and Development  
This section outlines the various applications  
that are available on your phone.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Accounts and sync).  
(
(
Applications  
The Applications list provides quick access to all  
the available applications on the phone.  
AllShare  
Refer to the application table on page 35 for a  
description of each Application, its function, and  
how to navigate through that particular  
application. If the application is already  
described in another section of this user manual,  
then a cross reference to that particular section  
is provided.  
This application wirelessly synchronizes your  
Samsung mobile phone with your TV, streams  
content and even keeps tabs on who calls or  
sends text messages with real-time, on-screen  
monitoring. Samsung’s AllShare makes staying  
connected easy.  
Allows users to share their in-device media  
content with other external devices using DLNA  
certified™ (Digital Living Network Alliance)  
Devices. These external devices must also be  
DLNA-compliant. Wi-Fi capability can be  
provided to TVs via a digital multimedia  
streamer.  
411 & More  
Provides more than just single tap access to  
directory assistance and other portals. Available  
categories include: 411 Directory Assistance,  
Current Weather, and more.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(411 & More).  
Important! You must activate Wi-Fi to use this  
2. Tap an on-screen options and follow the  
on-screen prompts.  
Accounts and sync  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
This application allows you to configure general  
synchronization settings that determine whether  
the background data is synchronized, and  
whether you automatically synchronize data with  
the phone.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(AllShare).  
2. Follow the on-screen prompts.  
132  
                   
The application contains two separate streaming  
media options:  
• Default memory: allows you to have media  
saved to your Phone or Memory Card. Tap an  
option.  
• My device allows you to stream/share selected  
multimedia content from your device to DLNA  
compliant device connected to the same WAP.  
• Subtitles: allows you to see subtitles on shared  
media.  
• Remote device allows you to receive and  
playback media stored externally (server, laptop,  
etc.) directly on your device.  
Depending on the setting you changed, a  
pop-up screen may display to restart  
AllShare. Tap Yes to continue.  
Configuring AllShare Settings  
Transmitting Media via AllShare  
The AllShare™ application must first be  
configured prior to its initial use. You must setup  
parameters such as connected Wi-FI, Items to  
share, source server address, and external  
device acceptance rights.  
1. Tap the My device tab, select Videos  
,
Photos, or Music, and then tap on the  
media that you would like to share.  
2. At the Select device screen, any devices  
that you can share with are displayed.  
3. Tap on a device to share media.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Applications) ➔  
(AllShare).  
Receiving Media via AllShare  
1. Tap the Remote device tab at the top of the  
screen.  
2. Press and then tap Settings and  
configure the following settings as desired:  
• Device name: defaults to your phone. Use the  
keypad to enter a new Media server if desired,  
All devices that you can receive media  
from are displayed.  
and tap Save  
.
• Share video/photos/audio: allows you to  
restrict what is shared from your phone. Tap the  
items you want to share.  
2. Tap a device name. Media that you can  
receive from the other device is listed.  
Tap an item that you want to stream to your  
phone.  
• Upload from other devices: allows you set the  
phone to select how uploads from other devices  
3. Press  
to return to the previous page.  
are started. Tap Always accept  
,
Always ask, or  
Always reject  
.
Applications and Development  
133  
     
3. Once installed, locate the Widget on your  
screen and tap Launch  
4. Follow the on-screen prompts.  
Bejeweled 2  
.
Bejeweled 2 is a free web-based game, sequel  
to Bejeweled. Start by clicking two adjacent  
pieces to create a line of three or more identical  
gems.  
Books  
Use Google Books to read over 3 million ebooks  
on the go.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Bejeweled 2).  
(
(
Note: This application might be updated after  
connection. This would require a user to  
follow the on-screen instructions to update  
the related application icon and features.  
Blio  
Blio is an eReading application that presents  
eBooks just like the printed version, in full color,  
and with all of the features you’d want from an  
eReader.  
Build your ebooks library in the cloud with  
Google Books: jump right into a bestseller or  
select from nearly 3 million free ebooks.  
Personalize the reader to your liking, pick up  
reading where you left off on your phone or  
computer, and settle down with a great book on  
your Android phone!  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. Read the on-screen welcome information  
and tap Close  
3. Tap an available on-screen option and  
follow the prompts. Choose from: Get  
Shop Search, and Read  
(blio).  
.
,
1. From the Home screen, tap  
,
.
(
Applications) ➔  
(Books).  
Bonus Apps  
2. If prompted, tap Turn sync on. This  
synchronizes your books you have  
previously selected between your Books  
account and your device.  
Provides the procedures necessary to install the  
T-Mobile Bonus Apps Widget that allows you to  
discover those applications that are compatible  
specifically with your phone.  
3. Tap  
to begin searching for both free  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
and paid ebooks.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Bonus Apps).  
4. Follow the on-screen prompts to download  
2. Read the Widget installation and tap OK  
.
the ebook to your phone.  
134  
                 
Calculator  
Important! You must have previously added an  
account (Facebook, Microsoft  
Using this feature you can use the phone as a  
calculator. The calculator provides the basic  
arithmetic functions; addition, subtraction,  
multiplication, and division. You can also use this  
as a scientific calculator.  
Exchange ActiveSync, or Google) prior  
to using the Calendar.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Calendar). The  
(Applications) ➔  
(Calculator).  
Calendar displays four tabs:  
• Month: displays the Month view.  
• Week: displays the Week view.  
• Day: displays the Day view.  
2. Enter the first number using the numeric  
keys.  
3. Enter the operation for your calculation by  
tapping the Plus, Minus, Multiplication, or  
Division key.  
• List: allows you to search for events for the  
selected Month, Week, or Day, or you can look  
for events for a future date.  
4. Enter the next number.  
5. To view the result, tap the = (equals) key.  
6. Repeat steps 1 to 4 as many times as  
required.  
2. Press  
options:  
and select one of the following  
• Create: creates a new Event.  
• Go to: displays a specific date.  
Note: Place the screen in Landscape mode to  
Today: displays the date highlighted with a Blue  
box highlighting the date.  
reveal additional scientific functions.  
• Search: allows you to search within current  
events.  
Calendar  
With the Calendar feature, you can consult the  
calendar by day, week, or month, create events,  
and set an alarm to act as a reminder. Google  
Calendar is built into the phone and synchronizes  
both new and existing entries between your  
phone and your online Google account.  
• Delete: allows you to delete All events, All events  
before today, or an individual event.  
• Settings: displays a list of configurable settings.  
Applications and Development  
135  
         
To manually sync calendar events:  
1. Press and then tap  
Accounts and sync  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Camera).  
(
(
.
2. Locate the email account containing the  
events you wish to synchronize.  
Clock  
3. Tap  
within the adjacent account field  
Here you can set an alarm, configure and view  
the World clock, use a stopwatch, set a timer,  
and display the desk clock. The applications  
display in a tabular format and quickly accessed  
with the touch of a finger.  
to reveal the account’s synchronization  
settings screen.  
4. Tap Sync Calendar to activate the  
synchronization of calendar events  
between your device and the remote  
exchange server. A green checkmark  
indicates the feature is enabled.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Clock).  
(
(
Contacts  
The default storage location for saving phone  
numbers to your Contacts List is your phone’s  
built-in memory.  
Downloads  
Provides quick access to tabs containing a list of  
your current downloaded files (Internet and  
Other).  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Downloads).  
Camera  
Use your 3.0 megapixel camera feature to produce  
photosinaJPEGformat.TheCamcordershootsHigh  
Definition video in an MP4 format.  
2. Tap an available file category tab (Internet  
downloads or Other downloads) and select  
the desired file. Compatible document  
formats can be opened by Polaris Office  
Note: An SD card must be inserted before the  
Camera will take and store photos.  
136  
                         
Email  
Gmail  
Email enables you to review and create email  
using most email services. The device alerts you  
when you receive an email message.  
Google Mail (Gmail) is a web-based email  
service. Gmail is configured when you first set  
up your phone. Depending on your  
synchronization settings, Gmail can  
automatically synchronize with your Gmail  
account on the web.  
Files  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Gmail).  
Organize and store data, images, and more in  
your own personal file folders. Files are stored to  
the memory card in separate (user defined)  
folders.  
(
(
Google Search  
Use Google Search to search the Web.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Files).  
(
(
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Google Search) and  
(
(
Gallery  
enter the search text.  
– or –  
The Gallery is where you view photos and play  
back videos. For photos, you can also perform  
basic editing tasks, view a slideshow, set photos  
as wallpaper or caller image, and share as a  
picture message.  
Tap  
on the Google Search bar and  
say the search information.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Gallery).  
(
(
Applications and Development  
137  
               
3. Enable options within these stations/  
Highlight  
channels.  
This downloadable application/widget allows you  
to stay up to date on relevant news, Android  
Market apps and games (specific to your phone),  
T-Mobile ringtones, CallerTunes and more.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
4. Press  
to exit the application.  
Kies air  
Kies air allows you to sync your Windows PC  
wirelessly with your phone provided they are  
both on the same Wi-Fi network. You can view  
and share call logs, videos, photos, music,  
bookmarks, ringtones, and even send SMS  
messages from your PC.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Highlight).  
2. Follow the on-screen installation  
instructions. Locate a screen with enough  
room to place the new widget onto.  
3. Tap  
access the Quick Launch Bar and  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Kies air).  
manage your selected apps (channels/  
stations) of selected information.  
4. Enable or disable apps and press  
exit the bar.  
(
(
to  
Latitude  
5. The Highlight application then displays  
Google Latitude allows you and your friends  
share locations and status messages with each  
other. It also lets you send instant messages and  
emails, make phone calls, and get directions to  
your friends’ locations.  
information corresponding to the channel  
categories you selected.  
To adjust the Highlight settings:  
1. Locate the on-screen Highlight application.  
2. Tap  
(Settings) from the upper-right of  
Important! You must sign in to your Google  
account, enable Wi-Fi, and enable the  
Location feature before you can use  
the application to access the Highlight  
Settings page.  
From here you can manage content, access the  
Quick Launch Bar, and review information about  
the application such as: About, Terms &  
Conditions, and Third Party License Agreements.  
138  
             
2. Press  
3. Tap Select from Contacts or Add via email  
address  
4. Tap a contact or enter an email address,  
then tap Add friends  
Add friends.  
Note: Although you do not have to enable location  
services in order to use Latitude, it is  
recommended for best accuracy.  
.
.
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Latitude).  
5. Tap Yes at the Send sharing requests  
prompt.  
Important! For best results, it is recommended  
that you enable all of your location  
Your friend will receive an email or text  
message with your location marked on a  
map. They will also receive instructions on  
how to view your location from the web or  
use Latitude on their phone or tablet  
provided it is available. Once they  
acknowledge your request, their location  
will display on your tablet. They can share  
their location from their computer, phone,  
or tablet. For more information, go to  
2. Tap Share location with family or friends to  
share your location and launch the Friends  
screen.  
3. Tap Wi-Fi Disabled - Click to enable  
connection to navigate to the Wi-Fi Settings  
menu where you can turn on Wi-Fi if it is  
not already enabled. For more  
4. If prompted with the Improve My Location  
screen, tap Settings to configure the  
necessary settings or Skip to continue on  
without making a change.  
6. To view the map, press  
Latitude Options  
.
See map.  
From the map display, press  
to  
display the following options:  
• Search: allows you to search for a place of  
interest.  
Sharing your Location with Friends  
1. From the Latitude map screen, tap  
to  
• Directions: displays navigation directions to a  
location from a starting point.  
display your Latitude friends. At first, only  
your name is displayed.  
Applications and Development  
139  
• Clear Map: allows you to remove all markings  
and layers from the map.  
Lookout Anti-Virus  
The Lookout™ Anti-Virus security application  
provides mobile device-specific security features  
that are coupled with a minimal performance hit.  
This application provides key security options  
that are unique to the mobile market. Along with  
the antivirus and anti-malware tech, there's a  
lost and stolen phone locator service, an  
application privacy adviser, and a backup  
service.  
• More: provides access to additional features  
such as: Map, Places, Navigation, Latitude,  
Location history, and My Places.  
• Settings: allows you to select the following  
additional options:  
Cache Settings: allows you to set options to  
pre-fetch map tiles when not using Wi-Fi and to  
clear the cache that holds the map tiles.  
Location reporting: allows you to configure the  
location reporting parameters.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Lookout Anti-Virus).  
2. Read the on-screen descriptions and tap  
Get started to begin your configuration.  
3. Read the on-screen information about  
Security and if desired, tap the Enable  
Security field to activate the feature.  
Labs: this is a testing ground for experimental  
features that aren’t ready for primetime. They  
may change, break or disappear at any time.  
Click on a Lab to enable or disable it.  
Terms, Privacy & Notices: displays the Terms  
and Conditions, Privacy Policy, o r Legal Notices  
information. Select the desired information from  
the pop-up menu.  
4. Tap Next  
.
5. Read the on-screen information about  
Backup and if desired, tap the Enable  
Backup field to activate the feature.  
About: displays general information about  
Google maps such as Version, Platform, Locale,  
Total data sent, Total data received, Free  
memory, etc.  
6. Tap Next  
.
7. Read the on-screen information about the  
feature that can help locate your missing  
phone and if desired, tap the New user (to  
setup a new account) or Existing user (to  
log into your account field to activate the  
feature.  
Help: displays the Google Mobile Help web  
page where you can receive help on Google  
Maps.  
140  
   
8. Tap Start Lookout  
.
Enabling a Location source  
From the main application, the main features are  
presented as buttons. Tap one to reveal a button  
that will run the feature.  
Before you use Google Maps and find your  
location or search for places of interest, you  
must enable a location source. To enable the  
location source you must enable the wireless  
network, or enable the GPS satellites.  
Maps  
Google Maps allow you to track your current  
location, view real-time traffic issues, and view  
detailed destination directions. There is also a  
search tool included to help you locate places of  
interest or a specific address. You can view  
locations on a vector or aerial map, or you can  
view locations at the street level.  
Important! The more location determining  
functions are enabled, the more  
accurate the determination will be of  
your position.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Location and security  
.
Important! Before using Google Maps you must  
have an active data (3G/4G) or Wi-Fi  
connection. The Maps application does  
not cover every country or city.  
2. Tap Use wireless networks to enable GPS to  
determine location based on nearby cell  
towers.  
3. Tap Use GPS satellites to enable the GPS  
satellite.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Maps).  
(
(
4. Tap Use sensor aiding to enhance  
positioning and save power using sensors.  
Important! For best results, it is recommended  
that you enable all of your location  
Tip: When using Google Maps you can turn on  
Enable GPS satellites. Selecting GPS satellites  
allows you to locate places of interest at the  
street-level. However, this also requires a  
clear view of the sky and uses more battery  
power.  
Applications and Development  
141  
             
Transit Lines: displays the overlapping transit  
lines on your map.  
Opening Maps  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Maps).  
Latitude: allows you to see your friend's  
locations and share your location with them.  
My Maps: displays a list of your preferred maps.  
Bicycling: displays the overlapping cycling trails  
on your map.  
2. Locate the top row of the applications to  
access additional options:  
• Search Maps: allows you to search for a place  
of interest.  
• Places: provides access to the places menu  
where you can quickly locate a business or  
person, find out more information about a  
business, see coupons, public responses, and  
more (page 153). Locate and tap one of the  
listed places (Restaurants, Coffee, Bars,  
Attractions, ATMs, Gas Stations, Explore Nearby,  
or Add your own place.)  
Wikipedia: displays any Wikipedia markers and  
info on your map.  
• My Location: when touched, the location  
displays on the map with a blinking blue dot.  
3. Press  
options:  
and select one of the following  
• Search: allows you to search for a place of  
interest.  
A list of places within this category displays.  
• Layers: allows you to switch map views:  
• Directions: displays navigation directions to a  
location from a starting point.  
Traffic: (available only in selected areas) Real-  
time traffic conditions are displayed over roads  
as color-coded lines. Each color represents how  
fast the traffic is moving.  
• My Places: marks favorite locations on the map.  
These items are automatically synchronized with  
maps.  
• Clear Map: after viewing or following directions,  
this option resets the map.  
Satellite: Maps uses the same satellite data as  
Google Earth. Satellite images are not real-time.  
Google Earth acquires the best imagery  
available, most of which is approximately one to  
three years old.  
• Join Latitude: lets you and your friends share  
locations and status messages with each other.  
It also lets you send instant messages and  
emails, make phone calls, and get directions to  
your friends’ locations.  
Terrain: combines a topographical view of the  
area’s terrain with the current map location.  
142  
 
• More  
:
Note: This application might be updated after  
connection. This would require a user to  
follow the on-screen instructions to update  
the related application icon and features.  
Labs: a testing ground for experimental features  
that are not ready to use publically.  
Cache Settings: provides the ability to setup  
maps that are cached into the phone’s memory  
(while not on a Wi-Fi connection) or to clear the  
cache of map titles.  
Accessing the Market  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. If not already logged in with your Google  
account, tap Next  
(Market).  
Help: uses the browser to display a searchable  
Google Mobile Help screen.  
.
Terms, Privacy & Notices: displays the Terms  
and Conditions, Privacy Policy, or Legal Notices  
information. Select the desired information from  
the pop-up menu.  
3. Tap Sign in and enter your Google account  
information.  
4. Tap Accept to agree to the Android Market  
terms of service.  
About: displays general information about  
Google maps such as Version, Platform, Locale,  
Total data sent, Total data received, Free  
memory, etc.  
Downloading a New Google  
Application  
Market  
Android Market provides access to downloadable  
applications and games to install on your phone.  
Android Market also allows you to provide  
feedback and comments about an application, or  
flag an application that might be incompatible  
with your phone.  
To download a new application, you will need to  
use your Google account to sign in to Android  
Market. The Android Market home page provides  
several ways to find applications. The home  
page features applications and includes a list of  
item applications by category, a list of games, a  
link to search, and a link to My apps.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Market).  
Applications and Development  
143  
           
2. Browse through the categories, find an  
application you're interested in, and tap  
the name.  
7. After the item is downloaded and installed  
on your phone, the content download icon  
appears in the notification area of  
the status bar.  
3. Read the application descriptions.  
8. On the Android Market screen, press  
and then tap My apps, tap the installed  
Important! If the selected application requires  
access to data or control of a function  
on your phone, Market displays the  
application in the list, and then tap Open  
.
information the application will access.  
Tip: The newly downloaded applications display in  
the applications list and are shown in  
alphabetical order if the View Type is set to  
Alphabetical grid or Alphabetical list, or at the  
end of the list if View type is set to  
Tap OK if you agree to the conditions of  
the application. Once you tap OK on  
this screen you are responsible for  
using this application on the phone  
and the amount of data it uses. Use  
this feature with caution.  
Customizable grid.  
Note: A data plan is required to use this feature.  
Charges may apply. Please contact your  
service provider for further details.  
4. Tap Install  
.
Note: Use caution with applications which request  
access to any personal data, functions, or  
significant amounts of data usage times.  
Launching an Installed Google  
Application  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
5. If prompted, follow the on-screen  
instructions to pay for the application.  
6. Check the progress of the current  
download by opening the Notifications  
panel.  
(
Applications).  
2. Tap the newly installed application. This  
application is typically located on the last  
Applications page.  
144  
the remaining memory and resources for each of  
the applications on your phone and clear the  
data, cache, or defaults.  
Android Development  
This device can be used for Android application  
development. You can write applications in the  
SDK and install them on this device, then run the  
applications using the hardware, system, and  
network.  
Press  
and then tap  
Manage  
(Settings) Applications  
applications  
.
Clearing application cache and data  
Warning! Android Dev Phones are not intended for  
non-developer end-users. Because the  
device can be configured with system  
software not provided by or supported  
by Google or any other company, end-  
users operate these devices at their own  
risk.  
1. Press  
Settings) Applications  
applications  
and then tap  
(
Manage  
.
2. Tap an application in which to clear the  
cache or data.  
3. Tap Force stop Uninstall, Clear data, Move  
,
to SD card, Clear cache, or Clear defaults  
Uninstalling third-party applications  
You can uninstall any application you  
.
Unknown sources  
This feature can be used for Android application  
development. The feature allows developers to  
install non-Market applications.  
downloaded and installed from Android Market.  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) Applications Manage  
applications  
2. Tap the third-party application, and from  
the Application info screen, tap Uninstall  
1. Press  
Settings) Applications  
sources  
and then tap  
(
(
Unknown  
.
.
Unknown sources displays a check mark  
to indicate it is active.  
.
Media Hub  
Manage applications  
This feature allows you to manage and remove  
installed applications. You can also view the  
amount of memory or resources used as well as  
From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) MediaHub).  
(
Applications and Development  
145  
           
• Sort by: allows you to sort by Date or Color.  
Memo  
• More: provides the following options:  
This feature allows you to create a memo.  
SNS log in: allows you to log into your  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Facebook, Twitter, or Linkedin accounts.  
Sync memo: allows you to sync your memos  
Google Docs or send individual memos.  
PIN lock: allows you to set a PIN lock so that a  
PIN must be entered before reading a memo.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Memo).  
2. Tap Create memo  
.
Note: If this is your first memo, you are  
automatically taken to the new memo  
screen.  
2. Touch and hold the memo then select Send  
and choose the method to send this  
3. Compose the memo.  
memo: Bluetooth Email, or Messaging.  
,
4. Press  
Save  
and select a color, then tap  
3. From the memo list, touch the upper-left  
.
edit button and select a color for the  
memo’s background, then tap Save  
.
Messaging  
Memo options  
This application allows you to use the Short  
Message Service (SMS) to send and receive  
short text messages to and from other mobile  
phones.  
1. While viewing the list of Memos, press  
and select one of the following  
options:  
• Create: allows you to create a memo.  
• Delete: allows you to delete one or more  
memos.  
You can also use the Multi Media Service (MMS)  
to create multimedia messages to send and  
receive from other mobile phones.  
• Search: allows you to search within the current  
set of memos.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Messaging).  
(
(
• Send: allows you to send one or several of your  
memos at one time. Select a memo and tap  
send to deliver it via: Bluetooth, Email, or  
Messaging.  
146  
           
3. Tap Auto update if you want the settings to  
Mini Diary  
automatically update.  
This application allows you to create a mini diary  
where you can add a photo, and text to describe  
an event or other memorable life event.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Deleting a Mini Diary entry  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
.
(Applications) ➔  
(Mini Diary). Any  
2. Press  
and then tap Delete all.  
diary entries display in a list.  
2. If prompted, tap Yes to allow required  
network connectivity.  
Mini Diary options  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. Select a diary.  
3. Press and select one of the following  
options:  
.
3. Tap the Tap to add photo field to add a  
photo for this diary event and touch the  
source. Selections are: Camera, or Gallery  
.
4. Tap the Add location area of the screen,  
• Create: creates a new diary entry.  
• Delete: deletes the displayed entry.  
• Edit: allows you to edit the current diary entry.  
• Change photo: replaces the photo in this entry  
by allowing you to take another photo or use  
another image.  
enter text, then tap Done  
5. Tap the Tap to add text area of the screen  
and enter text then tap Done  
.
.
6. Tap the weather data icon in the upper,  
right corner (above the photo) and select a  
weather condition from the list to describe  
the weather conditions for this entry.  
• Delete photo: deletes the photo from this entry  
when you touch Yes to confirm.  
7. Tap Save  
.
• More: provides additional options such as:  
Publish (SNS service such as Facebook) and  
Send via (to deliver the entry via either Email or  
Messaging).  
Mini Diary settings  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. From the main Diary listings page, press  
and then tap Settings  
(Mini Diary).  
.
Applications and Development  
147  
         
• Settings: Provides access to configuration  
settings such as: Get Better Deals, Connect with  
Facebook, and Terms & Conditions.  
More for Me  
Provides customized offers, discounts and deals  
right to your phone by providing some brief  
customer and location information. The  
application uses your current location to bring  
you the best deals in your area.  
Music  
This application allows you to play music files  
that you have stored on your microSD card. You  
can also create playlists.  
Initial Setup  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Music).  
(
Applications) ➔  
(More for Me).  
(
(
2. Read the on-screen information and  
configure the necessary options such as:  
Gender, Age, and agreements.  
3. Tap Continue to complete the setup  
process.  
My Account  
This option provides you with account specific  
information such as your current activity, billing  
information, and Plan Services information. You  
can also set alerts for minute or message usage,  
payment reminder, or power saver.  
Using the More for Me Application  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(More for Me).  
2. Access an available tab for more options:  
• Just for Me: displays a listing of current offers  
available within your current area.  
Note: You may be prompted to log into the Android  
Market to receive the latest version of the T-  
Mobile My Account application.  
• All Deals: Provides you with common categories  
to choose from, such as: Food & Drinks, Health  
& Beauty, Retail & Service, Activities, Events,  
Other, and All nearby.  
The differences between My Account and My  
Device are these:  
• My Account: check Activity, set Alerts and  
Events, review Billing, and review your current  
Plan and services.  
• My Deals: displays a list of previously redeemed  
offers.  
• My Device: access Support, view Quick Tools,  
Personalize settings, and Storage & Battery.  
148  
           
Message Usage: tracks the number of  
messages used and remaining in your plan. If  
you plan includes unlimited messages this  
setting does not apply.  
Tip: Use the Menu key to toggle between My  
Account and My Device.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Data Usage: tracks data used and remaining in  
your plan. If you plan includes unlimited data  
usage this setting does not apply.  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. Read the on-screen information and tap  
OK  
(My Account).  
.
Payment Reminder: alerts when your bill is  
due.  
The initial screen displays four tabs: Activity, Set  
Alerts, Billing, and Plan.  
Power Saver: sends an alert when the battery  
level reaches 30 percent. The alert displays in  
the notification window. This alert is  
Activity  
The Activity tab displays your current minute and  
message activity. You can view what percentage  
of minutes were used as well as the number of  
messages used for a particular start date.  
automatically set to On  
.
Support Alerts: allows you to enable  
automated troubleshooting.  
Alerts and Events  
From this screen you can activate alerts to notify  
you of the following:  
• Recent Oder Status: Displays details about your  
recent orders.  
• Account Events: provides details about your  
recent account events.  
• Alert Settings: sets when you would receive  
alerts for the following:  
Minute Usage: tracks the number of minutes  
used and remaining in your plan. Minute Usage  
Reminder: sends an alert when the number of  
minutes used reaches 75 percent of the total  
available minutes in the plan. Over Limit Alert:  
sends an alert when usage exceeds your plan’s  
total available minutes.  
Billing  
This provides a billing summary.  
Plan  
This screen displays specific information and  
charges for your current plan and services. The  
screen also displays additional services  
information and charges. Included categories  
include: My plan & services, Additional Services,  
and T-Mobile Offers.  
Applications and Development  
149  
Quick Tools  
My Device  
Quick Tools is a shortcut that allows you to view  
and configure the following features and  
parameters: Wi-Fi, Bluetooth, Data Roaming,  
GPS, Brightness, Screen Timeout, and Phone  
Info.  
Use the My Device application to configure  
device settings, view support information,  
personalize your CallerTunes, Ringtones, or  
Wallpapers, or view battery storage information.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Personalize  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. Read the on-screen information and tap  
OK  
(My Device).  
Using this menu you can personalize  
CallerTunes, Ringtone, and Wallpapers.  
• Caller Tunes: allows you to choose songs for  
your callers to hear.  
.
Tip: Use the Menu key (  
) to toggle between My  
Account and My Device.  
• Ringtones: you can personalize your phone’s  
ringtones by choosing from recordings, voices,  
and more.  
The differences between My Account and My  
Device are these:  
• Wallpapers: you can personalize your phone’s  
background by selecting wallpapers from the  
Shop, Gallery, Live Wallpapers, and the  
Wallpaper Gallery.  
• My Account: check Activity, set Alerts and  
Events, review Billing, and review your current  
Plan and services.  
• My Device: access Support, view Quick Tools,  
Storage & Battery  
Personalize settings, and Storage & Battery.  
From this tab you can view Memory storage  
information for the phone or memory card. You  
can also view the battery level percentage and  
other information.  
The initial screen displays four tabs: Personalize,  
Quick Tools, Support, and Storage Battery.  
Support  
Displays support information such as: Device  
Restart, Device Storage, My Account Feedback,  
T-Mobile Forums, T-Mobile on Twitter, and T-  
Mobile® Tech Assist™.  
150  
   
3. Tap Use GPS satellites. A green check mark  
indicates the GPS location feature is  
enabled.  
Navigation  
Google Maps Navigation (Beta) is an internet-  
connected turn-by-turn, GPS navigation system  
with voice guidance.  
4. Tap Use sensor aiding. A green check mark  
indicates the phone is enhancing its  
positioning ability and save power by using  
sensors.  
Caution! Traffic data is not real-time and  
directions may be wrong, dangerous,  
prohibited, or involve ferries.  
Navigation options  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Important! To receive better GPS signals, avoid  
using your device in the following  
conditions:  
(
Navigation). The navigation application  
can be configured from the main screen.  
2. Read the on-screen disclaimer and tap  
- inside a building or between  
buildings  
Accept  
.
- in a tunnel or underground passage  
- in poor weather  
3. Choose from the following on-screen  
options:  
- around high-voltage or  
electromagnetic fields  
- in a vehicle with tinted windows  
• Driving/Walking: configures the method of  
travel. Selection of Walking would negate the  
need to track traffic jams and obstructions.  
Driving mode enables the Settings feature:  
allows you to configure your Route options such  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Navigation).  
Enabling GPS Location  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) Location and security  
(
(
as: Avoid highways or Avoid tolls  
.
• Maps: enables the on-screen real-time map  
functionality.  
(
• Speak Destination: allows you to use the voice  
recognition feature to search for matching  
locations in your area.  
2. Tap Use wireless networks. A green check  
mark indicates the GPS location feature  
has been enhanced by using Wi-Fi and/or  
mobile networks to increase accuracy.  
Applications and Development  
151  
   
• Type Destination: allows you to manually enter  
a destination address (via the on-screen  
keypad).  
• Gas Stations: displays gas station location  
relative to your current location.  
• ATMs & Banks: displays ATM and Bank  
locations relative to your current location.  
• Restaurants: displays restaurant and eatery  
locations relative to your current location.  
• Contacts: allows you to receive turn-by-turn  
directions to the address stored for a selected  
Contacts entry.  
• Starred Places: allows you to obtain directions  
to locations that have been starred within Google  
maps (maps.google.com).  
Press  
to access additional options:  
Search: manually search for a destination address,  
place, name of business, or even a type of business.  
Set Destination: returns you to the navigation  
options screen where you can access a destination  
by either Speaking, Typing, or selecting from a  
Contacts entry or Starred Place.  
Navigation Map options  
Once on the map screen, you can access the  
following features:  
Destination: returns you to the previous Navigation  
options screen.  
Layers: allows you to switch map views. See  
previous description.  
Search by voice: Speak your destination instead of  
typing.  
Mute: allows you to mute the audio readout and  
directional information.  
Layers: allows you to switch map views:  
Traffic view: (available only in selected areas)  
Real-time traffic conditions are displayed over  
roads as color-coded lines. Each color  
represents how fast the traffic is moving.  
• Satellite: Maps uses the same satellite data as  
Google Earth. Satellite images are not real-time.  
Google Earth acquires the best imagery  
available, most of which is approximately one to  
three years old.  
Exit Navigation: terminates the application.  
More: provides additional application information  
such as: Help and Terms, Privacy & Notices.  
Caution! Navigation is a beta product. Use  
caution.  
• Parking: displays parking information relative to  
your current location.  
152  
Application version: displays the application  
version number.  
News & Weather  
The News & Weather application allows you to  
view the news and weather in your area.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
To access the settings:  
1. Press and then tap Settings  
2. Tap an available option: Weather settings  
News settings Refresh settings, and  
Application version  
.
(Applications) ➔  
(News & Weather).  
,
2. Select from any of the available scrollable  
,
tabs located at the top of the screen:  
.
Weather  
Entertainment  
,
Top Stories, U.S., Sports, and  
Places  
.
Google Places displays company logos on a layer  
of Google Maps. When viewing an area you can  
quickly locate a business or person, find out  
more information about the business, see  
coupons, public responses, and more.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
3. Tap the temperature to display a graph  
mapping the days temperature and  
humidity.  
4. While on the Weather screen, press  
to display the following options:  
• Refresh: allows you to refresh the screen. Your  
location and the weather is updated if there have  
been any changes.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Places).  
2. Locate and tap one of the listed places  
(Restaurants, Cafes, Bars, Attractions,  
[user added searches], or IN THIS AREA) A  
list of places within this category displays.  
3. Tap the Maps icon to launch the related  
maps feature.  
• Settings: allows you to set weather, news, and  
refresh settings.  
Weather settings: allows you to choose  
location(s) and set the metric for temperature  
displays.  
4. Press  
and then tap Add a search. The  
functions adds additional search shortcuts  
to the places screen.  
News settings: allows you to choose topics,  
configure settings for fetching articles and  
images, and view the terms of service for news  
service.  
Refresh settings: allows you to choose options  
for updating content.  
Applications and Development  
153  
         
Polaris Office  
Settings  
Polaris Office Mobile for Android is a Microsoft  
Office compatible office suite. This application  
provides a central place for managing your  
documents online or offline.  
This icon navigates to the sound and phone  
settings for your phone. It includes such settings  
as: display, security, memory, and any extra  
settings associated with your phone.  
The application can also open Adobe PDF  
(Portable Document Format) files.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Settings).  
– or –  
(
(
(
Applications) ➔  
(Polaris Office).  
Press  
and then tap  
2. Read the registration information and enter  
your Name and Email information (if  
desired).  
(
Settings).  
3. Tap Later to ignore this registration or  
Register to complete the process.  
4. On its initial launch, tap an available tab:  
Slacker  
Slacker offers free, internet radio for mobile  
phones.  
(New): creates a new office document.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
• My Files: This is where you keep your  
documents on this device. You can manage  
documents, or send them to others, and upload  
the documents.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Slacker).  
Important! You must register and create a free  
account prior to using this service.  
• Recent docs: provides a list of recently opened  
documents.  
2. If prompted, enter your Email address and  
password.  
– or –  
• Web files: This provides your online storage  
information at Box.net. You can also share your  
documents to others without using email  
attachments.  
Tap Create Account if you have not created  
an account.  
(Search): allows you to search for  
3. Begin selecting the music you want to  
document files by using a text string.  
listen to.  
154  
             
Social Hub  
T-Mobile Mall  
This downloadable application provides access  
to several phone features and tunes.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Allows you to easily and intuitively satisfy all of  
your communication needs from within a single-  
user interface. E-mails, instant messaging,  
social network contents, and calendar contents  
from all major service providers are available.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. Read the on-screen disclaimer and tap  
agree  
3. Read the consecutive legal disclaimer  
(T-Mobile Mall).  
I
.
(Applications) ➔  
(Social Hub). The  
Welcome to Social Hub page describes all  
of the available features.  
screen and tap Yes or No to agree/disagree  
to its terms.  
2. Tap Setup now to setup your Social Hub  
account.  
4. Tap OK to complete the activation process.  
5. Review the on-screen options such as:  
3. Tap on an account type that you would like  
to setup. Choose from either email  
accounts, SNS accounts, or other IM  
accounts.  
Recommended  
Ringtones  
CallerTunes  
Applications  
Games  
4. If you choose an SNS account, read the  
SNS disclaimer, tap the I accept all the  
terms above checkbox, then tap Agree to  
continue.  
T-Mobile Name ID  
Allows you to modify the on-screen Caller ID  
information. Name ID identifies unknown callers  
by Name, City, and State.  
5. Tap Next  
.
6. Follow the on-screen instructions for  
adding an account.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(T-Mobile Name ID).  
7. From the Social Hub main screen, tap the  
Feeds or Messages tabs to see information  
pertaining to your account.  
2. Choose an on-screen option.  
8. To add another account, press  
Add  
account.  
Applications and Development  
155  
           
4. Tap the Due date field and enter a due date  
name using the keypad. If there is no date  
that the task is due, tap the No due date  
checkbox.  
T-Mobile TV HD  
T-Mobile TV is an application that allows you to  
get live TV and Video on Demand.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) T-Mobile TV HD).  
5. If desired, enter Task  
and Notes then tap Save  
6. At the Task list screen, press  
display the following options:  
,
Priority  
.
,
Reminder  
,
(
(
to  
Talk  
• Create: allows you to create a new task.  
• View by task: allows you to view tasks by task  
categories.  
You can instant message with Google Talk.  
Google Talk allows you to communicate with  
other people who are also connected with  
Google Talk on the phone or on the web.  
• Delete: allows you to delete one or all of your  
tasks.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Talk).  
• Search: allows you to search your tasks for a  
particular word or words.  
(
(
• List by: allows you to sort by Due date, Status, or  
Priority.  
Task  
• Sync Task: allows you to sync your tasks to any  
of your accounts.  
Allows you to keep track of both your current and  
upcoming tasks. You can also sync these tasks  
with different accounts.  
From the Task list screen, tap a task once you  
have completed it and a checkmark appears  
next to the task. The task name is also grayed  
out so that you can still read it.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Task).  
2. Tap Create task to start a new task entry.  
3. Tap the Name field and enter a task name  
using the keypad.  
156  
           
• Storage displays a visual graph indicating the  
available and used space within the System  
storage location, USB storage, and SD card  
location.  
Task Manager  
Sometimes your phone might seem to slow down  
over time, and the biggest reason for this are  
background applications. These are applications  
that were not properly closed or shutdown and are  
stillactivebutminimized.TheTaskManagernotonly  
lets you see which of these applications are still  
active in the background but also easily lets you  
choose which applications are left running and  
which are closed.  
• Help provides additional battery saving  
techniques.  
2. From the Active applications tab, tap Exit to  
close selected applications or tap Exit all to  
close all background running applications.  
TeleNav GPS  
TeleNav GPS Navigator is a driving aid that uses  
both audible and visual directions for GPS  
navigation.  
Shutting Down Applications  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Applications) ➔  
(
Task manager).  
– or –  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Press and hold  
then tap Task  
(
Applications) ➔  
(TeleNav GPS).  
manager. This screen contains the  
following tabs:  
2. If prompted, read the GPS Settings  
notification, tap GPS Settings button and  
follow the on-screen prompts to enable the  
necessary GPS location feature.  
• Active applications display those currently  
active applications running on your phone.  
• Downloaded displays any installed packages or  
applications from the Market that are taking up  
memory space. Tap Uninstall to remove them  
from your phone.  
3. Read the agreement and tap Accept to  
accept the terms, or tap Exit to close the  
window. Wait for the application to load  
required first-time use files.  
• RAM, displays the amount of current RAM  
(Random Access Memory) currently being used  
4. Enter a phone number and tap Submit  
.
5. If you have already registered an account  
and allow you to Clear memory  
.
with your phone number, enter your  
existing 4-digit PIN and tap Sign In  
.
– or –  
Applications and Development  
157  
         
Create a new PIN code and tap Create  
.
• Sharing allows you to setup sharing  
preferences.  
6. Use the available on-screen functions.  
Facebook: set up your Qik credentials for  
Facebook posting of videos.  
Tetris  
Tetris is a puzzle video game in which falling  
tetrominoes must be manipulated to form  
complete lines, which are then cleared from the  
grid.  
Twitter: set up your Twitter account sharing  
preferences.  
YouTube: set up your Qik credentials for  
YouTube posting of videos.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Tetris).  
People: set up your contact sharing parameters.  
2. Follow the on-screen setup and usage  
• Privacy allows you to select who can find you  
and see your videos.  
instructions.  
• M2M Settings allows you to configure the  
Mobile to Mobile video chat settings.  
Video Chat  
This is a mobile video sharing and 2-way video  
calling service. This application also lets you  
record and share experiences with your friends,  
family, and your favorite social networks.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
• Location allows you to select the level of location  
accuracy that is embedded into your Qik videos.  
When posting or sharing Qik video information  
with others, you can decide how accurate the  
related location information can be. Choose  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Video Chat) Sign  
up.  
from: Off City level, Street level, or Track live.  
,
2. Fill in the Email address, Username, and  
Password, then tap Sign up to create your  
new account.  
• Video encoding quality allows you to assign a  
video quality to the outbound video. Choose  
from: Low Normal, or High.  
,
3. Follow the on-screen instructions. For  
• About displays the version information for the  
more information, visit: http://qik.com/  
.
Qik Video Chat application.  
To adjust application settings:  
Recording a Video Chat  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
1. Press  
and then tap Settings.  
2. Choose from any of the following options:  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Video Chat).  
158  
                     
2. Tap Record & Share  
.
3. Read the one-time disclaimer describing  
Voice Recorder  
the public nature of your videos and tap  
OK  
.
The Voice Recorder allows you to record an  
audio file up to one minute long and then  
immediately send it as a message.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
4. Tap Record to start recording.  
– or –  
Tap Stop to end the recording process.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Voice recorder).  
5. Enter a title for your video segment and  
select those services you wish to use to  
distribute your video.  
2. Tap Record icon to record an audio file.  
3. Tap Stop to stop recording. The file  
automatically saves to the Voice list.  
4. From the Recorded files page, press  
and then tap Share and select a method in  
which to share this audio file. Selections  
are: Messaging, Bluetooth, Gmail, or  
Email. Refer to each specific section,  
depending on the method you selected to  
send this voice recording.  
Services such as Twitter, Facebook, YouTube,  
SMS, and E-mail ask that you select a recipient  
for your video segment.  
Videos  
The Video Player application plays video files  
stored on your microSD card.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Videos).  
(
(
Voice Search  
The Voice Search feature is a voice-activated  
application that allows you to tell the phone what  
to search for and then the phone activates a  
Google search based on what you said.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Visual Voicemail  
Visual Voicemail enables users to view a list of  
people who left a voicemail message, and listen  
to the any message they want without being  
limited to chronological order.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Voice Search).  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Visual Voicemail).  
(
(
Applications and Development  
159  
                 
2. Tap Speak now and then speak your search  
command slowly and clearly.  
Google searches for the information and  
displays related information in the  
browser.  
2. If prompted, log into your existing account  
or create a new one.  
3. Follow the on-screen prompts.  
YouTube  
YouTube is a video sharing website on which  
users can upload and share videos, and view  
them in MPEG-4 format.  
Web  
Open the browser to start surfing the web. The  
browserisfullyoptimizedandcomeswithadvanced  
functionality to enhance the Internet browsing  
feature on your phone.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(YouTube).  
2. When the screen loads you can begin  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Web).  
searching and viewing posted videos.  
(
(
To configure YouTube Settings:  
Press  
and then tap Settings and  
configure the following parameters:  
• High quality on mobile, when enabled, allows  
you to start all videos in high quality mode while  
you are connected to a mobile network.  
• Caption font size allows you to set the font size  
used by on-screen captions. Choose from:  
Small, Medium, Large, or Extra Large.  
Wi-Fi Calling  
This feature allows you to make calls using a Wi-  
Fi over the T-Mobile network.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Wi-Fi Calling).  
(
(
• Clear search history allows you to clear any  
previous YouTube searches from appearing  
within the search box.  
Yelp  
Yelp is an online urban city guide that helps  
people find cool places to eat, shop, drink, relax  
and play. Its the fun and easy way to find, review  
and talk about what's great in your world  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Yelp).  
160  
                   
• SafeSearch filtering allows you to configure  
block settings for videos containing restricted  
content. This option blocks these videos from  
appearing within your search results. Choose  
from: Don’t filter, Moderate, or Strict blocking.  
• Help provides answers to most YouTube  
questions.  
• Feedback allows you to provide user feedback  
to YouTube.  
• Google Mobile Terms of Service  
YouTube Terms of Service  
• Google Mobile Privacy Policy  
YouTube Privacy Policy  
• Application version displays the software  
version for the current YouTube application.  
To watch a high quality video:  
Press  
and then tap Settings  
High  
quality on mobile  
.
Zinio Reader  
Launches a digital magazine reader. Zinio has  
transformed your favorite print magazines into  
digital format.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Applications) ➔  
(Zinio Reader).  
2. Tap sign in if you already have an account  
or tap create an account to continue.  
3. Follow the on-screen prompts.  
Applications and Development  
161  
   
Section 10: Connections  
Your phone is equipped with features that allow  
you to quickly connect to the web.  
Hot Trends: provides quick links to current Internet  
hot topics.  
Internet  
Quick Links: provides a series of application  
shortcuts. These shortcuts can be edit and  
managed.  
Your phone is equipped with a Google browser to  
navigate the mobile web. This section explains  
how to navigate the browser and use the basic  
features.  
Headlines: displays current Weather and headline  
information. These entries can be edit and  
configured.  
Accessing the Internet  
To access the Browser:  
Directory: provides a grid listing of additional social  
media, news, and other links. Tap Show More  
Categories to reveal additional entries.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Web).  
(
(
Navigating with the Browser  
1. To select an item, touch an entry.  
2. To scroll through a website, sweep the  
screen with your finger in an up or down  
motion.  
Note: You must disable your Wi-Fi connection if  
you wish to view the web2go home page  
Homepage  
When you access the Browser, the web2go home  
3. To return to the previous page, press  
.
page displays the following topics:  
Browser Options  
Google Search: allows you to quickly search for  
online topics using the Google search engine.  
Advertisement: provides an on-screen  
advertisement bubble providing suggested phone  
applications.  
1. From the home page, press  
to access  
the following options:  
• New window: displays a new window so you  
can browse multiple URLs. For more information,  
refer to “Adding and Deleting Windows”  
on page 164.  
Recommended: provides recommended apps.  
162  
               
• Windows: displays a list of the windows you  
have open.  
Settings: allows you to change the way you  
view your web pages by changing these options.  
See “Browser Settings” on page 166.  
• Browser brightness: allows you to manually  
adjust the screen brightness.  
Entering a URL  
You can access a website quickly by entering the  
URL. Websites are optimized for viewing on your  
phone.  
Note: If the Automatic brightness feature is  
enabled (Settings  
Display  
Brightness),  
you can not modify the browser’s brightness  
setting.  
To enter a URL and go to a particular website:  
From the web2go homepage, locate the  
• Stop/Refresh: stops the load of the new page or  
reloads the contents of the current page.  
• Forward: forwards the browser to another web  
page.  
URL field at the top of the screen, enter the  
URL and tap  
.
Note: This is not the same application as the  
Google Search Widget. The web2go screen  
can not be accessed via a Wi-Fi connection.  
• More: displays the following additional options:  
Add bookmark: allows you to add a URL to  
your bookmark list.  
Search the Internet  
Add shortcut to Home: adds a shortcut to your  
web2go homepage on your phone’s Home  
screen.  
To perform an internet search using keywords:  
1. From within the Google search application,  
tap the Google search field, enter the  
keyword(s) to search using the  
Find on page: allows you to search in the  
current page.  
on-screen keypad.  
Page info: displays information about the  
selected page.  
2. Tap  
displays.  
. A list of search results  
Share page: allows you to share the page using  
Gmail or as a message.  
3. Tap a link to view the website.  
Downloads: displays the download history.  
Connections  
163  
     
Adding and Deleting Windows  
You can have up to eight Internet windows open  
at one time. To add a new window, follow these  
steps:  
Using Bookmarks  
While navigating a website, you can bookmark a  
site to quickly and easily access it at a future  
time. The URLs (website addresses) of the  
bookmarked sites display in the Bookmarks  
page. From the Bookmarks page you can also  
view your Most visited websites and view your  
History.  
1. From the webpage, tap  
Bookmarks page displays. Additional  
pages include Most visited and History  
2. Press to display the following  
options:  
1. From your browser, press  
tap New window.  
– or –  
and then  
Press  
and then tap Windows  
New  
. The  
window  
.
2. A new browser window displays.  
.
3. Press  
and then tap Windows to see a  
list of all open windows.  
• Bookmark last-viewed page: Creates a new  
bookmark for the last webpage that you viewed.  
• List/Thumbnail view: Select Thumbnail view  
(default) to view a thumbnail of the webpage with  
the name listed, or select List view to view a list  
of the bookmarks with Name and URL listed.  
• Create folder: Creates a new folder in which to  
store new bookmarks.  
Note: This icon will display a number that  
corresponds to the current number of active  
browser windows,  
4. Scroll across the screen to view the  
currently active windows and tap an entry  
to launch the selected Internet window.  
5. Tap  
window.  
next to the listing to delete the  
• Change order: Rearranges the current  
bookmarks.  
• Move to folder: Selected bookmarks are moved  
to a selected folder.  
• Delete: Erases selected bookmarks.  
164  
 
3. Tap a bookmark to view the webpage, or  
touch and hold a bookmark for the  
following options:  
3. Assign a folder location. Home is the  
default.  
4. Tap OK. The new save page now appears  
on the Bookmarks page.  
• Open: Opens the webpage of the selected  
bookmark.  
Editing Bookmarks  
1. From the Bookmarks page, touch and hold  
the bookmark you want to edit.  
• Open in new window: Opens the webpage in a  
new window.  
• Edit bookmark: Allows you to edit the name or  
URL of the bookmark. For more information,  
refer to “Editing Bookmarks” on page 165.  
• Add shortcut to Home: Adds a shortcut to the  
bookmarked webpage to your phone’s Home  
screen.  
2. Tap Edit bookmark  
.
3. Use the on-screen keypad to edit the name  
of the bookmark or the URL.  
4. Tap OK  
.
Deleting Bookmarks  
1. From the Bookmarks page, touch and hold  
the bookmark you want to delete.  
• Share link: Allows you to share a URL address  
via Bluetooth, Email, Gmail, or Messaging.  
• Copy link URL: Allows you to copy the URL  
address to use in a message.  
2. Tap Delete bookmark  
.
3. At the confirmation window, tap OK  
.
Emptying the Cookies  
• Delete bookmark: Allows you to delete a  
bookmark. For more information, refer to  
“Deleting Bookmarks” on page 165.  
• Set as homepage: Sets the bookmark to your  
new homepage.  
A cookie is a small file placed on your phone by a  
website during navigation. In addition to  
containing some site-specific information, a  
cookie can also contain some personal  
information (such as a username and password)  
which might pose a security risk if not properly  
managed. You can clear these cookies from your  
phone at any time.  
Adding Bookmarks  
1. From the Home webpage, tap  
Add  
.
1. From the Home webpage, press  
and  
2. Use the on-screen keypad to enter the  
then tap More  
cookie data  
Settings  
Clear all  
name of the bookmark and the URL.  
.
Connections  
165  
             
2. Tap OK to delete the cookies or tap Cancel  
2. Tap any entry to display the selected  
to exit.  
webpage.  
Using Web History  
Browser Settings  
To make configure browser settings, follow these  
steps:  
The History list displays a list of the most  
recently viewed websites. These entries can be  
used to return to previously unmarked web  
pages.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Web).  
1. From the Home webpage, tap  
2. Press and then tap More  
Settings.  
History tab.  
3. Choose from the following on-screen  
A list of the most recently viewed websites  
displays.  
options:  
• Default zoom: Adjusts the zoom feature. Set to  
Far, Medium, or Close.  
2. Tap an entry to display the webpage.  
– or –  
• Open pages in overview: Displays an overview  
of recently viewed web pages.  
Press  
delete the current History list.  
Using Most Visited  
The Most visited list provides you with a list of  
the most visited and bookmarked websites.  
These entries are used to return to previously  
unmarked web pages.  
and then tap Clear history to  
Text encoding: Adjusts the current text  
encoding.  
• Block pop-up windows: Prevents popup  
advertisement or windows from appearing on-  
screen. Remove the checkmark to disable this  
function.  
1. From the Home webpage, tap  
Most visited tab.  
• Load images: Allows web page images to load  
along with the other text components of a loaded  
website.  
A list of your most frequently visited  
webpages displays. The most frequently  
visited web pages display at the top of the  
list.  
• Auto-fit pages: Allows web pages to be resized  
to fit as much of the screen as possible.  
• Landscape view only: Displays the browser in  
only the horizontal position.  
166  
   
• Enable JavaScript: Enables javascript for the  
current Web page. Without this feature, some  
pages may not display properly. Remove the  
checkmark to disable this function.  
• Clear form data: Deletes any stored data from  
previously filled out forms. Tap OK to complete  
the process.  
• Enable location: Allows websites to request  
access to your location.  
• Enable plug-ins: Allows the download of plug-  
ins such as Adobe Flash.  
• Clear location access: Clears location access  
for all websites. Tap OK to complete the process.  
• Remember passwords: Stores usernames and  
passwords for visited sites. Remove the  
checkmark to disable this function.  
• Open in background: New pages are launched  
in a separate page and displayed behind the  
current one. Remove the checkmark to disable  
this function.  
• Set home page: Sets the current home page for  
the Web browser.  
• Clear passwords: Deletes any previously stored  
usernames or passwords. Tap OK to complete  
the process.  
• Default storage: Sets the default storage to  
Memory card.  
• Show security warnings: Notifies you if there is  
a security issue with the current website.  
Remove the checkmark to disable this function.  
• Set search engine: Allows you to choose a  
default search engine for your phone. Choose  
• Clear cache: Deletes all currently cached data.  
Tap OK to complete the process.  
• Clear history: Clears the browser navigation  
history. Tap OK to complete the process.  
• Accept cookies: Allows sites, that require  
cookies, to save and read cookies from your  
device.  
from: Google Yahoo!, or Bing.  
,
• Website settings: View advanced settings for  
individual websites.  
• Clear all cookie data: Deletes all current  
browser cookie files.  
• Reset to default: Clears all browser data and  
resets all settings to default.  
• Remember form data: Allows the device to  
store data from any previously filled out forms.  
Remove the checkmark to disable this function.  
Connections  
167  
         
Bluetooth Status Indicators  
The following icons show your Bluetooth  
connection status at a glance:  
Bluetooth  
About Bluetooth  
Bluetooth is a short-range communications  
technology that allows you to connect wirelessly  
to a number of Bluetooth devices, such as  
headsets and hands-free car kits, and Bluetooth-  
enabled handhelds, computers, printers, and  
wireless devices. The Bluetooth communication  
range is usually up to approximately 30 feet.  
Displays when Bluetooth is active.  
Displays when Bluetooth is connected  
(paired) and communicating.  
Bluetooth Settings  
The Bluetooth settings menu allows you to set up  
many of the characteristics of your device’s  
Bluetooth service, including:  
Turning Bluetooth On and Off  
To turn Bluetooth on:  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Bluetooth settings  
and then tap  
Entering or changing the name your device uses for  
Bluetooth communication and description  
Setting your device’s visibility (or “discoverability”)  
for other Bluetooth devices  
(
.
2. Tap the Bluetooth field to activate the  
feature (checkmark indicates active).  
Displaying your device’s Bluetooth address  
When active,  
area.  
displays in the Status  
To access the Bluetooth Settings menu:  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Bluetooth settings  
To turn Bluetooth off:  
(
1. Press  
and then tap  
.
(Settings) Wireless and network  
2. Verify Bluetooth is active. Indicated by a  
Bluetooth settings  
.
green check mark in the Bluetooth field.  
2. Tap the Bluetooth field to deactivate the  
3. Tap the Device name  
,
Visible, and Search  
feature.  
for devices fields to set the options.  
168  
             
To change your Bluetooth name:  
1. Verify Bluetooth is active.  
Pairing Bluetooth Devices  
The Bluetooth pairing process allows you to  
establish trusted connections between your  
device and another Bluetooth device. When you  
pair devices, they share a passkey, allowing for  
fast, secure connections while bypassing the  
discovery and authentication process.  
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, tap  
Device name  
.
3. Enter a new name.  
4. Tap OK to complete the rename process.  
To set visibility:  
Note: Pairing between two Bluetooth devices is a  
one-time process. Once pairing is  
1. Verify your Bluetooth is active.  
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, tap  
established the devices continue to  
recognize their partnership and exchange  
information without entering a passcode.  
Visible  
.
Making your device visible allows other  
devices to pair and communicate.  
To pair your device with another Bluetooth device:  
1. Verify Bluetooth is active.  
Note: Your device is visible for up to 120 seconds  
(2 minutes). This value appears as a  
countdown within this field.  
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, tap  
Visible  
.
Your device must be visible to successfully  
pair with an external device.  
To scan for Bluetooth devices:  
1. Verify Bluetooth is active.  
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, tap Scan  
for devices to search for visible external  
Bluetooth-compatible devices such as  
headsets, devices, printers, and  
computers.  
3. Tap Scan for devices. Your device displays  
a list of discovered in-range Bluetooth  
devices.  
4. Tap a device from the list to initiate pairing.  
5. Enter the passkey or PIN code, if needed,  
and tap OK  
.
Connections  
169  
       
6. The external device must accept the  
connection and enter your device’s PIN  
code.  
3. Tap OK to confirm disconnection.  
– or –  
From the Bluetooth settings page, touch  
and hold the name of the previously paired  
Once successfully paired to an external  
device,  
displays in the Status area.  
device, and select Disconnect  
.
Note: Due to different specifications and features  
of other Bluetooth-compatible devices,  
display and operations may be different,  
and functions such as transfer or exchange  
may not be possible with all Bluetooth-  
compatible devices.  
Note: Disconnections are manually done but often  
occur automatically if the paired device  
goes out of range of your phone or it is  
powered off.  
Deleting a Paired Bluetooth Device  
Deleting a device from your list removes its  
“connection record” and upon reconnection  
would require that you re-enter all the previous  
pairing information.  
Disconnecting a Paired Bluetooth  
Device  
Disconnecting a paired device breaks the  
connection between the device and your phone,  
but retains the knowledge of the pairing. At a  
later point when you wish to reconnect the  
device, there is no need to setup the connection  
information again.  
1. Verify Bluetooth is active.  
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, touch  
and hold the name of the previously paired  
device (from the bottom of the page). This  
opens the connected device’s menu  
options.  
1. Verify your Bluetooth is active.  
2. From the Bluetooth settings page, touch  
the previously paired device (from the  
bottom of the page).  
3. Tap Unpair to delete the paired device.  
170  
   
Sending Contacts via Bluetooth  
Enable Downloading for Web  
Applications  
Depending on your paired devices’ settings and  
capabilities, you may be able to send pictures,  
Contact information, or other items using a  
Bluetooth connection.  
Important! Before you can download a web  
application you must insert an SD into  
the phone and enable the Unknown  
sources feature (enables  
Note: Prior to using this feature, Bluetooth must  
first be enabled on both your phone and the  
external device, and the recipient’s device  
must be visible.  
1. Verify your Bluetooth is active and your  
phone is visible.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Applications  
.
2. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Contacts).  
2. Tap the Unknown sources check box.  
3. Tap OK to allow install of non-Market  
applications. Tap again to remove the  
checkmark and disable the installation of  
non-market applications.  
3. Tap the entry to open the overview page.  
4. Press  
via  
and then tap Send namecard  
Bluetooth and select a paired  
external Bluetooth device.  
Warning! Not all web applications are safe to  
download. In order to protect your phone  
and data, use Android Market to install  
Note: The external Bluetooth device must be  
visible and communicating for the pairing to  
be successful.  
5. A Bluetooth share notification displays in  
your notifications list.  
Connections  
171  
       
PC Connections  
Note: To use any downloaded market application  
that requires a USB connection between  
your phone and your PC, you should first set  
You can connect your device to a PC using an  
optional PC data cable using various USB  
connection modes. Mass storage is the default  
connection method.  
the USB setting to Mass storage  
.
Mass storage: allows you to use the onboard  
storage capacity of the phone to store and  
upload files. This option allows your computer to  
detect the phone as a removable storage drive.  
2. Connect the multifunction jack on your  
device to a PC using an optional PC data  
cable.  
A pop-up window displays on the PC when  
connected.  
Kies air: allows you to sync your Windows PC  
wirelessly with your phone provided they are  
both on the same Wi-Fi network.  
3. Open the folder to view files.  
4. Copy files from the PC to the memory card.  
Connecting as a Mass Storage Device  
PriortousingKiesairforPhoneUpdate  
Before using Kies air to upgrade your device, it is  
recommended that you backup your personal  
data prior to use.  
You can connect your device to a PC as a  
removable disk and access the file directory. If  
you insert a memory card in the device, you can  
also access the files directory from the memory  
card by using the device as a memory card  
reader.  
To export a Contact list to your microSD card:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Contacts).  
2. Press  
3. Tap Export to SD card  
Note: The file directory of the memory card  
displays as a removable disk, separate from  
the internal memory.  
and then tap Import/Export  
.
1. Insert a memory card into the device to  
transfer files from or to the memory card.  
Verify your images and videos are on your microSD  
card:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Gallery).  
172  
           
2. Verify the Gallery contains all of your  
pictures and videos.  
4. If prompted, select a network. Choose  
from either Wi-Fi or Portable Wi-Fi hotspot  
.
3. Remove the back cover and remove the  
internal microSD card prior to initiating a  
Kies air update.  
5. Write down the on-screen URL address.  
Important! Both your phone and your computer  
must be connected to the same  
Enabling USB Debugging  
Wireless Access Point (WAP).  
USB debugging must be enabled before being  
able to use the Development feature.  
6. From your computer, enter the URL in your  
Web browser.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Development.  
(Settings) Applications  
7. If prompted, an Access Request prompt is  
displayed on your device. Tap Allow to  
permit connection between the computer  
and device.  
2. Tap the USB debugging field to verify the  
feature is active before connecting your  
USB cable.  
3. Using an optional PC data cable, connect  
the multifunction jack on your device to a  
PC.  
8. On your computer, you may be prompted  
to run a Java plugin for a  
TransferManagerApplet. Click Run  
.
Kies Air  
9. Tap the Remember for today checkbox if  
you will be using Kies air with the same PC  
later.  
Kies Air allows you to sync your Windows PC  
wirelessly with your phone provided they are  
both on the same Wi-Fi network. You can view  
and share call logs, videos, photos, music,  
bookmarks, ringtones, and even send SMS  
messages from your PC.  
10. From your PC, a security warning may be  
displayed asking if you want to run this  
application. Click Run to continue.  
11. On your PC, the Kies air screen is  
1. Sign onto the same Wi-Fi network from  
your phone and from your PC.  
displayed. On your phone, the  
icon  
appears at the top of your screen.  
2. From the Home screen, tap  
(Applications) ➔  
(Kies air).  
3. From the Kies air homescreen, tap Start  
.
Connections  
173  
   
12. Follow the on-screen instructions to view  
and share information between your phone  
and PC.  
Activating Wi-Fi  
By default, your device’s Wi-Fi feature is turned  
off (deactivated). Activating Wi-Fi allows your  
device to discover and connect to compatible in-  
range WAPs (Wireless Access Points).  
13. Click a link from the left navigation pane to  
access one of several device file  
categories such as:  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
settings  
2. Tap Wi-Fi to activate the feature. A  
and then tap  
(
Wi-Fi  
[Device Name] - provides an overview of all the  
main categories.  
.
Photos/Videos/Music  
Ringtones  
checkmark indicates that Wi-Fi is active.  
The device scans for available in-range  
wireless networks and displays them  
under Wi-Fi networks on the same screen.  
Bookmarks  
Messages/Call Log/Contacts  
File Explorer  
Connecting to a Wi-Fi Network  
Language settings  
1. Press  
and then tap  
14. To exit the Kies air application, tap Stop on  
your device, then close out the Web  
browser on your computer.  
(Settings) Wireless and network  
Wi-Fi  
settings  
.
The network names and security settings  
(Open network or Secured with WEP) of  
detected Wi-Fi networks display in the Wi-  
Fi networks section.  
Wi-Fi  
About Wi-Fi  
Wi-Fi (short for "wireless fidelity") is a term used  
for certain types of Wireless Local Area Networks  
(WLAN). Wi-Fi communication requires access to  
an existing and accessible Wireless Access Point  
(WAP). These WAPs can either be Open  
(unsecured) as within most Hot Spots, or  
Secured (requiring knowledge of the Router  
name and password).  
2. Tap the network you wish to connect to.  
Note: When you select an open network you are  
automatically connected.  
3. Enter a wireless password (if necessary).  
174  
         
Activate and Deactiavte Wi-Fi from the  
Notification bar.  
Manually Add a New Network  
Connection  
1. Tap Add Wi-Fi network  
.
Note: Use of wireless data connections such as  
Wi-Fi and Bluetooth can reduce battery life  
and use times.  
2. Enter the Network SSID (the name of your  
Wireless Access Point).  
3. Tap the Security field and select a security  
option. This must match the current  
security setting on your target WAP.  
4. Enter your WAP’s password if the WAP is  
secure.  
Manually Scan for a Wi-Fi Network  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Wireless and network  
settings  
2. Press  
Wi-Fi Status Indicators  
Wi-Fi  
.
5. Tap Save to store the new information and  
connect to the target WAP.  
and then tap Scan  
.
The following icons indicate the Wi-Fi connection  
status:  
Note: No prompt to enter the WAP key displays if  
this is the second time to connect to a  
previously accessed or secured wireless  
network. The WAP key is required when the  
device is reset using factory default  
settings.  
Displays when Wi-Fi is connected,  
active, and communicating with a  
Wireless Access Point (WAP).  
Displays when Wi-Fi is active and  
there is an available open wireless  
network.  
Deactivating Wi-Fi  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Wi-Fi Advanced Settings  
The Wi-Fi settings - Advanced menu allows you  
to set up many of the device’s Wi-Fi services,  
including:  
(Settings) Wireless and network  
Wi-Fi  
settings  
.
2. Tap the Wi-Fi field to deactivate the  
feature. The checkmark grays.  
– or –  
Setting the Wi-Fi sleep policy  
Viewing the device’s MAC Address  
Configuring use of either a DHCP or Static IP  
Connections  
175  
         
To access the Wi-Fi Advanced Settings menu:  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) Wireless and network  
settings  
2. Press  
4. Tap USB tethering from the Tethering  
menu. This places a green check mark  
next to the entry and activates the feature.  
A Tethering or Hotspot active notification  
briefly appears on the screen. Look for the  
(
Wi-Fi  
.
and then tap Advanced  
.
Tethering active icon  
bar area of the screen.  
in the Status  
Tethering  
This option allows you to share your phone’s  
mobile data connection via a direct USB  
connection between your phone and computer. A  
wireless version of this same functionality would  
be the Portable Wi-Fi feature.  
To disconnect tethering:  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Tethering and portable hotspot  
and then tap  
(
.
2. Tap USB tethering from the Tethering menu  
to remove the check mark and deactivate  
the feature.  
Note: You can not mount your phone’s microSD  
card to your computer while using the USB  
tethering feature. If additional software or  
USB drivers are required, navigate to: http://  
3. Remove the USB cable from the phone.  
Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot  
This feature allows you to turn your phone into a  
Wi-Fi hotspot. The feature works best when used  
in conjunction with HSPA+ (4G) data services  
(although 3G service can also be used).  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Tethering and portable hotspot  
and then tap  
(
.
2. Plug in the USB cable between your  
computer and your phone.  
Important! The Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot service can  
not be active at the same time as Wi-  
Fi. Please close your Wi-Fi connection  
prior to launching the Portable Wi-Fi  
service.  
3. When prompted for a USB mode, press  
to exit the menu.  
176  
                 
Note: You must have a tethering plan on your  
account to use the Wi-Fi hotspot. You can  
not use data on the device while it is being  
used as a hotspot.  
Note: Using your 4G service and Portable Wi-Fi  
Hotspot drains your phone’s battery at a  
much faster rate than when using any other  
feature combination.  
The best way to keep using the phone as a  
hotspot is to have it connected to a power  
supply.  
To activate the Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot service:  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Tethering and portable hotspot  
2. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot settings  
and then tap  
(
To connect to the Hotspot:  
.
1. Enable Wi-Fi (wireless) functionality on  
your target device (laptop, media device,  
etc.).  
OK  
.
3. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot. This places a  
checkmark in the adjacent field to activate  
the service.  
2. Scan for Wi-Fi networks from the device  
and select your phone hotspot from the  
network list.  
4. Tap Portable Wi-Fi hotspot  
Yes to  
continue with the activation.  
The SSID name for your phone’s hotspot is  
determined by what you entered into the  
Network SSID field.  
5. Tap Configure portable Wi-Fi hotspot  
.
6. Create a new Network SSID name,  
configure the desired fields and tap Save  
Write down the SSID name.  
.
You can change the name by tapping Configure  
portable Wi-Fi hotspot  
Network SSID and  
7. Confirm the Portable Wi-Fi Portable Wi-Fi  
changing the entry.  
service icon  
screen.  
appears at the top of the  
3. Select this Hotspot and follow your on-  
screen instructions to complete the  
connection.  
Note: By default, the connection is open and not  
secured. It is recommended that you access  
the Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot settings and  
create a secure connection by using a  
password for communication.  
4. Launch your Web browser to confirm you  
have an Internet connection.  
Connections  
177  
   
To secure the Portable Hotspot service:  
The two most common methods for securing  
your connection to the Hotspot are to a security  
method (WPA2 PSK) and to Hide your phone’s  
SSID name.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Wireless and network  
Tethering and portable hotspot  
Wi-Fi hotspot settings  
Wi-Fi hotspot  
Portable  
Configure portable  
.
2. Tap the Security field and select WPA2 PSK  
3. With security enabled, enter a new  
password into the Password field.  
.
Important! The more complex the password, the  
harder it will be for intruders to break  
your security. It is recommended that  
you not use names, birthdays, or other  
personal information.  
4. Tap Save to store the new settings.  
178  
   
Section 11: Time Management  
This section describes how you can manage  
time using time-related applications such as the  
Calendar, Alarm Clock, Analog or Digital clock,  
and the World clock.  
• Delete: allows you to delete All events, All events  
before today, or an individual event.  
• Settings: displays a list of configurable settings.  
Creating a Calendar Event  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Calendar  
With the Calendar feature, you can consult the  
calendar by day, week, or month, create events,  
and set an alarm to act as a reminder.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Calendar).  
2. From the Month tab, press  
Create.  
Calendar Settings  
(
Applications) ➔  
(
Calendar). The  
Using the Calendar settings you can select the  
day with which you want the calendar to begin.  
You also select how you want to view the  
calendar, by Month, Week, or Day or determine  
how to manage events, notifications, sounds,  
and defaults reminders.  
Calendar displays four tabs:  
• Month: displays the Month view.  
• Week: displays the Week view.  
• Day: displays the Day view.  
• List: allows you to search for events for the  
selected Month, Week, or Day, or you can look  
for events for a future date.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
.
2. Press Settings  
.
2. Press  
options:  
and select one of the following  
3. Tap Calendars and select the calendar  
categories you want to display or tap All  
• Create: creates a new Event.  
• Go to: displays a specific date.  
Today: displays the date highlighted with a Blue  
box highlighting the date.  
calendar. A check mark indicates selection.  
4. Tap Default view and select a view: Month  
Week Day, or List  
5. Tap Day view and select a type: Time grid  
or Event list  
6. Tap First day of week and select either  
Monday or Sunday  
Time Management  
,
,
.
,
• Search: allows you to search within your current  
events.  
.
.
179  
         
7. Tap Hide declined events to activate this  
option. A check mark indicates selection.  
8. Tap Hide contacts’ anniversaries to activate  
this option. A check mark indicates  
selection.  
Setting an Alarm  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Clock).  
2. Tap Create alarm).  
(
3. Use the plus or minus symbols to enter the  
hour, and minutes, then tap AM or PM  
(toggles depending on which was last  
selected).  
9. Tap Lock time zone (to lock event time  
based on your current user-selected time  
zone). Select a time zone from within the  
Select time zone field.  
4. Tap the Alarm repeat field and tap the  
number of times you want this alarm to  
10. Tap Set alerts and notifications to adjust the  
event notification method. Choose from:  
repeat. Selections are: One-time event  
,
Alert  
11. Tap Vibrate to activate this notification  
option. Selections are: Always Only in  
Silent mode, or Never  
,
Status bar notification, and Off.  
Daily Every weekday(Mon-Fri), or One-time  
,
event. If you selected Weekly, a button row  
displays. Tap each day of the week in  
which you want this alarm to repeat, then  
,
.
tap OK  
.
12. Tap Select ringtone to assign a ringtone to  
a calendar event notification.  
5. Tap the Alarm type field and select one of  
the following: Melody  
and melody, or Briefing  
,
Vibration Vibration  
.
,
13. Tap Calendar sync and select the type of  
general synchronization settings you want.  
A check mark indicates selection.  
6. Slide the slider bar left or right in the Alarm  
volume field to decrease or increase the  
alarm volume. A sample of the volume  
level plays.  
Clock  
This feature allows you to create an alarm to ring  
at a specified time, track time in other parts of  
the world, use a stopwatch, or set a timer.  
7. Tap the Alarm tone field and select one of  
the following: Sounds, or Go to My files  
Locate a sound to use as an alarm ringtone  
then tap OK to activate the ringtone.  
.
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Clock).  
(
(
180  
       
8. Tap the radio button to activate a tone for  
the Snooze. Tap the field to assign a  
duration time (3 minutes, 5 minutes, 10  
minutes, 15 minutes, or 30 minutes) and  
snooze repetition (1 time, 2 times, 3 times,  
5 times, and 10 times).  
Turning Off an Alarm  
To stop an alarm when it sounds, touch  
and slide to the right.  
Setting the Snooze Feature  
To activate the Snooze feature after an  
alarm sounds, touch and slide  
left. Snooze must first be set in the alarm  
settings.  
to the  
• Duration indicates the length of time the alarm  
will remain silent between alarm notifications  
(snooze time).  
World Clock  
This feature allows you to find out what time it is  
another part of world.  
• Snooze repeat indicates the numbers of snooze  
sessions that are assigned to this alarm. How  
many times will the snooze silence the alarm.  
9. Tap the radio button to activate Smart  
alarm which slowly increases screen  
brightness and the volume of nature tones  
to simulate dawn breaking.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
2. Tap the World clock tab.  
3. Tap Add city) then scroll and select  
(Clock).  
(
the desired city, or tap in the search field to  
locate a city.  
Tap the field to assign a duration time (3  
min, 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, or 30 min) and  
nature tone (Morning, Breeze, Mist, Forest,  
Light, or Rain).  
• Duration indicates the length of time the alarm  
will remain silent between alarm notifications.  
Tone provides one of several nature sounds that  
are used as the alarm tone.  
To assign DST settings:  
1. Locate a desired city from the World Clock  
list.  
2. Touch and hold a city and select DST  
settings  
.
3. Select a DST setting (Automatic, Off, 1  
hour or 2 hours).  
10. Tap the Name field and enter a name for  
this Alarm.  
11. Tap Save to store the new alarm event.  
Time Management  
181  
         
Stopwatch  
This feature allows you to capture elapsed time  
while letting the stopwatch keep running.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Configuring a Desk Clock  
This feature lets you activate an on-screen clock  
that can be viewed when the device is docked.  
From the Home screen, tap  
Applications) Clock) Desk  
clock tab.  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Clock) ➔  
(
(
Stopwatch tab.  
2. Tap Start to start the stopwatch counter.  
3. Tap Lap to begin the lap time counter.  
4. Tap Stop to stop the counter.  
5. Tap Restart to restart the lap counter. You  
can have multiple lap times.  
6. Tap Reset to reset the counter.  
Setting a Timer  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Clock) Timer tab.  
2. Tap the hr min, or sec field and use the on-  
,
screen keypad to enter the hour, minute, or  
seconds. The timer plays an alarm at the  
end of the countdown.  
3. Tap Start to start the timer.  
4. Tap Stop to stop the timer or Reset to reset  
the timer and start over.  
5. Tap Restart to resume the timer counter.  
182  
         
Section 12: Changing Your Settings  
This section explains the sound and phone settings  
for your phone. It includes such settings as: display,  
security,memory,andanyextrasettingsassociated  
with your phone.  
2. Tap Wi-Fi. A check mark displayed  
indicates Wi-Fi is active.  
Wi-Fi settings  
Once set up for Wi-Fi connectivity, your phone  
automatically uses Wi-Fi, when available, for all  
your mobile phone services.  
Wireless and Networks  
Using Flight mode  
Flight mode allows you to use many of your  
phone’s features, such as Camera, Games, and  
more, when you are in an airplane or in any other  
area where making or receiving calls or data is  
prohibited.  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
settings  
2. Configure the settings as desired.  
and then tap  
(
Wi-Fi  
.
The available connection types displayed with a  
security type displayed next to them.  
Important! When your phone is in Flight mode, it  
cannot send or receive any calls or  
access online information or  
applications.  
Network Notification  
By default, when Wi-Fi is on, you receive  
notifications in the Status bar anytime your  
phone detects an available Wi-Fi network. You  
can deactivate this feature if you do not want to  
receive notifications.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Wireless and network  
.
2. Tap Flight mode. A check mark displayed  
next to the feature indicates Flight mode is  
active.  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
settings  
and then tap  
(
Wi-Fi  
.
Activating Wi-Fi  
2. Tap Network notification. A check mark  
displayed next to the feature indicates  
Network notification is active.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Wireless and network  
Wi-Fi  
settings  
.
Changing Your Settings  
183  
             
3. Tap Network notification again to remove  
the check mark and deactivate this  
feature.  
3. Tap Add Wi-Fi network  
4. Enter the SSID (Service Set Identifier) and  
Security settings then tap Save  
.
.
WPS Button Connection  
Note: An SSID is a unique key which identifies a  
wireless LAN. Its purpose is to stop other  
wireless equipment from accessing your  
LAN — whether accidentally or  
The WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) button is a  
standard for easy and secure wireless network  
set up and connections. To use WPS, the  
connecting device must support WPS and be  
compatible with Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA)  
security. WPS can automatically set up a random  
network name and WPA wireless security for  
wireless Wi-Fi phones, routers, access points,  
computers, adapters, and other electronic  
devices.  
intentionally. To communicate, wireless  
devices must be configured with the same  
SSID.  
Bluetooth settings  
In this menu you can activate Bluetooth, view or  
assign a device name, activate your phone so  
other Bluetooth devices can discover it, or scan  
for other, available Bluetooth devices with which  
to pair.  
WPS allows you to push buttons instead of  
entering a network name and wireless security  
PIN.  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
settings  
2. Tap WPS button connection  
and then tap  
Activating Bluetooth  
(
Wi-Fi  
Press  
and then tap  
.
(Settings) Wireless and network  
.
Bluetooth settings and tap Bluetooth to turn  
it on.  
3. Press the WPS button on your Wi-Fi access  
point within 2 minutes.  
Manually Adding a Wi-Fi Network  
Note: Bluetooth must be enabled prior to use.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Wireless and network  
Wi-Fi  
settings  
.
2. Tap Wi-Fi to turn it on.  
184  
       
Activating the Device Name  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Important! Some Bluetooth devices are secured  
and require a PIN number to confirm  
and pair with them.  
(
Bluetooth settings  
Device name. The  
assigned device name displays.  
2. Press to erase the current device  
3. Enter a PIN to pair with the device, if one is  
required, and tap Accept or Decline  
.
name and enter a new name for this  
device using the keyboard.  
Tethering  
This option allows you to share your phone’s  
mobile data connection via a direct USB  
connection between your phone and computer. A  
wireless version of this same functionality would  
be the Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot feature.  
3. Tap OK to confirm your setting.  
Activating Visibility  
Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Bluetooth settings Visible  
and then tap  
(
.
Note: You can not mount your phone’s microSD  
card to your computer while using the USB  
tethering feature. If additional software or  
USB drivers are required, navigate to: http://  
The phone is now activated for discovery  
for 119 seconds so you can pair with  
another device. After 119 seconds the  
phone becomes undiscoverable again.  
Scanning for Devices  
This option allows you to scan for active  
Bluetooth devices so you can pair with them.  
Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Tethering and portable hotspot  
and then tap  
(
.
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Wireless and network  
Bluetooth settings  
Search for devices.  
Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot  
Your phone begins scanning and lists any  
discovered devices in the Bluetooth  
devices section.  
This feature allows you to turn your phone into a  
Wi-Fi hotspot. The feature works best when used  
in conjunction with HSPA+ (4G) data services  
(although 3G service can also be used).  
2. Tap a device name to pair with the device.  
Changing Your Settings  
185  
             
To establish a PPTP VPN (Point-to-Point Tunneling  
Protocol):  
1. Establish a VPN name (a name for this  
connection).  
Important! The Portable Wi-Fi Hotspot service can  
not be active at the same time as Wi-  
Fi. Please close your Wi-Fi connection  
prior to launching the Portable Wi-Fi  
service.  
2. Assign a server by using Set VPN server.  
3. Enable encryption (if desired).  
4. Set the DNS search domains.  
To add an L2TP VPN (Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol):  
1. Establish a VPN name (a name for this  
connection).  
VPN settings  
The VPN settings menu allows you to set up and  
manage Virtual Private Networks (VPNs).  
2. Assign a server by using Set the VPN  
server.  
Important! Before you can use a VPN you must  
3. Enable L2TP secret.  
establish and configure one.  
4. Set L2TP secret.  
Adding a VPN  
5. Set the DNS search domains.  
Before you add a VPN you must determine which  
VPN protocol to use: PPTP (Point-to-Point  
Tunneling Protocol), L2TP (Layer 2 Tunneling  
Protocol), L2TP/IPSec PSK (Pre-shared key  
based L2TP/IPSec), or L2TP/IPSec CRT  
(Certificate based L2TP/IPSec).  
To add an L2TP/IPSec PSK VPN (Pre-shared key  
based L2TP/IPSec):  
1. Establish a VPN name (a name for this  
connection).  
2. Assign a server by using Set the VPN  
server.  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
settings  
and then tap  
3. Utilize the Set IPSEc pre-shared key.  
4. Enable L2TP secret.  
(
VPN  
.
5. Set L2TP secret.  
2. Tap Add VPN  
.
6. Set the DNS search domains.  
186  
     
To add an L2TP/IPSec CRT VPN (Certificate based  
L2TP/IPSec):  
Use packet data  
Allows you to activate data usage on your phone.  
1. Establish a VPN name (a name for this  
connection).  
Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks Use packet data  
Data Roaming  
and then tap  
(
2. Assign a server by using Set the VPN  
server.  
.
3. Enable L2TP secret.  
4. Set L2TP secret.  
Data roaming allows you to connect to your  
service provider’s partner networks and access  
data services when you are out of your service  
providers area of coverage.  
5. Set user certificate.  
Note: A user certificate must be installed to use  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks  
and then tap  
this setting.  
(
.
6. Set CA certificate.  
2. Tap Data roaming to connect to data  
services while roaming outside your  
network.  
– or –  
Note: A CA certificate must be installed to use this  
setting.  
7. Set the DNS search domains.  
Tap Data roaming again to remove the  
green check mark and deactivate the  
feature.  
Mobile networks  
Before you use applications such as Google  
Maps and find your location or search for places  
of interest, you must enable the Mobile networks  
options.  
Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks  
The following options display:  
and then tap  
(
.
Changing Your Settings  
187  
           
Access Point Names  
To access a wireless access point:  
2. Tap GSM/WCDMA (Auto mode). A check  
mark displays next to this option to  
indicate that it is active. This is the default  
mode for this phone.  
Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks Access Point Names. A  
and then tap  
(
Using the 2G (EDGE) Network Only  
If you are not using applications that require the  
3G network speed (any application that accesses  
the network or uses a browser), using the 2G  
network saves battery life.  
list of the Access point names display. The  
active access point displays a bright green,  
filled circle to the right of the name.  
Network mode  
You can configure your phone to either manually  
detect and use either a 2G (GSM) or 3G (WCDMA)  
data network connection.  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks Network mode  
and then tap  
(
.
2. Tap GSM only. A check mark displays next  
Press  
and then tap  
to this option to indicate that it is active.  
(Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks  
Network Mode.  
Note: Connecting to 2G networks slows the data  
transfer speed and time.  
Using the Fastest Available Network  
To confirm you are always using the fastest  
possible connection, the phone has an automatic  
detection method where it finds both the fastest  
and most stable connection/communication  
method. This phone is capable of using either  
4G/3G services for this connection.  
Using the 4G Network Only  
If you are using applications that require the 4G  
network speed, follow these instructions to  
connect to the 4G network.  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks Network mode  
and then tap  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks Network Mode  
and then tap  
(
(
.
.
2. Tap WCDMA only. A check mark displays  
next to this option to indicate that it is  
active.  
188  
                 
Network Operators  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Wireless and network  
Using this feature you can view the current  
network connection. You can also scan and  
select a network operator manually, or set the  
network selection to Automatic.  
Mobile networks  
Network operators.  
2. Tap Default setup  
.
3. Tap Manual to locate and connect to a  
1. Press  
Settings) Wireless and network  
Mobile networks  
and then tap  
network manually.  
– or –  
(
.
Tap Automatic to allow the device to  
automatically select a network.  
2. Tap Network operators. The current  
network connection displays at the bottom  
of the list.  
Call Settings  
To access the Call settings menu:  
Important! You must deactivate data service prior  
Press  
Settings) Call  
– or –  
From the Home screen, tap  
Settings Call  
and then tap  
to searching for an available network.  
(
.
3. Tap Search networks to manually search  
for a network.  
.
4. Tap Select automatically to automatically  
select a network connection.  
Configuring General Call Settings  
Configure the general call settings using this  
option.  
Note: Connecting to 2G networks slows the data  
transfer speed and time.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Settings Call  
2. Tap one of the following options:  
.
Default Setup Options  
Your phone default is set to Automatic (to  
automatically search for an available network.  
You can set this option to Manual to select a  
network each time you connect.  
• Call rejection: allows you to manage your  
rejection mode and rejection list.  
Auto reject mode: sets the phone to  
automatically reject incoming calls or messages.  
Changing Your Settings  
189  
         
Reject list: provides access to current rejection  
entries and numbers.  
Turn on proximity sensor: allows you to turn off  
the LCD when the phone is near your face during  
a call so you do not accidentally tap a key.  
• Call forwarding: configures call forwarding  
• Set reject messages: allows you to manage  
both existing rejection messages and create new  
ones.  
• Call alert: allows you to assign call alert tones  
and activate call alerts and vibration.  
• Additional settings: allows you to additional call  
Outgoing call vibration: vibrates the phone  
when the called party answers.  
Call status tones: assigns sounds settings  
during the call. Choose from: Call connect tone,  
Minute minder, and Call end tone.  
• Voicemail service: allows you to select the  
carrier used for your voicemail service. For more  
Alerts on call: selects whether alarm and  
message notification is turned off during a call.  
Choose from: Off, Sound, Voice or Vibration.  
• Voicemail: allows you to view the settings for  
your voicemail.  
• Call answering/ending: allows you to manage  
the settings for answering and ending calls.  
• Hearing aids: allows you to enable/disable  
hearing aid compatibility. For more information,  
Answering key allows you to press a key to  
answer the phone.  
Automatic answering, when connected,  
automatically answers a call via the headset after  
a period of time. Selections are: off, After 1  
second, After 2 seconds, After 3 seconds, After  
4 seconds, or After  
Configuring Call Forwarding  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Call  
Call forwarding.  
2. Tap an available option:  
5 seconds.  
• Always forward: incoming calls are re-routed to  
a secondary number that you specify.  
Power key ends calls allows you to press the  
power key to end the current call.  
• Forward when busy: forwards all your calls to  
voicemail when your phone is busy.  
190  
                               
• Forward when unanswered: automatically  
forwards to your voicemail number when the  
phone is not answered, and otherwise allows  
you to enter a voicemail number.  
• Call waiting: notifies you of an incoming call  
while you are on another call.  
• Auto redial: automatically redial the dialed  
number if it is unable to connect or the call is cut  
off.  
• Forward when unreachable: automatically  
forwards to your voicemail number when the  
phone is not in service, or is turned off.  
Fixed Dialing Numbers  
Fixed Dial Number (FDN), allows you to restrict  
outgoing calls to a limited set of phone numbers.  
Enabling FDN  
HAC Mode  
This menu is used to activate or deactivate  
Hearing Aid Compatibility for this device.  
1. Press  
Settings) Call  
Fixed Dialing Numbers  
2. Tap Enable FDN  
3. At the prompt, enter your PIN2 code and  
tap OK  
and then tap  
Additional settings  
.
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
(
Settings) Call  
.
2. Tap the Hearing aids field to activate the  
feature (green check mark), or tap it again  
to deactivate the feature. Off is the default  
setting.  
.
.
Important! Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code. If  
your SIM card does not, this menu  
does not display.  
Configuring Additional Voice Call  
Settings  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Call  
Additional settings.  
The PIN2 code is provided by your  
carrier. Entering the PIN2 incorrectly  
three times will cause the device to  
lock. Contact customer service for  
assistance.  
2. Tap one of the following options:  
• Caller ID: chooses whether your number is  
displayed when someone answers your outgoing  
call. Choose from: Network default, Hide  
number, or Show number.  
• Call barring: blocks specific types of calls (All  
outgoing calls, International calls, etc..).  
Changing Your Settings  
191  
                 
Changing the PIN2 Code  
4. Tap FDN list then press  
and then tap  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Add contact or edit the contacts that were  
(Settings) Call  
Additional settings  
stored.  
Fixed Dialing Numbers  
2. Tap Change PIN2  
.
Important! Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code. If  
your SIM card does not, this menu  
does not display.  
.
3. At the prompt, enter your old PIN2 code.  
4. At the prompt, enter a new PIN2 code.  
5. Confirm your PIN2 code.  
The PIN2 code is provided by your  
carrier. Entering the PIN2 incorrectly  
three times will cause the device to  
lock. Contact customer service for  
assistance.  
Important! Not all SIM cards use a PIN2 code. If  
your SIM card does not, this menu  
does not display.  
The PIN2 code is provided by your  
carrier. Entering the PIN2 incorrectly  
three times will cause the device to  
lock. Contact customer service for  
assistance.  
Voicemail  
From this menu, you can either view your  
voicemail number or enter a new one.  
1. Press  
Settings) Call  
2. Tap My carrier  
3. Tap Voicemail  
and then tap  
(
Voicemail service.  
.
Managing the FDN List  
Voice mail number to now  
When this feature is enabled, you can make calls  
only to phone numbers stored in the FDN list on  
the SIM card.  
view your number within the Voicemail  
number field.  
– or –  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Call  
Additional settings  
To enter a new voicemail number, tap  
Fixed Dialing Numbers  
2. Tap Enable FDN  
.
Voicemail  
number and tap OK  
Voice mail number, enter a  
.
.
3. At the prompt, enter your PIN2 code and  
tap OK.FDN is enabled.  
192  
   
2. Tap Vibration and select a vibration mode.  
Choose from: Always Never Only in silent  
mode, or Only when not in silent mode  
Sound Settings  
From this menu you can control the sounds on  
the phone as well as configure the display  
settings.  
,
,
.
Note: The Phone vibrate setting is independent of  
other call sounds settings. For example, if  
you have Silent mode enabled along with  
Phone vibrate, your phone won’t play a  
ringtone, but will vibrate for an incoming  
call.  
Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Sound settings  
.
The following options display:  
Silent mode  
Silent mode is convenient when you wish to stop  
the phone from making noise, in a theater for  
example. In Silent Mode the speaker is muted  
and the phone only vibrates to notify you of  
incoming calls, or other functions that normally  
have a defined tone or sound as an alert.  
Note: Use both the Silent mode and enable the  
Only when not in silent mode option to  
guarantee no vibrations or sounds from your  
phone.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Sound settings  
.
Adjusting the Volume Settings  
The Volume menu now provides access to  
various volume settings within one on-screen  
popup menu.  
2. Tap Silent mode  
.
– or –  
From the Home screen, press and hold the  
Lock key until Phone options displays.  
1. Press  
Settings) Sound settings  
2. Touch and drag the on-screen slider to  
and then tap  
(
Volume.  
3. Tap Silent mode to activate or deactivate  
this mode (the current mode displays).  
assign the volume settings for any of the  
following volume levels.  
Setup Phone Vibration  
1. Press  
and then tap  
• Incoming call  
,
Media, System, or Notification.  
(Settings) Sound settings  
3. Tap OK to assign the volume levels.  
Changing Your Settings  
193  
                   
Setup the Voice Call Ringtone  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) Sound settings  
2. Tap Phone ringtone  
Screen Lock Sounds  
The screen lock sounds option is used to  
activate/deactivate sounds when locking and  
unlocking the screen.  
(
.
.
1. Press  
and then tap  
3. Tap a ringtone from the available list. The  
ringtone briefly plays when selected.  
4. Tap OK to assign a ringer.  
(Settings) Sound settings  
.
2. Tap Screen lock sounds. A check mark  
displayed next to these features indicates  
active status.  
Setting a Notification Ringtone  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Notification  
Display Settings  
(Settings) Sound settings  
In this menu, you can change various settings for  
the display such as the font, orientation, pop-up  
notifications, puzzle lock feature, animation,  
brightness, screen timeout, power saving mode,  
and tv out settings.  
ringtone  
.
2. Tap one of the ringtones and tap OK  
.
Audible Tone Settings  
The Audible touch tones and Audible selection  
options are used when you use the dialing pad or  
making a screen selection. Each time you press  
a key or make a selection the selected tone  
sounds.  
Adjusting the Screen Display  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Display.  
2. Configure the following screen display  
1. Press  
and then tap  
settings:  
• Screen display  
(Settings) Sound settings  
.
2. Tap Audible touch tones or Audible  
selection. A check mark displayed next to  
these features indicates active status.  
Font style: sets the fonts used on the LCD  
display. Selections are: Default font. Tap Get  
fonts online to download additional fonts.  
Home screen Wallpaper: assigns an image  
from either the Gallery, Live wallpapers, or  
Wallpaper gallery to the Home screen.  
194  
             
Lock screen Wallpaper: assigns an image  
from either the Wallpaper gallery or Gallery to  
the Lock screen.  
• Screen timeout: adjusts the delay time before  
the screen automatically turns off. Selections  
are:  
15 seconds, 30 seconds, 1 minute, 2 minutes,  
10 minutes, and 30 minutes.  
Clock position: assigns the on-screen clock  
position to either the top, MIddle or Bottom of  
the screen.  
Touch key light duration: to adjust the light  
duration of the touch keys..  
Event notifications: assigns what type of on-  
screen notification you are prompted with.  
Choose from either: New messages or New  
emails.  
• Horizontal calibration: uses the accelerometer  
to calibrate the phone when held in a horizontal  
position.  
• Brightness: adjusts the on-screen brightness  
level.  
Adjusting Screen Brightness  
This feature configures the LCD Brightness  
levels.  
1. Press  
Settings) Display  
2. Touch and slide the on-screen slider to  
and then tap  
(
Brightness  
.
• Auto-rotate screen: when enabled, the phone  
automatically switches from portrait to landscape  
orientation and vice versa. When this setting is  
disabled, the phone displays in portrait mode  
only.  
adjust the level and tap OK  
.
Horizontal Calibration  
Calibrate your phone by using the built-in  
accelerometer.  
1. Press  
Settings) Display  
calibration  
and then tap  
Horizontal  
• Animation: determines whether some or all of  
the window elements animate. Selections are:  
No animations, Some animations, or All  
animations.  
(
.
Changing Your Settings  
195  
             
2. Place the phone on a level surface and tap  
Calibrate. The phone adjusts the level of  
the accelerometer. During the calibration  
process a green circle appears on-screen  
and the center circle adjusts to the center  
position.  
To activate additional power saving features:  
1. Activate Power saving mode.  
2. Tap any of the available fields to activate  
additional power saving parameters.  
Choose from:  
Turn Off Wi-Fi to disable Wi-Fi when it is not  
connected to an AP.  
Power Saving Mode  
Turn Off Bluetooth to disable Bluetooth when  
not in use or actively transmitting data.  
Turn Off GPS to disable the GPS location system  
when not in use.  
This feature allows you both automatically set  
the phone to use a power saving mode and  
configure additional power saving options  
manually, all in an effort to conserve battery  
power.  
Turn off Sync to disable the feature when the  
phone is not synchronizing with the server.  
• Brightness to enable or disable the adjustment  
of screen brightness. This field must be enabled  
before being able to adjust the brightness value.  
• Brightness to select the brightness percentage  
• Screen time-out to adjust the time delay before  
the screen turns off.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Power saving mode  
.
2. Confirm  
appears at the top of the  
screen. This indicates the power saving  
mode is active.  
To automatically enable power saving options:  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Power saving mode  
.
2. Tap Use Power saving mode to enable this  
feature when the battery level is low.  
3. Tap Power saving mode on at to assign the  
“battery low” level at which the power  
saving mode is activated. It is at this level  
that the automatic power saving function  
will “kick in”.  
• Power saving tips to display additional on-  
screen power saving information.  
4. Tap OK to store the new battery level.  
196  
         
Location and Security  
Screen Unlock Pattern  
Settings  
To secure data and limit phone access, set the  
phone to require a screen unlock pattern each  
time you turn on the device, or every time the  
phone wakes up from sleep mode (when the  
screen automatically turns off).  
The Location and Security settings allow you to  
configure phone location and security settings.  
Using Wireless Networks  
Before you use applications such as Google  
Maps and find your location or search for places  
of interest, you must enable the Use wireless  
networks option or enable the GPS satellites.  
Setting an Unlock Pattern  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Creating a screen unlock pattern increases  
security on the phone. When you enable the User  
visible pattern field, you will draw an unlock  
pattern on the screen whenever you want to  
unlock the phone’s buttons or touch screen.  
When you activate the User tactile feedback  
field, you feel vibration as feedback while  
drawing the pattern.  
(Settings) Location and security  
.
2. Tap Use wireless networks to enable  
location information using the wireless  
network.  
Enabling the GPS Satellites  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Location and security.  
Note: Make sure the Require Pattern field is  
2. Tap Use GPS satellites enable the GPS  
activated.  
satellite.  
Enabling the sensor aiding  
1. Press  
Settings) Location and security  
2. Tap Set screen lock Pattern  
3. Read the instructions then tap Next  
and then tap  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
.
(Settings) Location and security. For  
.
.
4. Review the onscreen animation procedure  
for drawing a pattern and tap Next when  
you are ready to draw a pattern.  
2. Tap Use sensor aiding enhances positioning  
and save power while using the sensors.  
Changing Your Settings  
197  
                   
5. Draw your pattern by touching your first  
on-screen point. Then, without removing  
your finger from the screen, drag your finger  
over adjacent points until the gray trace line  
overlaps each point and they are  
Using Visible a Pattern  
When enabled, this feature displays the onscreen  
lock grid that is used to unlock the phone.  
PIN Lock and Unlock  
1. Press  
and then tap  
highlighted with a green circle.  
(
Settings) Location and security  
2. Tap Set screen lock  
3. Tap PIN  
.
6. When you have connected at least four  
dots in a vertical, horizontal or diagonal  
direction, lift your finger from the screen  
.
.
4. Enter a PIN number using the numeric  
keypad and touch Continue to confirm the  
password.  
and tap Continue  
.
7. Confirm the new pattern by redrawing it  
and then tapping Confirm. The Unlock  
pattern is set.  
5. Confirm the PIN by re-entering it and tap  
OK to confirm.  
Changing the Screen Lock Pattern  
Your phone now requires you to enter this  
PIN number in order to unlock the phone.  
This feature allows you to change the previously  
stored unlock pattern and update it if necessary.  
This process is similar to changing your  
password from time to time.  
Password Lock and Unlock  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Location and security  
2. Tap Set screen lock  
3. Tap Password  
.
1. Press  
Settings) Location and security  
2. Tap Change screen lock  
and then tap  
.
(
.
.
.
4. Enter a password using the keypad and tap  
Continue to confirm the password.  
5. Confirm the password by re-entering it and  
tap OK to confirm.  
3. Retrace your current pattern on the screen.  
4. Tap Pattern and repeat steps 3 - 7 from the  
previous section.  
198  
 
Setting up SIM Card Lock  
Prevent another user from using your SIM card to  
make unauthorized calls or from accessing  
information stored on your SIM card by  
Device Administration  
Activating this feature allows Google to  
administrate your phone in a way similar to IT  
security settings on a corporate PC. This would  
be beneficial in the case that your phone was  
lost or stolen. The phone could be “deactivated”  
or “restricted” (through administration) from a  
remote location.  
protecting the information using a PIN code.  
1. Press  
Settings) Location and security  
2. Tap Set up SIM card lock  
3. Tap Lock SIM card, enter your SIM PIN  
code, then tap OK  
and then tap  
(
.
.
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Location and security  
.
.
2. Tap Select device administrators to begin  
configuring this setting.  
Note: You must activate Lock SIM card before you  
can change your SIM PIN code.  
3. Select an administrator device and follow  
the prompts.  
To change an existing SIM Card PIN:  
Credential Storage  
1. Tap Change SIM PIN  
2. Enter the old SIM PIN code and tap OK  
3. Enter the new SIM PIN code and tap OK  
.
This option allows certain applications to access  
secure certificates and other credentials.  
Certificates and credentials can be installed to  
the SD card and password protected.  
.
.
4. Re-type the new SIM PIN code and tap OK  
.
1. Press  
and then tap  
Password Settings  
When you create a phone password you can also  
configure the phone to display the password as  
you type it instead of using an asterisk (*).  
(Settings) Location and security  
.
2. Tap Use secure credentials to activate this  
feature. A check mark displayed next to  
the feature indicates secure credentials is  
active.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Location and security  
.
3. Tap Install from USB storage to install  
encrypted certificates from the USB  
Storage location.  
2. Tap Visible passwords to activate this  
feature.  
Changing Your Settings  
199  
     
4. Tap Set password to set or change the  
credential storage password.  
Note: If you are notified that you can not download  
a Market application because it comes from  
an “Unknown source”, enabling this option  
corrects this issue.  
5. Tap Clear storage to clear the storage (SD  
card or phone memory) of all contents and  
reset the credentials password.  
Managing Applications  
Applications  
This feature allows you to manage installed  
applications. You can view and control currently  
running services, or use the device for  
application development.  
This phone can be used for Android  
development. You can write applications in the  
SDK and install them on this device, then run the  
applications using the hardware, system, and  
network. This feature allows you to configure the  
device for development.  
You can also view the amount of memory or  
resources used as well as the remaining memory  
and resources for each of the applications on  
your phone and clear the data, cache, or  
defaults.  
Warning! Android Dev Phones are not intended for  
non-developer  
end-users. Because the device can be  
configured with system software not  
provided by or supported by Google or  
any other company, end-users operate  
these devices at their own risk.  
Press  
and then tap  
Manage  
(Settings) Applications  
applications  
.
Clearing Application Cache and Data  
Important! You must have downloaded  
applications installed to use this  
feature.  
Unknown Sources  
Before you can download a web application you  
must enable the Unknown sources feature  
(enables downloading). Developers can use this  
option to install non-Market applications.  
1. Press  
Settings) Applications  
applications  
and then tap  
(
Manage  
1. Press  
and then tap  
.
(Settings) Applications  
.
2. Tap an application in which to clear the  
2. Tap Unknown sources to active this feature.  
cache or data.  
200  
     
3. Tap Force stop, Clear data, or Clear cache  
.
Important! Only certain downloaded applications  
are capable of being moved from  
phone to card.  
Uninstalling Third-party Applications  
Important! You must have downloaded  
applications installed to use this  
feature.  
1. Press  
Settings) Applications  
applications  
and then tap  
(
Manage  
.
1. Press  
Settings) Applications  
applications  
and then tap  
2. Tap the Downloaded tab and select your  
desired application.  
(
Manage  
.
3. Tap Move to SD card (from within the  
Storage section of the Application info  
page).  
2. Tap the Downloaded tab and select your  
desired application.  
3. Tap Uninstall (from within the top area of  
the Application info page).  
Once the application has been moved to the  
microSD card, this button now reads “Move to  
phone”.  
4. At the prompt, tap OK to uninstall the  
application.  
Running Services  
5. Select a reason for uninstalling the  
The Running services option allows you to view  
and control currently running services such as  
Backup, Google Talk, SNS (messaging), Swype,  
and more.  
application, then tap OK  
.
Moving Third-party Applications to your SD  
Card  
Your phone’s built in memory is augmented by  
using a microSD card to store additional data.  
When the phone’s built-in memory capacity is  
reached, it can be possible to move some  
applications over to the internal microSD card.  
Freeing up memory space on the phone can help  
avoid any sluggish performance when the phone  
has to work harder to manage memory  
resources.  
1. Press  
Settings) Applications  
services  
and then tap  
(
Running  
.
The screen displays all the processes that  
are running.  
2. Tap a process to stop the process from  
running.  
Changing Your Settings  
201  
       
When you stop the process the service or  
application will no longer run until you start  
the process or application again.  
Android Development  
Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Applications  
Development.  
Important! Stopping a process might have  
undesirable consequences on the  
application.  
Important! These features are used for  
development purposes only.  
USB Debugging  
This feature is used for development purposes  
only.  
Memory Usage  
This option allows you to view a list of the  
memory usage for currently active applications.  
Allowing Mock Locations  
This feature is used for development purposes  
only.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Memory  
(Settings) Applications  
usage. The All tab is opened and displays a  
list of the current applications.  
If you are a developer who is testing a GPS  
applications using this device, you can tell the  
device that the phone is at different GPS  
locations. In other words, the phone is allowed to  
“mock” the coordinates.  
2. Press  
the list from being sorted either  
alphabetically or by largest memory usage.  
Battery Usage  
and then tap Sort to change  
This option allows you to view a list of those  
components using battery power.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
Battery usage  
and then tap Refresh to update  
(Settings) Applications  
.
2. Press  
the list.  
– or –  
Tap an entry to view more detailed  
information.  
202  
           
Synchronizing a Google Account  
By default, there are no accounts managed by  
the device. These must be manually added.  
Accounts and Synchronization  
Your phone provides the ability to synchronize  
data from a variety of different sources or sites.  
These accounts can range from Google, a  
Corporate Microsoft Exchange Email Server, and  
other social sites such as Facebook, Twitter, and  
MySpace. Corporate and Google accounts  
provide the ability to synchronize Calendar  
events and Contacts.  
To manage an existing Google account  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) Accounts and sync  
2. Tap Add account Google  
3. Tap Next Sign in  
:
(
.
.
.
To enable the auto-sync feature:  
Note: If you do not already have a Google account,  
tap Create and follow the on-screen  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Accounts and sync  
.
prompts to create your new account.  
2. Tap Auto-sync. A green checkmark  
indicates the feature is enabled. This  
feature enables the synchronization of data  
between your phone and external sites or  
servers.  
4. Touch the Username (@gmail.com) and  
Password fields and enter your  
information.  
5. Tap Sign in. Your phone then  
communicates with the Google servers to  
confirm your information. Your existing  
Gmail account then appears within the  
Manage accounts area of the screen.  
The three main components are Contacts Email,  
and Calendar Events. Before these can be  
synchronized, they must be added to the  
managed accounts list.  
Any changes or updates to your Gmail account  
are then automatically updated to your device.  
• Background data: allows your phone to use  
data in the background.  
Changing Your Settings  
203  
           
To configure the Google management settings:  
1. Press and then tap  
Settings) Accounts and sync  
– or –  
Press  
and then tap  
(
.
(Settings) Accounts and sync.  
2. Tap  
within the Google account field to  
2. Locate the email account containing the  
reveal the account’s synchronization  
settings screen.  
events you wish to synchronize.  
3. Tap  
within the adjacent account field  
3. Tap the parameters you wish to  
to reveal the account’s synchronization  
settings screen.  
synchronize (Sync Contacts Sync Gmail, or  
Sync Calendar). A green checkmark  
indicates the feature is enabled.  
,
4. Toggle the check mark adjacent to either  
the Sync Contacts or Sync Calendar fields to  
manually sync the account.  
4. Press  
screen.  
to return to the previous  
Motion Settings  
This feature allows you to assign specific  
functions to certain phone actions that are  
detected by both the accelerometer and  
gyroscope.  
SynchronizingYourCorporateAccount  
By default, there are no Corporate Calendar  
events managed by the device. These must be  
manually added.  
To activate motion:  
Press  
Settings) Motion  
To activate different motion functions:  
Activate the motion feature.  
and then tap  
(
Motion activation.  
Note: Once a corporate email account is created,  
it is automatically added as a managed  
account.  
Turn over to mute activates the mute function  
for incoming calls and playing sounds.  
Tutorials provide on-screen visual explanations  
of the above features.  
Use the following procedure to configure your  
phone to synchronize with a corporate email  
account.  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(
Applications)Settings  
sync  
204  
Accounts and  
.
           
3. Tap Export to SD card Ô OK. For more  
Privacy Settings  
Location settings, backup configurations, or  
reset the phone to erase all personal data.  
Verify your images and videos are on your microSD  
card:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Privacy  
.
Mobile Backup and Restore  
The phone can be configured to back up your  
current settings, application data and settings.  
1. Press  
(
Applications) ➔  
(Gallery).  
2. Verify the Gallery contains all of your  
pictures and videos.  
and then tap  
3. Remove the back cover and remove the  
internal microSD card prior to initiating a  
Kies air update.  
(Settings) Privacy  
.
2. Tap Back up my data to create a backup of  
your current phone settings and  
applications.  
Factory Data Reset  
From this menu you can reset your phone and  
sound settings to the factory default settings.  
3. Tap Automatic restore to assist in the re-  
installation of a previously installed  
application (including preferences and  
data).  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Privacy. (You will see a  
disclaimer.)  
Prior to doing a Factory Reset  
Before using Kies air to upgrade your device, it is  
recommended that you backup your personal  
data prior to use.  
2. Tap Factory data reset  
Reset phone.  
3. If necessary, enter your password and tap  
Erase everything  
.
The phone resets to the factory default  
settings automatically and when finished  
displays the Home screen.  
To export a Contact list to your microSD card:  
1. From the Home screen, tap  
(Contacts).  
2. Press  
and then tap Import/Export  
.
Note: Select Format USB storage to also erase all  
data on the USB storage.  
Changing Your Settings  
205  
                   
Use My Location: uses your My Location  
information for Google search results and  
services.  
SD Card & Phone Storage  
From this menu you can view the memory  
allocation for the memory card as well as mount  
or unmount the SD card.  
Search on google.com: allows you to use  
www.google.com instead of your local domain  
(www.google.com).  
For more information about mounting or  
unmounting the SD card, see “Using the SD  
Terms of Service: displays the applications’  
service terms.  
To view the memory allocation for your external SD  
card:  
Open Source Licenses: displays the  
applications’ open source license information.  
Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Storage.The available  
Language&KeyboardSettings  
This setting allows you to configure the language  
in which to display the menus. You can also set  
on-screen keyboard options.  
memory displays under the Total space  
and Available space headings.  
Search Settings  
Use Google Search to search the Web.  
Press  
and then tap  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
Settings) Language and keyboard  
.
(Search).  
2. Press  
Search settings  
.
3. Tap any of the following search parameters  
to then alter the settings:  
• Google search opens a screen where you can  
set your Google search preferences.  
Clear history: erases the history for recently  
selected search results.  
Show web suggestions: includes search  
matches from Google’s online search engine.  
206  
       
• Show tips: turns on an on-screen flashing  
indicator that provides helpful user information.  
Swype Advanced settings  
Advanced settings provide access to Swype  
operation parameters.  
Language Settings  
To set the language that the menus display on  
the phone:  
1. Press  
Settings) Language and keyboard  
Select language  
and then tap  
(
• Word suggestion: uses a built-in word database  
to predict words while entering text in Swype.  
.
2. Select a language and region from the list.  
• Auto-spacing: automatically inserts a space  
between words. When you finish a word, just lift  
your finger or stylus and start the next word.  
• Auto-capitalization: automatically capitalizes  
the first letter of a sentence.  
Select Input Method  
There are two input methods available: Swype  
and Samsung keypad.  
1. Press  
Settings) Language and keyboard  
Select input method  
and then tap  
(
• Show complete trace: determines whether or  
not to display the complete Swype trace path on-  
screen.  
.
2. Select an input method.  
Swype Settings  
• Speed vs. accuracy: sets how quickly Swype  
responds to on-screen input. Move the slider  
between Fast Response (speed) or Error Tolerant  
1. Press  
Settings) Language and keyboard  
Swype  
and then tap  
(accuracy) and tap OK  
.
(
• Personal dictionary: manages your personal  
dictionary.  
.
2. Tap one of the following Swype  
• Reset Swype’s dictionary: deletes all words  
you’ve previously entered and added to Swype’s  
dictionary.  
preferences to activate the setting:  
• Language: allows you to select the current text  
input language. Default language is US English.  
• Audio feedback: turns off sounds generated by  
the Swype application.  
Changing Your Settings  
207  
     
Swype Help settings  
Help settings provide access to Swype help  
operation parameters.  
5. Tap the Keypad sweeping field if you want  
to sweep the keypad and change from ABC  
6. Tap the Auto-capitalization field to  
automatically capitalize the first letter of a  
sentence.  
• Swypehelp: displays the on-screen Swype User  
Manual.  
Tutorial: provides an on-screen tutorial that  
shows you how to input text faster in Swype  
input mode.  
7. Tap Voice input to activate the Voice input  
feature. This is an experimental feature  
that uses Google’s networked speech  
recognition application.  
About  
Provides information about the current Swype  
application version.  
Samsung Keyboard Settings  
8. Tap Auto-full stop to automatically insert a  
full stop by tapping the space bar twice.  
9. Tap the Tutorial field to view a short tutorial  
on use of the Samsung keyboard.  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Language and keyboard  
Samsung keypad  
.
2. Tap Portrait keypad types and select a text  
XT9 Advanced Settings  
input method:  
The following XT9 Advanced settings are  
available when the XT9 field is selected.  
1. Tap the XT9 field to select XT9 (predictive  
text) mode, then tap XT9 advanced  
Qwerty Keypad  
3x4 Keypad  
3. Tap Input languages and select a language.  
4. Tap XT9 to use XT9 Predictive text method.  
settings  
.
2. Tap the Word completion field to enable  
word completion. Your phone predicts how  
to complete the word typed.  
208  
         
3. Tap the Word completion point field then  
touch 2 letters 3 letters 4 letters, or the  
letters radio button. Word completion  
10. To add a new word to the T9 dictionary:  
Tap XT9 my words Add word or press  
and then tap Add  
Enter the new word in the Register to XT9  
my words field, then tap Done  
,
,
5
.
begins after 2 or more (depending on your  
selection).  
.
4. Tap the Spell correction field. This option  
corrects typographical errors by selecting  
from a list of possible words that reflect  
the characters of the keys you touched as  
well as the characters of nearby keys.  
5. Tap the Next word prediction field to enable  
word prediction.  
11. Tap XT9 auto-substitution to add words to  
substitute (for example youve becomes  
you’ve). A list of substitutions displays.  
12. If you do not see the substitution you want,  
press  
and then tap Add, then input  
the Shortcut word and Substitution word.  
13. Tap Done  
.
6. Tap the Auto-append field to automatically  
add predictions.  
Voice Input and Out Settings  
Configuring Voice Input Recognition  
This feature allows the phone to correctly  
recognize verbal input.  
7. Tap the Auto-substitution field to  
automatically replace words that you are  
typing. This option assists with correcting  
misspelled words.  
1. Press  
Settings) Voice input and output  
Voice recognition settings  
and then tap  
(
8. Tap the Regional correction field. This  
option sets the device to automatically  
correct mistyped words according to  
normal spelling for your region.  
.
2. Configure the available options to alter the  
settings associated with this feature:  
• Language: selects an input language and  
associated dialect recognition (if available).  
• SafeSearch: sets the explicit image filter  
settings. These settings apply to only Google  
9. Tap the Recapture field. This option sets  
the device to re-display the word  
suggestion list when you select the wrong  
word from the list.  
voice search results. Choose from: Off  
,
Moderate, or Strict  
.
Changing Your Settings  
209  
   
• Block offensive words: allows you to block  
recognition of known offensive words or  
language. (A green check mark indicates the  
feature is active).  
• Default engine: sets the speech synthesis  
engine that will be used for the spoken text.  
Choices include: Pico TTS  
.
• Install voice data: confirms the installation of  
necessary data required for voice synthesis.  
• Speech rate: adjusts the rate at which on-  
screen text is spoken by the device. Choose  
3. Press  
screen.  
to return to the previous  
Configuring Text-to-speech (Voice  
Output)  
This feature allows the phone to provide a verbal  
readout of on-screen data such as messages  
and incoming caller information.  
from: Very slow  
,
Slow, Normal, Fast, and Very  
fast.  
• Language: assigns the language used for verbal  
readout. Choose from German (Germany),  
English (United Kiingdom), English (United  
States), Spanish (Spain), French (France), or  
Italian (Italy).  
1. Press  
Settings) Voice input and output  
Text-to-speech settings  
and then tap  
(
.
2. Configure the available options to alter the  
settings associated with this feature:  
• Listen to an example: plays a short example of  
what the text-to-speech feature sounds like on  
your device when activated.  
• Samsung TTS: configures the Samsung TTS  
settings for various languages.  
• Pico TTS: configures the pico TTS settings for  
various languages.  
Accessibility Settings  
• Driving mode: incoming calls and new  
notifications are automatically ready out loud.  
• Driving mode settings: allows you to select  
applications to use TTs while Driving mode is on.  
• Always use my settings: accepts an override of  
application settings with personal configurations  
for this text-to-speech settings screen. If  
enabled, your device defaults to using the text-  
to-speech feature.  
This service lets you enable and disable  
downloaded accessibility applications that aid in  
navigating your Android device, such as  
TalkBack (uses synthesized speech to describe  
the results of actions), KickBack (provides haptic  
feedback for actions), and SoundBack (plays  
sounds for various actions). Also lets you enable  
use of the power key to end calls.  
210  
         
1. Press  
and then tap  
5. Tap Set time and use the plus or minus  
(
Settings) Accessibility  
.
icons, set Hour, and Minute. Tap PM or AM,  
then select Set  
.
Note: Initially, it might be necessary to download  
accessibility applications from the Android  
Market.  
Optional: Tap Use 24-hour format. If this is not  
selected the phone automatically uses a 12-hour  
format.  
6. Tap Select date format and touch the date  
2. Tap Accessibility to activate the feature,  
then select the services for which you  
want data to log.  
format type.  
About Phone  
This menu contains legal information, system  
tutorial information, and other phone information  
such as the model number, firmware version,  
baseband version, kernel version, and software  
build number.  
3. Select The power key ends calls field to  
activate this feature which ends any  
current calls.  
Date and Time  
This menu allows you to change the current time  
and date displayed.  
To access phone information:  
Press  
Settings) About phone. The following  
information displays:  
and then tap  
1. Press  
and then tap  
(
(
Settings) Date and time  
.
2. Tap Automatic to allow the network set the  
• Status: displays the battery status, the level of  
the battery (percentage), the phone number for  
this device, the network connection, signal  
strength, mobile network type, service state,  
roaming status, mobile network state, IMEI  
number, IMEI SV, Wi-Fi MAC address, Bluetooth  
address, and Up time.  
date and time.  
Important! Deactivate Automatic to manually set  
the rest of the options.  
3. Tap Set date and use the plus or minus  
icons to set the Month  
,
Day, and Year then  
touch Set  
.
• Battery usage: displays the applications or  
services (in percentages) that are using battery  
power.  
4. Tap Select time zone, then touch a time  
zone.  
Changing Your Settings  
211  
   
• Legal information: This option displays  
information about Open source licenses as well  
as Google legal information. This information  
clearly provides copyright and distribution legal  
information and facts as well as Google Terms of  
Service, Terms of Service for Android-powered  
Phones, and much more pertinent information  
as a reference.  
Software Update  
The Software Update feature enables you to use  
your phone to connect to the network and upload  
any new phone software directly to your phone.  
The phone automatically updates with the latest  
available software when you access this option.  
Press  
and then tap  
(Settings) Software update  
.
Read the information and terms, then press  
to return to the Settings menu.  
The phone automatically updates the  
software (if available).  
• Model number: displays the phone’s model  
number.  
• Android version: displays the firmware version  
loaded on this handset.  
• Baseband version: displays the baseband  
version loaded on this handset.  
• Kernel version: displays the kernel version  
loaded on this handset.  
• Build number: displays the software, build  
number.  
Note: Firmware, baseband, kernel and build  
numbers are usually used for updates to the  
handset or support. For additional  
information please contact your T-Mobile  
service representative.  
212  
 
Section 13: Health and Safety Information  
published have failed to show an association  
between exposure to radio frequency from a cell  
phone and health problems.  
This section outlines the safety precautions  
associated with using your phone. The terms  
“mobile device” or “cell phone” are used in this  
section to refer to your phone. Read this  
The low levels of RF cell phones emit while in  
use are in the microwave frequency range. They  
also emit RF at substantially reduced time  
intervals when in the stand-by mode. Whereas  
high levels of RF can produce health effects (by  
heating tissue), exposure to low level RF that  
does not produce heating effects causes no  
known adverse health effects.  
information before using your mobile device  
.
Exposure to Radio Frequency  
(RF) Signals  
The U.S. Food and Drug Administration (FDA) has  
published information for consumers relating to  
Radio Frequency (RF) exposure from wireless  
phones. The FDA publication includes the  
following information:  
The biological effects of radio frequency energy  
should not be confused with the effects from  
other types of electromagnetic energy.  
Do cell phones pose a health hazard?  
Many people are concerned that cell phone  
radiation will cause cancer or other serious  
health hazards. The weight of scientific evidence  
has not linked cell phones with any health  
problems.  
Very high levels of electromagnetic energy, such  
as is found in X-rays and gamma rays, can ionize  
biological tissues. Ionization is a process where  
electrons are stripped away from their normal  
locations in atoms and molecules. It can  
permanently damage biological tissues including  
DNA, the genetic material.  
Cell phones emit low levels of Radio Frequency  
(RF) energy. Over the past 15 years, scientists  
have conducted hundreds of studies looking at  
the biological effects of the radio frequency  
energy emitted by cell phones. While some  
researchers have reported biological changes  
associated with RF energy, these studies have  
failed to be replicated. The majority of studies  
The energy levels associated with radio  
frequency energy, including both radio waves  
and microwaves, are not great enough to cause  
ionization of atoms and molecules. Therefore, RF  
energy is a type of non-ionizing radiation. Other  
types of non-ionizing radiation include visible  
Health and Safety Information  
213  
         
light, infrared radiation (heat), and other forms of  
electromagnetic radiation with relatively low  
frequencies.  
usage for more than 5,000 people with brain  
tumors (glioma and meningioma) and a similar  
number of healthy controls.  
While RF energy does not ionize particles, large  
amounts can increase body temperatures and  
cause tissue damage. Two areas of the body, the  
eyes and the testes, are particularly vulnerable to  
RF heating because there is relatively little blood  
flow in them to carry away excess heat.  
Research Results to Date: Is there a  
connection between RF and certain health  
problems?  
The results of most studies conducted to date  
say no. In addition, attempts to replicate and  
confirm the few studies that have shown a  
connection have failed.  
Results of this study did NOT show that cell  
phones caused brain cancer. In this study, most  
people had no increased risk of brain cancer  
from using cell phones. For people with the  
heaviest use of cell phones (an average of more  
than ½ hour per day, every day, for over 10  
years) the study suggested a slight increase in  
brain cancer. However, the authors determined  
that biases and errors prevented any conclusions  
being drawn from this data. Additional  
information about Interphone can be found at  
http://www.iarc.fr/en/media-centre/pr/2010/pdfs/  
pr200_E.pdf.  
Interphone is the largest cell phone study to  
date, but it did not answer all questions about  
cell phone safety. Additional research is being  
conducted around the world, and the FDA  
continues to monitor developments in this field.  
InternationalCohortStudyonMobilePhone  
Users (COSMOS)  
The COSMOS study aims to conduct long-term  
health monitoring of a large group of people to  
determine if there are any health issues linked to  
long-term exposure to radio frequency energy  
from cell phone use. The COSMOS study will  
follow approximately 300,000 adult cell phone  
users in Europe for 20 to 30 years. Additional  
The scientific community at large therefore  
believes that the weight of scientific evidence  
does not show an association between exposure  
to Radio Frequency (RF) from cell phones and  
adverse health outcomes. Still the scientific  
community has supported additional research to  
address gaps in knowledge. Some of these  
studies are described below.  
Interphone Study  
Interphone is a large international study  
designed to determine whether cell phones  
increase the risk of head and neck cancer. A  
report published in the International Journal of  
Epidemiology (June, 2010) compared cell phone  
214  
information about the COSMOS study can be  
found at  
Cell Phone Industry Actions  
Although the existing scientific data do not justify  
FDA regulatory actions, the FDA has urged the  
cell phone industry to take a number of steps,  
including the following:  
.
RiskofBrainCancerfromExposuretoRadio  
Frequency Fields in Childhood and  
Adolescence (MOBI-KIDS)  
Support-needed research on possible biological  
effects of RF for the type of signal emitted by cell  
phones;  
MOBI-KIDS is an international study investigating  
the relationship between exposure to radio  
frequency energy from communication  
technologies including cell phones and brain  
cancer in young people. This is an international  
multi-center study involving 14 European and  
non-European countries. Additional information  
about MOBI-KIDS can be found at  
Design cell phones in a way that minimizes any  
RF exposure to the user; and  
Cooperate in providing users of cell phones with  
the current information on cell phone use and  
human health concerns.  
http://www.creal.cat/programes-recerca/  
en_projectes-creal/view.php?ID=39.  
The FDA also is working with voluntary standard-  
setting bodies such as the Institute of Electrical  
and Electronics Engineers (IEEE), the  
International Commission on Non-Ionizing  
Radiation Protection (ICNIRP), and others to  
assure that safety standards continue to  
adequately protect the public.  
Surveillance, Epidemiology, and End  
Results (SEER) Program of the National  
Cancer Institute  
The National Cancer Institute (NCI) actively  
follows cancer statistics in the United States to  
detect any change in rates of new cases for  
brain cancer. If cell phones play a role in risk for  
brain cancer, rates should go up, because heavy  
cell phone use has been common for quite some  
time in the U.S. Between 1987 and 2005, the  
overall age-adjusted incidence of brain cancer  
did not increase. Additional information about  
SEER can be found at  
Reducing Exposure: Hands-Free Kits  
and Other Accessories  
Steps to Reduce Exposure to Radio  
Frequency Energy  
If there is a risk from being exposed to radio  
frequency energy (RF) from cell phones - and at  
this point we do not know that there is - it is  
probably very small. But, if you are concerned  
.
Health and Safety Information  
215  
 
about avoiding even potential risks, you can take  
a few simple steps to minimize your RF  
exposure.  
CellPhoneAccessoriesthatClaimtoShield  
the Head from RF Radiation  
Because there are no known risks from exposure  
to RF emissions from cell phones, there is no  
reason to believe that accessories which claim to  
shield the head from those emissions reduce  
risks. Some products that claim to shield the  
user from RF absorption use special phone  
cases, while others involve nothing more than a  
metallic accessory attached to the phone.  
Reduce the amount of time spent using your cell  
phone;  
Use speaker mode or a headset to place more  
distance between your head and the cell phone.  
Hands-Free Kits  
Hands-free kits may include audio or Bluetooth®  
headsets and various types of body-worn  
accessories such as belt-clips and holsters.  
Combinations of these can be used to reduce RF  
energy absorption from cell phones.  
Studies have shown that these products  
generally do not work as advertised. Unlike  
“hands-free” kits, these so-called “shields” may  
interfere with proper operation of the phone. The  
phone may be forced to boost its power to  
compensate, leading to an increase in RF  
absorption.  
Headsets can substantially reduce exposure  
because the phone is held away from the head in  
the user's hand or in approved body-worn  
accessories. Cell phones marketed in the U.S.  
are required to meet RF exposure compliance  
requirements when used against the head and  
against the body.  
Children and Cell Phones  
The scientific evidence does not show a danger  
to any users of cell phones from RF exposure,  
including children and teenagers. The steps  
adults can take to reduce RF exposure apply to  
children and teenagers as well.  
Because there are no known risks from exposure  
to RF emissions from cell phones, there is no  
reason to believe that hands-free kits reduce  
risks. Hands-free kits can be used for  
convenience and comfort. They are also required  
by law in many states if you want to use your  
phone while driving.  
Reduce the amount of time spent on the cell phone;  
Use speaker mode or a headset to place more  
distance between the head and the cell phone.  
Some groups sponsored by other national  
governments have advised that children be  
discouraged from using cell phones at all. For  
example, The Stewart Report from the United  
216  
 
Kingdom made such a recommendation in  
December 2000. In this report, a group of  
independent experts noted that no evidence  
exists that using a cell phone causes brain  
tumors or other ill effects. Their recommendation  
to limit cell phone use by children was strictly  
precautionary; it was not based on scientific  
evidence that any health hazard exists.  
Health Protection Agency:  
US Food and Drug Administration:  
http://www.fda.gov/Radiation-EmittingProducts/  
HomeBusinessandEntertainment/CellPhones/  
SpecificAbsorptionRate(SAR)  
Certification Information  
Your wireless phone is a radio transmitter and  
receiver. It is designed and manufactured not to  
exceed the exposure limits for Radio Frequency  
(RF) energy set by the Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) of the U.S. Government.  
Additional information on the safety of RF  
exposures from various sources can be obtained  
from the following organizations (updated 10/1/  
2010):  
FCC RF Safety Program:  
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA):  
Occupational Safety and Health Administration  
(OSHA):  
These FCC RF exposure limits are derived from  
the recommendations of two expert  
organizations: the National Council on Radiation  
Protection and Measurement (NCRP) and the  
Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers  
(IEEE). In both cases, the recommendations were  
developed by scientific and engineering experts  
drawn from industry, government, and academia  
after extensive reviews of the scientific literature  
related to the biological effects of RF energy.  
.
(Note: This web address is case sensitive.)  
National Institute for Occupational Safety and Health  
(NIOSH):  
World Health Organization (WHO):  
International Commission on Non-Ionizing Radiation  
Protection:  
The RF exposure limit set by the FCC for wireless  
mobile phones employs a unit of measurement  
known as the Specific Absorption Rate (SAR).  
The SAR is a measure of the rate of absorption of  
RF energy by the human body expressed in units  
Health and Safety Information  
217  
   
of watts per kilogram (W/kg). The FCC requires  
wireless phones to comply with a safety limit of  
1.6 watts per kilogram (1.6 W/kg).  
accessory that contains no metal and that  
positions the mobile device a minimum of 1.0  
cm from the body.  
The FCC SAR limit incorporates a substantial  
margin of safety to give additional protection to  
the public and to account for any variations in  
measurements.  
Use of other accessories may not ensure  
compliance with FCC RF exposure guidelines.  
The FCC has granted an Equipment Authorization  
for this mobile phone with all reported SAR levels  
evaluated as in compliance with the FCC RF  
exposure guidelines. The maximum SAR values  
for this model phone as reported to the FCC are:  
SAR tests are conducted using standard  
operating positions accepted by the FCC with the  
phone transmitting at its highest certified power  
level in all tested frequency bands. Although the  
SAR is determined at the highest certified power  
level, the actual SAR level of the phone while  
operating can be well below the maximum  
reported value. This is because the phone is  
designed to operate at multiple power levels so  
as to use only the power required to reach the  
network. In general, the closer you are to a  
wireless base station antenna, the lower the  
power output of the phone.  
Cellular/PCS WCDMA/GSM/EDGE and AWS WCDMA  
Head: 0.76 W/Kg.  
Body-worn Accessory: 0.86 W/Kg.  
Product Specific (Wireless Router): 1.00 W/kg;  
Simultaneous Transmission: 1.04 W/kg.  
WLAN  
Head: 0.16 W/Kg.  
Body-worn Accessory: 0.18 W/Kg.  
Product Specific (Wireless Router): 0.18 W/kg;  
Simultaneous Transmission: 1.04 W/kg  
Before a new model phone is available for sale to  
the public, it must be tested and certified to the  
FCC that it does not exceed the SAR limit  
established by the FCC. Tests for each model  
phone are performed in positions and locations  
(e.g. at the ear and worn on the body) as  
required by the FCC. For body-worn operation,  
this phone has been tested and meets FCC RF  
exposure guidelines when used with an  
SAR information on this and other model phones  
can be accessed online on the FCC's website  
To find information that pertains to a particular  
model phone, this site uses the phone FCC ID  
number which is usually printed somewhere on  
the case of the phone. Sometimes it may be  
.
necessary to remove the battery pack to find the  
number. Once you have the FCC ID number for a  
218  
particular phone, follow the instructions on the  
website and it should provide values for typical  
or maximum SAR for a particular phone.  
Additional SAR information can also be obtained  
at  
However, there is no guarantee that interference  
will not occur in a particular installation. If this  
equipment does cause harmful interference to  
radio or television reception, which can be  
determined by turning the equipment off and on,  
the user is encouraged to try to correct the  
interference by one or more of the following  
measures:  
.
FCC Part 15 Information to  
User  
Pursuant to part 15.21 of the FCC Rules, you are  
cautioned that changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by Samsung could void your  
authority to operate the device.  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and  
receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit  
different from that to which the receiver is  
connected.  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC  
Rules. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions: (1) This device may not cause  
harmful interference, and (2) this device must  
accept any interference received, including  
interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV  
technician for help.  
Smart Practices While Driving  
On the Road - Off the Phone  
The primary responsibility of every driver is the  
safe operation of his or her vehicle.  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found  
to comply with the limits for a Class B digital  
device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
These limits are designed to provide reasonable  
protection against harmful interference in a  
residential installation. This equipment  
Responsible drivers understand that no  
secondary task should be performed while  
driving whether it be eating, drinking, talking to  
passengers, or talking on a mobile phone -  
unless the driver has assessed the driving  
conditions and is confident that the secondary  
task will not interfere with their primary  
generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency  
energy and, if not installed and used in  
responsibility. Do not engage in any activity while  
driving a moving vehicle which may cause you to  
accordance with the instructions, may cause  
harmful interference to radio communications.  
Health and Safety Information  
219  
     
take your eyes off the road or become so absorbed  
in the activity that your ability to concentrate on  
the act of driving becomes impaired. Samsung is  
committed to promoting responsible driving and  
giving drivers the tools they need to understand  
and address distractions.  
Notice regarding legal restrictions on mounting  
this device in an automobile:  
Laws in some states may prohibit mounting this  
device on or near the windshield of an  
automobile. In other states, the law may permit  
mounting this device only in specific locations in  
the automobile. Be sure to consult the state and  
local laws or ordinances where you drive before  
mounting this device in an automobile. Failure to  
comply with these restrictions could result in  
fines, penalties, or other damages.  
Check the laws and regulations on the use of  
mobile devices and their accessories in the areas  
where you drive. Always obey them. The use of  
these devices may be prohibited or restricted in  
certain areas. For example, only hands-free use  
may be permitted in certain areas.  
Never mount this device in a manner that will  
obstruct the driver's clear view of the street and  
traffic.  
Before answering calls, consider your  
circumstances. Let the call go to voicemail when  
driving conditions require. Remember, driving  
comes first, not the call!  
Never use wireless data services such as text  
messaging, Web browsing, or e-mail while  
operating a vehicle.  
If you consider a call necessary and appropriate,  
follow these tips:  
Never watch videos, such as a movie or clip, or  
play video games while operating a vehicle.  
Use a hands-free device;  
Secure your phone within easy reach;  
Place calls when you are not moving;  
Plan calls when your car will be stationary;  
Do not engage in stressful or emotional  
conversations;  
For more information, go to http://www.ctia.org  
.
Battery Use and Safety  
Important! Handle and store batteries properly to  
avoid injury or damage. Most battery  
issues arise from improper handling of  
batteries and, particularly, from the  
Let the person with whom you are speaking know  
that you are driving and will suspend the call if  
necessary;  
continued use of damaged batteries.  
Do not take notes or look up phone numbers while  
driving;  
220  
   
Do not disassemble, crush, puncture, shred, or  
otherwise attempt to change the form of your  
battery. Do not put a high degree of pressure on the  
battery. This can cause leakage or an internal  
short-circuit, resulting in overheating.  
Do not handle a damaged or leaking battery. Do  
not let leaking battery fluid come in contact with  
your eyes, skin or clothing. For safe disposal  
options, contact your nearest Samsung-authorized  
service center.  
Do not let the phone or battery come in contact  
with liquids. Liquids can get into the phone's  
circuits, leading to corrosion. Even when the phone  
appears to be dry and appears to operate normally,  
the circuitry could slowly corrode and pose a safety  
hazard. If the phone and/or battery get wet, have  
them checked by your service provider or contact  
Samsung, even if they appear to be working  
properly.  
Avoid dropping the cell phone. Dropping the  
phone or the battery, especially on a hard surface,  
can potentially cause damage to the phone and  
battery. If you suspect damage to the phone or  
battery, take it to a service center for inspection.  
Never use any charger or battery that is  
damaged in any way  
.
Do not allow the battery to touch metal objects  
.
Accidental short-circuiting can occur when a  
metallic object (coin, key, jewelry, clip, or pen)  
causes a direct connection between the + and -  
terminals of the battery (metal strips on the battery),  
for example when you carry a spare battery in a  
pocket or bag. Short-circuiting the terminals may  
damage the battery or the object causing the short-  
circuiting.  
Do not place your battery in or near a heat  
source. Excessive heating can damage the phone  
or the battery and could cause the phone or the  
battery to explode. Do not dry a wet or damp battery  
with an appliance or heat source such as a  
microwave oven, hair dryer, iron, or radiator. Avoid  
leaving your phone in your car in high temperatures.  
Do not dispose of the phone or the battery in a  
fire. The phone or the battery may explode when  
overheated.  
Important! Use only Samsung-approved batteries,  
and recharge your battery only with  
Samsung-approved chargers which  
are specifically designed for your  
phone.  
Health and Safety Information  
221  
WARNING!  
Proper disposal of your mobile device and its  
battery is not only important for safety, it benefits  
the environment. Batteries must be recycled or  
disposed of properly.  
Use of a non-Samsung-approved battery or  
charger may present a risk of fire, explosion,  
leakage, or other hazard. Samsung's warranty  
does not cover damage to the phone caused by  
non-Samsung-approved batteries and/or  
chargers.  
Recycling programs for your mobile device,  
batteries, and accessories may not be available  
in your area.  
Do not use incompatible cell phone batteries  
and chargers. Some websites and second-hand  
dealers not associated with reputable  
We've made it easy for you to recycle your old  
Samsung mobile device by working with  
respected take-back companies in every state in  
the country.  
manufacturers and carriers, might be selling  
incompatible or even counterfeit batteries and  
chargers. Consumers should purchase  
Drop It Off  
You can drop off your Samsung-branded  
mobile device and batteries for recycling at  
one of our numerous Samsung Recycling  
Direct (SM) locations. A list of these locations  
may be found at:  
manufacturer or carrier-recommended products and  
accessories. If unsure about whether a replacement  
battery or charger is compatible, contact the  
manufacturer of the battery or charger.  
Misuse or use of incompatible phones, batteries,  
and charging devices could result in damage to  
the equipment and a possible risk of fire,  
explosion, or leakage, leading to serious  
injuries, damages to your phone, or other  
.
Samsung-branded devices and batteries will  
be accepted at these locations for no fee.  
Consumers may also recycle their used  
mobile device or batteries at many retail or  
carrier-provided locations where mobile  
devices and batteries are sold. Additional  
information regarding specific locations may  
be found at:  
serious hazard  
.
Samsung Mobile Products and  
Recycling  
Samsung cares for the environment and  
encourages its customers to recycle Samsung  
mobile devices and genuine Samsung  
accessories.  
222  
   
UL Certified Travel Charger  
.
The Travel Charger for this phone has met  
applicable UL safety requirements. Please  
adhere to the following safety instructions per UL  
guidelines:  
Mail It In  
The Samsung Mobile Take-Back Program will  
provide Samsung customers with a free  
recycling mailing label. Just go to  
citizenship/  
FAILURE TO FOLLOW THE INSTRUCTIONS  
OUTLINED MAY LEAD TO SERIOUS PERSONAL  
INJURY AND POSSIBLE PROPERTY DAMAGE.  
usactivities_environment_samsungrecyclingdirect  
follow the instructions to print out a free  
pre-paid postage label and then send your  
old mobile device or battery to the address  
listed, via U.S. Mail, for recycling.  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS - SAVE  
THESE INSTRUCTIONS.  
DANGER - TO REDUCE THE RISK OF  
FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, CAREFULLY  
FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS.  
Dispose of unwanted electronics through an  
approved recycler.  
FOR CONNECTION TO A SUPPLY NOT  
IN NORTH AMERICA, USE AN  
ATTACHMENT PLUG ADAPTOR OF THE  
PROPER CONFIGURATION FOR THE  
POWER OUTLET.  
To find the nearest recycling location, go to  
our website:  
Or call, (877) 278-0799.  
THIS POWER UNIT IS INTENDED TO  
BE CORRECTLY ORIENTED IN A  
VERTICAL OR HORIZONTAL OR FLOOR  
MOUNT POSITION.  
Followlocalregulationsregardingdisposal  
of mobile devices and batteries  
Dispose of your mobile device and batteries in  
accordance with local regulations. In some  
areas, the disposal of these items in household  
or business trash may be prohibited. Help us  
protect the environment - recycle!  
Display / Touch-Screen  
Please note the following information when  
using your mobile device:  
Warning! Never dispose of batteries in a fire  
because they may explode.  
Health and Safety Information  
223  
       
WARNING REGARDING DISPLAY  
Plan (FRP). Changes may affect the performance  
of location-based technology on your mobile  
device.  
The display on your mobile device is made  
of glass or acrylic and could break if your  
mobile device is dropped or if it receives  
significant impact. Do not use if screen is  
broken or cracked as this could cause  
injury to you.  
Certain Samsung mobile devices can also use an  
Assisted Global Positioning System (AGPS),  
which obtains information from the cellular  
network to improve GPS performance. AGPS  
uses your wireless service provider's network  
and therefore airtime, data charges, and/or  
additional charges may apply in accordance with  
your service plan. Contact your wireless service  
provider for details.  
WARRANTY DISCLAIMER: PROPER USE OF A  
TOUCH-SCREEN MOBILE DEVICE  
If your mobile device has a touch-screen  
display, please note that a touch-screen  
responds best to a light touch from the pad  
of your finger or a non-metallic stylus.  
Using excessive force or a metallic object  
when pressing on the touch-screen may  
damage the tempered glass surface and  
void the warranty. For more information,  
please refer to the “Standard Limited  
Warranty”.  
Your Location  
Location-based information includes information  
that can be used to determine the approximate  
location of a mobile device. Mobile devices  
which are connected to a wireless network  
transmit location-based information. Additionally,  
if you use applications that require location-  
based information (e.g. driving directions), such  
applications transmit location-based information.  
The location-based information may be shared  
with third-parties, including your wireless  
service provider, applications providers,  
Samsung, and other third-parties providing  
services.  
GPS & AGPS  
Certain Samsung mobile devices can use a  
Global Positioning System (GPS) signal for  
location-based applications. A GPS uses  
satellites controlled by the U.S. Government that  
are subject to changes implemented in  
accordance with the Department of Defense  
policy and the 2008 Federal Radio navigation  
224  
   
Use of AGPS in Emergency Calls  
user-programmed functions, which cannot  
guarantee connection in all conditions, areas, or  
circumstances.  
When you make an emergency call, the cellular  
network may activate AGPS technology in your  
mobile device to tell the emergency responders  
your approximate location.  
Therefore, you should never rely solely on any  
wireless mobile device for essential  
communications (medical emergencies, for  
example). Before traveling in remote or  
AGPS has limitations and might not work in your  
area. Therefore:  
underdeveloped areas, plan an alternate method  
of contacting emergency services personnel.  
Remember, to make or receive any calls, the  
mobile device must be switched on and in a  
service area with adequate signal strength.  
Always tell the emergency responder your location  
to the best of your ability; and  
Remain on the mobile device for as long as the  
emergency responder instructs you.  
Navigation  
Emergency calls may not be possible on all  
wireless mobile device networks or when certain  
network services and/or mobile device features  
are in use. Check with local service providers.  
Maps, directions, and other navigation-data,  
including data relating to your current location,  
may contain inaccurate or incomplete data, and  
circumstances can and do change over time. In  
some areas, complete information may not be  
available. Therefore, you should always visually  
confirm that the navigational instructions are  
consistent with what you see before following  
them. All users should pay attention to road  
conditions, closures, traffic, and all other factors  
that may impact safe driving or walking. Always  
To make an emergency call:  
1. If the mobile device is not on, switch it on.  
2. From the Home screen, tap  
. Enter  
the emergency number for your present  
location (for example, 911 or other official  
emergency number), then tap  
.
Emergency numbers vary by location.  
obey posted road signs  
.
If certain features are in use (call blocking, for  
example), you may first need to deactivate those  
features before you can make an emergency  
call. Consult your User Manual and your local  
cellular service provider. When making an  
emergency call, remember to give all the  
Emergency Calls  
This mobile device, like any wireless mobile  
device, operates using radio signals, wireless  
and landline networks, as well as  
necessary information as accurately as possible.  
Health and Safety Information  
225  
   
Remember that your mobile device may be the  
only means of communication at the scene of an  
accident; do not cut off the call until given  
permission to do so.  
Dust and dirt  
Do not expose your mobile device to dust,  
dirt, or sand.  
Cleaning solutions  
Care and Maintenance  
Do not use harsh chemicals, cleaning  
solvents, or strong detergents to clean the  
mobile device. Wipe it with a soft cloth  
slightly dampened in a mild soap-and-water  
solution.  
Your mobile device is a product of superior  
design and craftsmanship and should be treated  
with care. The suggestions below will help you  
fulfill any warranty obligations and allow you to  
enjoy this product for many years:  
Shock or vibration  
Keep your Samsung Mobile Device away from:  
Liquids of any kind  
Do not drop, knock, or shake the mobile  
device. Rough handling can break internal  
circuit boards.  
Keep the mobile device dry. Precipitation,  
humidity, and liquids contain minerals that  
will corrode electronic circuits. If the mobile  
device does get wet, do not accelerate drying  
with the use of an oven, microwave, or dryer,  
because this may damage the mobile device  
and could cause a fire or explosion.  
Paint  
Do not paint the mobile device. Paint can clog  
the device’s moving parts or ventilation  
openings and prevent proper operation.  
Responsible Listening  
Do not use the mobile device with a wet  
hand. Doing so may cause an electric shock  
to you or damage to the mobile device.  
Caution! Avoid potential hearing loss  
.
Damage to hearing occurs when a person is  
exposed to loud sounds over time. The risk of  
hearing loss increases as sound is played louder  
and for longer durations. Prolonged exposure to  
loud sounds (including music) is the most  
common cause of preventable hearing loss.  
Some scientific research suggests that using  
portable audio devices, such as portable music  
Extreme heat or cold  
Avoid temperatures below 0°C / 32°F or  
above 45°C / 113°F.  
Microwaves  
Do not try to dry your mobile device in a  
microwave oven. Doing so may cause a fire  
or explosion.  
226  
       
players and cell phones, at high volume settings  
for long durations may lead to permanent  
noise-induced hearing loss.  
When using headphones, turn the volume down if  
you cannot hear the people speaking near you or if  
the person sitting next to you can hear what you are  
listening to.  
This includes the use of headphones (including  
headsets, earbuds, and Bluetooth® or other  
wireless devices). Exposure to very loud sound  
has also been associated in some studies with  
tinnitus (a ringing in the ear), hypersensitivity to  
sound, and distorted hearing. Individual  
susceptibility to noise-induced hearing loss and  
potential hearing problem varies. Additionally,  
the amount of sound produced by a portable  
audio device varies depending on the nature of  
the sound, the device settings, and the  
Do not turn the volume up to block out noisy  
surroundings. If you choose to listen to your portable  
device in a noisy environment, use noise-cancelling  
headphones to block out background environmental  
noise. By blocking background environment noise,  
noise cancelling headphones should allow you to  
hear the music at lower volumes than when using  
earbuds.  
Limit the amount of time you listen. As the volume  
increases, less time is required before you hearing  
could be affected.  
headphones that are used. As a result, there is  
no single volume setting that is appropriate for  
everyone or for every combination of sound,  
settings, and equipment.  
Avoid using headphones after exposure to extremely  
loud noises, such as rock concerts, that might cause  
temporary hearing loss. Temporary hearing loss  
might cause unsafe volumes to sound normal.  
Do not listen at any volume that causes you  
discomfort. If you experience ringing in your ears,  
hear muffled speech, or experience any temporary  
hearing difficulty after listening to your portable  
audio device, discontinue use and consult your  
doctor.  
You should follow some common sense  
recommendations when using any portable  
audio device:  
Always turn the volume down before plugging the  
earphones into an audio source.  
Set the volume in a quiet environment and select  
the lowest volume at which you can hear  
adequately.  
Be aware that you can adapt to higher volume  
settings over time, not realizing that the higher  
volume may be harmful to your hearing.  
You can obtain additional information on this  
subject from the following sources:  
Health and Safety Information  
227  
Email: cdcinfo@cdc.gov  
American Academy of Audiology  
Internet:  
11730 Plaza American Drive, Suite 300  
Reston, VA 20190  
http://www.cdc.gov/niosh/topics/noise/  
default.html  
Voice: (800) 222-2336  
Email: info@audiology.org  
1-888-232-6348 TTY  
Internet:  
Operating Environment  
Remember to follow any special regulations in  
force in any area, and always switch your mobile  
device off whenever it is forbidden to use it, or  
when it may cause interference or danger. When  
connecting the mobile device or any accessory  
to another device, read its user's guide for  
detailed safety instructions. Do not connect  
incompatible products.  
National Institute on Deafness and Other  
Communication Disorders  
National Institutes of Health  
31 Center Drive, MSC 2320  
Bethesda, MD 20892-2320  
Email: nidcdinfo@nih.gov  
Using Your Mobile Device Near Other  
Electronic Devices  
Internet:  
Most modern electronic equipment is shielded  
from Radio Frequency (RF) signals. However,  
certain electronic equipment may not be  
shielded against the RF signals from your  
wireless mobile device. Consult the  
National Institute for Occupational Safety  
and Health (NIOSH)  
395 E Street, S.W., Suite 9200  
Patriots Plaza Building  
Washington, DC 20201  
manufacturer to discuss alternatives.  
Voice: 1-800-35-NIOSH  
(1-800-356-4674)  
1-800-CDC-INFO (1-800-232-4636)  
Outside the U.S. 513-533-8328  
Implantable Medical Devices  
A minimum separation of six (6) inches should  
be maintained between a handheld wireless  
mobile device and an implantable medical  
device, such as a pacemaker or implantable  
cardioverter defibrillator, to avoid potential  
interference with the device.  
228  
   
Persons who have such devices:  
Vehicles  
Should ALWAYS keep the mobile device more than  
six (6) inches from their implantable medical device  
when the mobile device is turned ON;  
RF signals may affect improperly installed or  
inadequately shielded electronic systems in  
motor vehicles. Check with the manufacturer or  
its representative regarding your vehicle before  
using your mobile device in a motor vehicle. You  
should also consult the manufacturer of any  
equipment that has been added to your vehicle.  
Posted Facilities  
Switch your mobile device off in any facility  
where posted notices require you to do so.  
Potentially Explosive Environments  
Switch your mobile device off when in any area  
with a potentially explosive atmosphere and obey  
all signs and instructions. Sparks in such areas  
could cause an explosion or fire resulting in  
bodily injury or even death. Users are advised to  
switch the mobile device off while at a refueling  
point (service station).  
Should not carry the mobile device in a breast  
pocket;  
Should use the ear opposite the implantable medical  
device to minimize the potential for interference;  
Should turn the mobile device OFF immediately if  
there is any reason to suspect that interference is  
taking place;  
Should read and follow the directions from the  
manufacturer of your implantable medical device. If  
you have any questions about using your wireless  
mobile device with an implantable medical device,  
consult your health care provider.  
For more information see: http://www.fcc.gov/oet/  
.
Users are reminded of the need to observe  
restrictions on the use of radio equipment in fuel  
depots (fuel storage and distribution areas),  
chemical plants, or where blasting operations  
are in progress. Areas with a potentially  
explosive atmosphere are often, but not always,  
clearly marked. They include below deck on  
boats, chemical transfer or storage facilities,  
vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas (such as  
propane or butane), areas where the air contains  
chemicals or particles, such as grain, dust, or  
Other Medical Devices  
If you use any other personal medical devices,  
consult the manufacturer of your device to  
determine if it is adequately shielded from  
external RF energy. Your physician may be able  
to assist you in obtaining this information. Switch  
your mobile device off in health care facilities  
when any regulations posted in these areas  
instruct you to do so. Hospitals or health care  
facilities may be using equipment that could be  
sensitive to external RF energy.  
Health and Safety Information  
229  
metal powders, and any other area where you  
would normally be advised to turn off your  
vehicle engine.  
devices. Not all mobile devices have been rated.  
Mobile devices that are rated have the rating on  
their box or a label located on the box.  
When your Device is Wet  
The ratings are not guarantees. Results will vary  
depending on the user's hearing device and  
hearing loss. If your hearing device happens to  
be vulnerable to interference, you may not be  
able to use a rated mobile device successfully.  
Trying out the mobile device with your hearing  
device is the best way to evaluate it for your  
personal needs.  
Do not turn on your device if it is wet. If your  
device is already on, turn it off and remove the  
battery immediately (if the device will not turn off  
or you cannot remove the battery, leave it as-is).  
Then, dry the device with a towel and take it to a  
service center.  
FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility  
(HAC)RegulationsforWireless  
Devices  
The U.S. Federal Communications Commission  
(FCC) has established requirements for digital  
wireless mobile devices to be compatible with  
hearing aids and other assistive hearing devices.  
M-Ratings: Wireless mobile devices rated M3 or  
M4 meet FCC requirements and are likely to  
generate less interference to hearing devices  
than mobile devices that are not labeled. M4 is  
the better/higher of the two ratings. M-ratings  
refer to enabling acoustic coupling with hearing  
aids that do not operate in telecoil mode.  
When individuals employing some assistive  
hearing devices (hearing aids and cochlear  
implants) use wireless mobile devices, they may  
detect a buzzing, humming, or whining noise.  
Some hearing devices are more immune than  
others to this interference noise, and mobile  
devices also vary in the amount of interference  
they generate.  
T-Ratings: Mobile devices rated T3 or T4 meet  
FCC requirements and are likely to generate less  
interference to hearing devices than mobile  
devices that are not labeled. T4 is the better/  
higher of the two ratings. T-ratings refer to  
enabling inductive coupling with hearing aids  
operating in telecoil mode.  
Hearing devices may also be rated. Your hearing  
aid manufacturer or hearing health professional  
may help you find this rating. Higher ratings  
mean that the hearing device is relatively  
immune to interference noise.  
The wireless telephone industry has developed a  
rating system for wireless mobile devices to  
assist hearing device users find mobile devices  
that may be compatible with their hearing  
230  
   
Under the current industry standard, American  
National Standards Institute (ANSI) C63.19, the  
hearing aid and wireless mobile device rating  
values are added together to indicate how usable  
they are together. For example, if a hearing aid  
meets the M2 level rating and the wireless  
mobile device meets the M3 level rating, the  
sum of the two values equals M5.  
The HAC rating and measurement procedure are  
described in the American National Standards  
Institute (ANSI) C63.19 standard.  
HAC for Newer Technologies  
This phone has been tested and rated for use  
with hearing aids for some of the wireless  
technologies that it uses. However, there may be  
some newer wireless technologies used in this  
phone that have not been tested yet for use with  
hearing aids.  
Under the standard, this should provide the  
hearing aid user with normal use while using the  
hearing aid with the particular wireless mobile  
device. A sum of 6 or more would indicate  
excellent performance.  
It is important to try the different features of this  
phone thoroughly and in different locations,  
using your hearing aid or cochlear implant, to  
determine if you hear any interfering noise.  
Consult your service provider or the  
However, these are not guarantees that all users  
will be satisfied. T ratings work similarly.  
manufacturer of this phone for information on  
hearing aid compatibility. If you have questions  
about return or exchange policies, consult your  
service provider or phone retailer.  
Restricting Children's Access  
to Your Mobile Device  
M3  
+
M2  
=
5
Your mobile device is not a toy. Do not allow  
children to play with it because they could hurt  
themselves and others, damage the mobile  
device, or make calls that increase your mobile  
device bill.  
Keep the mobile device and all its parts and  
accessories out of the reach of small children.  
T3  
+
T2  
=
5
Health and Safety Information  
231  
   
FCC Notice and Cautions  
Other Important Safety  
Information  
FCC Notice  
The mobile device may cause TV or radio  
interference if used in close proximity to  
receiving equipment. The FCC can require you to  
stop using the mobile device if such interference  
cannot be eliminated. Vehicles using liquefied  
petroleum gas (such as propane or butane) must  
comply with the National Fire Protection  
Standard (NFPA-58). For a copy of this standard,  
contact the National Fire Protection Association.  
Cautions  
Any changes or modifications to your mobile  
device not expressly approved in this document  
could void your warranty for this equipment and  
void your authority to operate this equipment.  
Only use approved batteries, antennas, and  
chargers. The use of any unauthorized  
Only qualified personnel should service the mobile  
device or install the mobile device in a vehicle.  
Faulty installation or service may be dangerous and  
may invalidate any warranty applicable to the  
device.  
Ensure that any mobile devices or related  
equipment installed in your vehicle are securely  
mounted.  
Check regularly that all wireless mobile device  
equipment in your vehicle is mounted and operating  
properly.  
When using a headset in dry environments, static  
electricity can build up in the headset and cause a  
small quick static electrical shock. To minimize the  
risk of electrostatic discharge from the headset  
avoid using the headset in extremely dry  
environments or touch a grounded unpainted metal  
object to discharge static electricity before inserting  
the headset.  
accessories may be dangerous and void the  
mobile device warranty if said accessories cause  
damage or a defect to the mobile device.  
Although your mobile device is quite sturdy, it is  
a complex piece of equipment and can be  
broken. Avoid dropping, hitting, bending, or  
sitting on it.  
Do not store or carry flammable liquids, gases, or  
explosive materials in the same compartment as the  
mobile device, its parts, or accessories.  
232  
       
For vehicles equipped with an air bag, remember  
that an air bag inflates with great force. Do not place  
objects, including installed or portable wireless  
equipment near or in the area over the air bag or in  
the air bag deployment area. If wireless equipment  
is improperly installed and the air bag inflates,  
serious injury could result.  
Reduce risk of repetitive motion injuries. When you  
repetitively perform actions, such as pressing keys,  
drawing characters on a touch screen with your  
fingers, or playing games, you may experience  
occasional discomfort in your hands, neck,  
shoulders, or other parts of your body. When using  
your device for extended periods, hold the device  
with a relaxed grip, press the keys lightly, and take  
frequent breaks. If you continue to have discomfort  
during or after such use, stop use and see a  
physician.  
Switch your mobile device off before boarding an  
aircraft. The use of wireless mobile devices in  
aircraft is illegal and may be dangerous to the  
aircraft's operation. Check with appropriate  
authorities before using any function of a mobile  
device while on an aircraft.  
If your device has a camera flash or light, do not use  
the flash or light close to the eyes of people or pets.  
[122011]  
Failure to observe these instructions may lead to the  
suspension or denial of cell phone services to the  
offender, or legal action, or both.  
While using your device, leave some lights on in the  
room and do not hold the screen too close to your  
eyes.  
Seizures or blackouts can occur when you are  
exposed to flashing lights while watching videos or  
playing games for extended periods. If you feel any  
discomfort, stop using the device immediately.  
Health and Safety Information  
233  
Section 14: Warranty Information  
damage resulting from excessive force or use of  
Standard Limited Warranty  
a metallic object when pressing on a touch  
screen; (d) equipment that has the serial number  
or the enhancement data code removed,  
What is covered and for how long?  
SAMSUNG TELECOMMUNICATIONS AMERICA,  
LLC (“SAMSUNG”) warrants that SAMSUNG’s  
handsets and accessories (“Products”) are free  
from defects in material and workmanship under  
normal use and service for the period  
commencing upon the date of purchase by the  
first consumer purchaser and continuing for the  
following specified period of time after that date:  
defaced, damaged, altered or made illegible;  
(e) ordinary wear and tear; (f) defects or damage  
resulting from the use of Product in conjunction  
or connection with accessories, products, or  
ancillary/peripheral equipment not furnished or  
approved by SAMSUNG; (g) defects or damage  
resulting from improper testing, operation,  
maintenance, installation, service, or adjustment  
not furnished or approved by SAMSUNG;  
Phone  
1 Year  
Batteries  
1 Year  
(h) defects or damage resulting from external  
causes such as collision with an object, fire,  
flooding, dirt, windstorm, lightning, earthquake,  
exposure to weather conditions, theft, blown  
fuse, or improper use of any electrical source;  
(i) defects or damage resulting from cellular  
signal reception or transmission, or viruses or  
other software problems introduced into the  
Product; or (j) Product used or purchased outside  
the United States. This Limited Warranty covers  
batteries only if battery capacity falls below 80%  
of rated capacity or the battery leaks, and this  
Limited Warranty does not cover any battery if  
(i) the battery has been charged by a battery  
charger not specified or approved by SAMSUNG  
for charging the battery; (ii) any of the seals on  
Case/Pouch/Holster  
90 Days  
Other Phone Accessories 1 Year  
What is not covered?  
This Limited Warranty is conditioned upon proper  
use of the Product.  
This Limited Warranty does not cover: (a) defects  
or damage resulting from accident, misuse,  
abnormal use, abnormal conditions, improper  
storage, exposure to liquid, moisture, dampness,  
sand or dirt, neglect, or unusual physical,  
electrical or electromechanical stress;  
(b) scratches, dents and cosmetic damage,  
unless caused by SAMSUNG; (c) defects or  
234  
       
the battery are broken or show evidence of  
tampering; or (iii) the battery has been used in  
equipment other than the SAMSUNG phone for  
which it is specified.  
What must you do to obtain warranty service?  
To obtain service under this Limited Warranty,  
you must return the Product to an authorized  
phone service facility in an adequate container  
for shipping, accompanied by the sales receipt or  
comparable proof of sale showing the original  
date of purchase, the serial number of the  
Product and the seller’s name and address.  
What are SAMSUNG’s obligations?  
During the applicable warranty period, provided  
the Product is returned in accordance with the  
terms of this Limited Warranty, SAMSUNG will  
repair or replace the Product, at SAMSUNG’s sole  
option, without charge. SAMSUNG may, at  
SAMSUNG’s sole option, use rebuilt,  
reconditioned, or new parts or components when  
repairing any Product, or may replace the  
Product with a rebuilt, reconditioned or new  
Product.  
To obtain assistance on where to deliver the  
Product, please call SAMSUNG Customer Care at  
1-888-987-4357. If SAMSUNG determines that  
any Product is not covered by this Limited  
Warranty, you must pay all parts, shipping, and  
labor charges for the repair or return of such  
Product.  
Repaired/replaced cases, pouches and holsters  
will be warranted for a period of ninety (90) days.  
All other repaired/replaced Products will be  
warranted for a period equal to the remainder of  
the original Limited Warranty on the original  
Product or for ninety (90) days, whichever is  
longer. All replaced Products, parts, components,  
boards and equipment shall become the property  
of SAMSUNG. Except to any extent expressly  
allowed by applicable law, transfer or  
You should keep a separate backup copy of any  
contents of the Product before delivering the  
Product to SAMSUNG for warranty service, as  
some or all of the contents may be deleted or  
reformatted during the course of warranty  
service.  
What are the limits on SAMSUNG’s liability?  
THIS LIMITED WARRANTY SETS OUT THE FULL  
EXTENT OF SAMSUNG’S RESPONSIBILITIES, AND  
THE EXCLUSIVE REMEDY REGARDING THE  
PRODUCTS.  
assignment of this Limited Warranty is  
prohibited.  
ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT  
LIMITATION, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ARE LIMITED TO THE  
Warranty Information  
235  
DURATION OF THIS LIMITED WARRANTY. IN NO  
EVENT SHALL SAMSUNG BE LIABLE FOR  
DAMAGES IN EXCESS OF THE PURCHASE PRICE  
OF THE PRODUCT OR FOR, WITHOUT  
THIRD-PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT RESTS  
SOLELY WITH THE USER AND THE DIRECT  
VENDOR, OWNER OR SUPPLIER OF SUCH THIRD-  
PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT.  
LIMITATION, COMMERCIAL LOSS OF ANY SORT;  
LOSS OF USE, TIME, DATA, REPUTATION,  
OPPORTUNITY, GOODWILL, PROFITS OR  
SAVINGS; INCONVENIENCE; INCIDENTAL,  
SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL OR PUNITIVE  
DAMAGES; OR DAMAGES ARISING FROM THE  
USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PRODUCT. SOME  
STATES AND JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW  
LIMITATIONS ON HOW LONG AN IMPLIED  
WARRANTY LASTS, OR THE DISCLAIMER OR  
LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS AND  
DISCLAIMERS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU.  
Nothing in the Product instructions or  
information shall be construed to create an  
express warranty of any kind with respect to the  
Products. No agent, employee, dealer,  
representative or reseller is authorized to modify  
or extend this Limited Warranty or to make  
binding representations or claims, whether in  
advertising, presentations or otherwise, on  
behalf of SAMSUNG regarding the Products or  
this Limited Warranty.  
This Limited Warranty gives you specific legal  
rights, and you may also have other rights that  
vary from state to state.  
SAMSUNG MAKES NO WARRANTIES OR  
REPRESENTATIONS, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,  
STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, AS TO THE  
QUALITY, CAPABILITIES, OPERATIONS,  
PERFORMANCE OR SUITABILITY OF ANY  
THIRD-PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT USED  
IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE PRODUCT, OR THE  
ABILITY TO INTEGRATE ANY SUCH SOFTWARE OR  
EQUIPMENT WITH THE PRODUCT, WHETHER  
SUCH THIRD-PARTY SOFTWARE OR EQUIPMENT  
IS INCLUDED WITH THE PRODUCT DISTRIBUTED  
BY SAMSUNG OR OTHERWISE. RESPONSIBILITY  
FOR THE QUALITY, CAPABILITIES, OPERATIONS,  
PERFORMANCE AND SUITABILITY OF ANY SUCH  
What is the procedure for resolving disputes?  
ALL DISPUTES WITH SAMSUNG ARISING IN ANY  
WAY FROM THIS LIMITED WARRANTY OR THE  
SALE, CONDITION OR PERFORMANCE OF THE  
PRODUCTS SHALL BE RESOLVED EXCLUSIVELY  
THROUGH FINAL AND BINDING ARBITRATION,  
AND NOT BY A COURT OR JURY.  
Any such dispute shall not be combined or  
consolidated with a dispute involving any other  
person’s or entity’s Product or claim, and  
specifically, without limitation of the foregoing,  
shall not under any circumstances proceed as  
part of a class action. The arbitration shall be  
236  
conducted before a single arbitrator, whose  
award may not exceed, in form or amount, the  
relief allowed by the applicable law. The  
arbitration shall be conducted according to the  
American Arbitration Association (AAA)  
Commercial Arbitration Rules applicable to  
consumer disputes. This arbitration provision is  
entered pursuant to the Federal Arbitration Act.  
The laws of the State of Texas, without reference  
to its choice of laws principles, shall govern the  
interpretation of the Limited Warranty and all  
disputes that are subject to this arbitration  
provision. The arbitrator shall decide all issues of  
interpretation and application of this arbitration  
provision and the Limited Warranty.  
and expert witness fees, exceed $5,000.00  
(“Large Claim”) shall be determined according to  
AAA rules. In a Large Claim case, the arbitrator  
may grant to the prevailing party, or apportion  
among the parties, reasonable attorney fees,  
expert witness fees and costs. Judgment may be  
entered on the arbitrator’s award in any court of  
competent jurisdiction.  
This arbitration provision also applies to claims  
against SAMSUNG’s employees, representatives  
and affiliates if any such claim arises from the  
Product’s sale, condition or performance.  
You may opt out of this dispute resolution  
procedure by providing notice to SAMSUNG no  
later than 30 calendar days from the date of the  
first consumer purchaser’s purchase of the  
Product. To opt out, you must send notice by  
e-mail to optout@sta.samsung.com, with the  
subject line: “Arbitration Opt Out.” You must  
include in the opt out e-mail (a) your name and  
address; (b) the date on which the Product was  
purchased; (c) the Product model name or model  
number; and (d) the IMEI or MEID or Serial  
Number, as applicable, if you have it (the IMEI or  
MEID or Serial Number can be found (i) on the  
Product box; (ii) on the Product information  
screen, which can be found under “Settings;”  
(iii) on a label on the back of the Product beneath  
the battery, if the battery is removable; and (iv) on  
the outside of the Product if the battery is not  
removable). Alternatively, you may opt out by  
For any arbitration in which your total damage  
claims, exclusive of attorney fees and expert  
witness fees, are $5,000.00 or less (“Small  
Claim”), the arbitrator may, if you prevail, award  
your reasonable attorney fees, expert witness  
fees and costs as part of any award, but may not  
grant SAMSUNG its attorney fees, expert witness  
fees or costs unless it is determined that the  
claim was brought in bad faith. In a Small Claim  
case, you shall be required to pay no more than  
half of the total administrative, facility and  
arbitrator fees, or $50.00 of such fees,  
whichever is less, and SAMSUNG shall pay the  
remainder of such fees. Administrative, facility  
and arbitrator fees for arbitrations in which your  
total damage claims, exclusive of attorney fees  
Warranty Information  
237  
calling 1-888-987-4357 no later than 30 calendar  
days from the date of the first consumer  
Important! Please provide warranty information  
(proof of purchase) to Samsung’s  
Customer Care Center in order to  
provide this service at no charge. If the  
warranty has expired on the device,  
charges may apply.  
purchaser’s purchase of the Product and providing  
the same information. These are the only two  
forms of notice that will be effective to opt out of  
this dispute resolution procedure. Opting out of  
this dispute resolution procedure will not affect  
the coverage of the Limited Warranty in any way,  
and you will continue to enjoy the benefits of the  
Limited Warranty.  
Samsung Telecommunications America, LLC  
1301 E. Lookout Drive  
Richardson, Texas 75082  
Severability  
Phone: 1-800-SAMSUNG  
Phone: 1-888-987-HELP (4357)  
©2012 Samsung Telecommunications America,  
LLC. All rights reserved.  
If any portion of this Limited Warranty is held to  
be illegal or unenforceable, such partial illegality  
or unenforceability shall not affect the  
enforceability of the remainder of the Limited  
Warranty.  
No reproduction in whole or in part allowed  
without prior written approval. Specifications and  
availability subject to change without notice.  
[111611]  
Precautions for Transfer and Disposal  
If data stored on this device is deleted or  
reformatted using the standard methods, the  
data only appears to be removed on a superficial  
level, and it may be possible for someone to  
retrieve and reuse the data by means of special  
software.  
End User License Agreement  
for Software  
IMPORTANT. READ CAREFULLY: This End User  
License Agreement (“EULA”) is a legal  
agreement between you (either an individual or a  
single entity) and Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.  
for software owned by Samsung Electronics Co.,  
Ltd. and its affiliated companies and its third  
party suppliers and licensors that accompanies  
this EULA, which includes computer software  
To avoid unintended information leaks and other  
problems of this sort, it is recommended that the  
device be returned to Samsung’s Customer Care  
Center for an Extended File System (EFS) Clear  
which will eliminate all user memory and return  
all settings to default settings. Please contact the  
Samsung Customer Care Center for details.  
238  
 
and may include associated media, printed  
materials, “online” or electronic documentation  
(“Software”).  
property laws and treaties. Samsung or its  
suppliers own the title, copyright and other  
intellectual property rights in the Software. The  
Software is licensed, not sold.  
BY CLICKING THE “I ACCEPT” BUTTON (OR IF  
YOU BYPASS OR OTHERWISE DISABLE THE “I  
ACCEPT”, AND STILL INSTALL, COPY,  
DOWNLOAD, ACCESS OR OTHERWISE USE THE  
SOFTWARE), YOU AGREE TO BE BOUND BY THE  
TERMS OF THIS EULA. IF YOU DO NOT ACCEPT  
THE TERMS IN THIS EULA, YOU MUST CLICK THE  
“DECLINE” BUTTON, AND DISCONTINUE USE OF  
THE SOFTWARE.  
3. LIMITATIONS ON END USER RIGHTS. You may  
not reverse engineer, decompile, disassemble, or  
otherwise attempt to discover the source code or  
algorithms of, the Software (except and only to  
the extent that such activity is expressly  
permitted by applicable law not withstanding this  
limitation), or modify, or disable any features of,  
the Software, or create derivative works based  
on the Software. You may not rent, lease, lend,  
sublicense or provide commercial hosting  
services with the Software.  
1. GRANT OF LICENSE. Samsung grants you the  
following rights provided that you comply with all  
terms and conditions of this EULA: You may  
install, use, access, display and run one copy of  
the Software on the local hard disk(s) or other  
permanent storage media of one computer and  
use the Software on a single computer or a  
mobile device at a time, and you may not make  
the Software available over a network where it  
could be used by multiple computers at the  
same time. You may make one copy of the  
Software in machine-readable form for backup  
purposes only; provided that the backup copy  
must include all copyright or other proprietary  
notices contained on the original.  
4. CONSENT TO USE OF DATA. You agree that  
Samsung and its affiliates may collect and use  
technical information gathered as part of the  
product support services related to the Software  
provided to you, if any, related to the Software.  
Samsung may use this information solely to  
improve its products or to provide customized  
services or technologies to you and will not  
disclose this information in a form that  
personally identifies you.  
5. UPGRADES. This EULA applies to updates,  
supplements and add-on components (if any) of  
the Software that Samsung may provide to you  
or make available to you after the date you  
obtain your initial copy of the Software, unless  
we provide other terms along with such upgrade.  
2. RESERVATION OF RIGHTS AND OWNERSHIP.  
Samsung reserves all rights not expressly  
granted to you in this EULA. The Software is  
protected by copyright and other intellectual  
Warranty Information  
239  
To use Software identified as an upgrade, you  
must first be licensed for the Software identified  
by Samsung as eligible for the upgrade. After  
upgrading, you may no longer use the Software  
that formed the basis for your upgrade eligibility.  
termination of this EULA, you must cease all use  
of the Software and destroy all copies, full or  
partial, of the Software.  
9. THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS. Certain  
third-party applications may be included with, or  
downloaded to this mobile device. SAMSUNG  
makes no representations whatsoever about any  
of these applications. Since SAMSUNG has no  
control over such applications, Purchaser  
acknowledges and agrees that SAMSUNG is not  
responsible for the availability of such  
applications and is not responsible or liable for  
any content, advertising, products, services, or  
other materials on or available from such  
applications. Purchaser expressly acknowledges  
and agrees that use of third-party applications is  
at Purchaser’s sole risk and that the entire risk of  
unsatisfactory quality, performance, accuracy  
and effort is with Purchaser. It is up to Purchaser  
to take precautions to ensure that whatever  
Purchaser selects to use is free of such items as  
viruses, worms, Trojan horses, and other items  
of a destructive nature. References on this  
mobile device to any names, marks, products, or  
services of any third-parties are provided solely  
as a convenience to Purchaser, and do not  
constitute or imply an endorsement,  
6. SOFTWARE TRANSFER. You may not transfer  
this EULA or the rights to the Software granted  
herein to any third party unless it is in connection  
with the sale of the mobile device which the  
Software accompanied. In such event, the  
transfer must include all of the Software  
(including all component parts, the media and  
printed materials, any upgrades, this EULA) and  
you may not retain any copies of the Software.  
The transfer may not be an indirect transfer,  
such as a consignment. Prior to the transfer, the  
end user receiving the Software must agree to all  
the EULA terms.  
7. EXPORT RESTRICTIONS. You acknowledge  
that the Software is subject to export restrictions  
of various countries. You agree to comply with all  
applicable international and national laws that  
apply to the Software, including the U.S. Export  
Administration Regulations, as well as end user,  
end use, and destination restrictions issued by  
U.S. and other governments.  
8. TERMINATION. This EULA is effective until  
terminated. Your rights under this License will  
terminate automatically without notice from  
Samsung if you fail to comply with any of the  
terms and conditions of this EULA. Upon  
sponsorship, or recommendation of, or affiliation  
with the third-party or its products and services.  
Purchaser agrees that SAMSUNG shall not be  
responsible or liable, directly or indirectly, for any  
240  
damage or loss caused or alleged to caused by,  
or in connection with, use of or reliance on any  
such third-party content, products, or services  
available on or through any such application.  
Purchaser acknowledges and agrees that your  
use of any third-party application is governed by  
such third-party application provider’s Terms of  
Use, License Agreement, Privacy Policy, or other  
such agreement and that any information or  
personal data you provide, whether knowingly or  
unknowingly, to such third-party application  
provider, will be subject to such third-party  
application provider’s privacy policy, if such a  
policy exists. SAMSUNG DISCLAIMS ANY  
DAMAGE TO YOUR MOBILE DEVICE OR LOSS OF  
DATA THAT RESULTS FROM THE DOWNLOADING  
OR USE OF SUCH THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS.  
SAMSUNG EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ANY  
WARRANTY REGARDING WHETHER  
PURCHASER’S PERSONAL INFORMATION IS  
CAPTURED BY ANY THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION  
PROVIDER OR THE USE TO WHICH SUCH  
PERSONAL INFORMATION MAY BE PUT BY SUCH  
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION PROVIDER. ANY  
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS PROVIDED WITH  
THIS MOBILE DEVICE ARE PROVIDED “AS IS”  
AND ON AN “AS AVAILABLE” BASIS, WITHOUT  
WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND FROM SAMSUNG,  
EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. TO THE FULLEST  
EXTENT POSSIBLE PURSUANT TO APPLICABLE  
LAW, SAMSUNG DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES  
EXPRESS, IMPLIED, OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING,  
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY, SATISFACTORY QUALITY OR  
WORKMANLIKE EFFORT, FITNESS FOR A  
RESPONSIBILITY FOR ANY DISCLOSURE OF  
INFORMATION OR ANY OTHER PRACTICES OF  
ANY THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION PROVIDER.  
10. Disclaimer of Warranty Regarding Third-Party  
Applications. SAMSUNG DOES NOT WARRANT  
OR MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS REGARDING  
THE AVAILABILITY, USE, TIMELINESS, SECURITY,  
VALIDITY, ACCURACY, OR RELIABILITY OF, OR THE  
RESULTS OF THE USE OF, OR OTHERWISE  
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, RELIABILITY OR  
AVAILABILITY, ACCURACY, LACK OF VIRUSES,  
QUIET ENJOYMENT, NON-INFRINGEMENT OF  
THIRD PARTY RIGHTS OR OTHER VIOLATION OF  
RIGHTS. SAMSUNG DOES NOT WARRANT  
AGAINST INTERFERENCE WITH YOUR  
ENJOYMENT OF THE THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION,  
THAT THE FUNCTIONS CONTAINED IN THE  
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION WILL MEET  
RESPECTING, THE CONTENT OF ANY  
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION WHETHER SUCH  
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION IS INCLUDED WITH  
THE PRODUCT DISTRIBUTED BY SAMSUNG, IS  
DOWNLOADED, OR OTHERWISE OBTAINED. USE  
OF ANY THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION IS DONE AT  
PURCHASER’S OWN DISCRETION AND RISK AND  
PURCHASER IS SOLELY RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY  
PURCHASER’S REQUIREMENTS, THAT THE  
Warranty Information  
241  
OPERATION OF THE THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION  
WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR-FREE, OR  
THAT DEFECTS IN THE THIRD-PARTY  
ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF  
INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO  
THE ABOVE LIMITATION OR EXCLUSION MAY NOT  
APPLY TO YOU. NOT WITHSTANDING THE  
APPLICATION WILL BE CORRECTED. PURCHASER  
ASSUMES THE ENTIRE COST OF ALL NECESSARY  
SERVICING, REPAIR, OR CORRECTION. SOME  
JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW EXCLUSIONS OR  
LIMITATIONS ON HOW LONG AN IMPLIED  
WARRANTY LASTS, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS  
OR EXCLUSIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. NO  
ADVICE OR INFORMATION, WHETHER ORAL OR  
WRITTEN, OBTAINED BY PURCHASER FROM  
SAMSUNG SHALL BE DEEMED TO ALTER THIS  
DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY REGARDING  
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS, OR TO CREATE  
ANY WARRANTY.  
FOREGOING, SAMSUNG’S TOTAL LIABILITY TO  
PURCHASER FOR ALL LOSSES, DAMAGES,  
CAUSES OF ACTION, INCLUDING BUT NOT  
LIMITED TO THOSE BASED ON CONTRACT, TORT,  
OR OTHERWISE, ARISING OUT OF PURCHASER’S  
USE OF THIRD-PARTY APPLICATIONS ON THIS  
MOBILE DEVICE, OR ANY OTHER PROVISION OF  
THIS EULA, SHALL NOT EXCEED THE AMOUNT  
PURCHASER PAID SPECIFICALLY FOR ANY SUCH  
THIRD-PARTY APPLICATION THAT WAS  
INCLUDED WITH THIS MOBILE DEVICE. THE  
FOREGOING LIMITATIONS, EXCLUSIONS, AND  
DISCLAIMERS (INCLUDING SECTIONS 9, 10, AND  
11) SHALL APPLY TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT  
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, EVEN IF ANY  
REMEDY FAILS ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE.  
11. Limitation of Liability. SAMSUNG WILL NOT  
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES OF ANY KIND  
ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THE USE OR  
THE INABILITY TO USE ANY THIRD-PARTY  
APPLICATION, ITS CONTENT OR FUNCTIONALITY,  
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO DAMAGES  
CAUSED BY OR RELATED TO ERRORS,  
OMISSIONS, INTERRUPTIONS, DEFECTS, DELAY  
IN OPERATION OR TRANSMISSION, COMPUTER  
VIRUS, FAILURE TO CONNECT, NETWORK  
CHARGES, AND ALL OTHER DIRECT, INDIRECT,  
SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, EXEMPLARY, OR  
12. U.S. Government End Users Restricted  
Rights. The Software is licensed only with  
"restricted rights" and as "commercial items"  
consisting of "commercial software" and  
"commercial software documentation" with only  
those rights as are granted to all other end users  
pursuant to the terms and conditions herein. All  
Software and Products provided to the United  
States Government pursuant to solicitations  
issued on or after December 1, 1995 is provided  
with the commercial rights and restrictions  
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES EVEN IF SAMSUNG  
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF  
SUCH DAMAGES. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT  
242  
described elsewhere herein. All Software and  
Products provided to the United States  
Government pursuant to solicitations issued prior  
to December 1, 1995 are provided with  
RESTRICTED RIGHTS as provided for in FAR, 48  
CFR 52.227-14 (JUNE 1987) or DFAR, 48 CFR  
252.227-7013 (OCT 1988), as applicable.  
Social Hub  
Legal Terms and Privacy  
Samsung's Social Hub and (if applicable) the  
website where you accessed this Disclaimer  
(collectively, the "Service"), is being made  
available to you by Samsung Electronics Co.,  
Ltd., and its affiliates and suppliers (collectively  
"Samsung") subject to the following enclosed  
documents:  
13. APPLICABLE LAW. This EULA is governed by  
the laws of TEXAS, without regard to conflicts of  
laws principles. This EULA shall not be governed  
by the UN Convention on Contracts for the  
International Sale of Goods, the application of  
which is expressly excluded. If a dispute,  
controversy or difference is not amicably settled,  
it shall be finally resolved by arbitration in Seoul,  
Korea in accordance with the Arbitration Rules of  
the Korean Commercial Arbitration Board. The  
award of arbitration shall be final and binding  
upon the parties.  
Social Hub Terms and Conditions which governs  
your use of the Service generally;  
Social Hub End User License Agreement which  
specifically governs your use of the software which  
forms part of, or enables you to access, the Service;  
and  
Social Hub Privacy Policy which governs our  
collection and use of personal information in  
connection with your access to and use of the  
Service.  
14. ENTIRE AGREEMENT; SEVERABILITY. This  
EULA is the entire agreement between you and  
Samsung relating to the Software and  
supersedes all prior or contemporaneous oral or  
written communications, proposals and  
representations with respect to the Software or  
any other subject matter covered by this EULA. If  
any provision of this EULA is held to be void,  
invalid, unenforceable or illegal, the other  
provisions shall continue in full force and effect.  
By using the Service, you agree to be bound by  
the above documents. Please read through  
those documents to make sure you understand  
the basis on which Samsung is providing the  
Service to you.  
You will be able to access additional features  
.
Warranty Information  
243  
   
Such Amendments will be effective immediately  
and incorporated into the Terms upon sending or  
posting of such notice. You are responsible for  
regularly reviewing the Terms. Your continued  
use of the Service will be deemed to constitute  
your acceptance of any and all such  
Social Hub Terms and Conditions  
Acceptance of the Terms  
These Social Hub Terms and Conditions together  
with the Social Hub Privacy Policy and Social Hub  
End User Licence Agreement (collectively  
"Terms") govern your use of Social Hub, which  
comprises all content and services accessible  
through Social Hub (including third party content  
and services), and (if applicable) the website  
where you accessed these Terms (collectively  
the "Service"). The Terms constitute an  
agreement between you and Samsung  
Amendments.  
Eligibility  
To use the Service, you must be at least sixteen  
(16) years of age. If you are at least sixteen (16 )  
years of age but are a minor for legal purposes  
where you live, you must review the Terms and  
have your parent or legal guardian accept the  
Terms on your behalf in order for you to use the  
Service. The person accepting the Terms on your  
behalf must be legally competent.  
Electronics Co., Ltd., and its affiliates  
(collectively "Samsung") with respect to the  
Service. By using the Service, you agree to be  
legally bound to the Terms.  
Your Information  
You are not allowed to use the Service if you do  
not agree to the Terms. To the extent permitted  
by applicable law, Samsung reserves the right to  
modify, update, supplement, revise or otherwise  
change the Terms, and to impose new or  
additional rules, policies, terms or conditions in  
relation to the Service, from time to time with or  
without notice to you ("Amendments").  
When required to provide information in  
connection with your use of the Service, you  
agree to provide truthful and complete  
information. Providing misleading information  
about your identity is forbidden. When you first  
use the Service, you may be required to create a  
username and a password.  
Samsung may provide you with notice of the  
Amendments by sending an email message to  
the email address listed in your account  
information (if any), or by posting the notice on  
the Social Hub website.  
You (and your parent or legal guardian, if you are  
a minor) are personally responsible for any use  
of the Service with your username and  
password.  
244  
You agree to take due care in protecting your  
username and password against misuse by  
others and promptly notify Samsung about any  
misuse.  
if Samsung determines, at its sole discretion,  
that you have repeatedly submitted infringing  
Materials to the Service.  
Using the Service  
You agree to:  
Termination of Service  
Samsung may terminate or restrict your access  
to certain parts of the Service if there is an  
indication that you have breached the Terms or  
at any time in its sole discretion.  
Use the Service only for your private,  
non-commercial purposes;  
Comply with applicable laws, the Terms and good  
manners;  
Your Material  
Not submit unlawful, offensive, abusive,  
pornographic, harassing, libelous or other  
inappropriate Material;  
Except as set forth in the Social Hub Privacy  
Policy, Samsung shall not be responsible for any  
removal of the information or content you have  
submitted in the course of using the Service  
("Material") when your access to the Service is  
terminated. Your submission of Material in the  
course of using the Service does not transfer  
ownership rights in the Material to Samsung.  
After the Material is removed from the Service by  
either you or Samsung, some traces of the  
Material may remain and copies of the Material  
may still reside within the servers used in  
providing the Service. However, Samsung does  
not claim ownership in your Material.  
Respect the privacy of others;  
Obtain any consents, permission or licenses that  
may be required for you to have the legal right to  
submit any Material; and  
Not distribute or post spam, unreasonably large  
files, chain letters, pyramid schemes, viruses or any  
other technologies that may harm the Service, or  
the interest or property of the Service users.  
Unauthorized use of the Service (including any  
use in contravention of the Terms) is prohibited  
and may result in criminal prosecution and/or  
civil liability.  
You represent and warrant that you have  
obtained any consents, permission or licenses  
that may be required for you to have the legal  
right to submit any Material. Samsung reserves  
the right to terminate your access to the Service  
Restrictions  
You and any third party directed by You must not  
display, copy, store, modify, sell, publish or  
redistribute the Service (whether all or any  
Warranty Information  
245  
portion of it), and such displaying, copying,  
storing, modification, sale, publishing and  
redistribution shall be prohibited unless you have  
obtained all necessary rights and permissions  
from Samsung and the owners and right holders  
of such the Service or relevant part.  
Actions Required by Law  
Samsung may need to comply with lawful  
interception and/or data retention requirements  
imposed by your country of residence or any  
other country in which you use the Service.  
Samsung may restrict access to any part of the  
Service or terminate your access to the Service,  
at any time in its sole discretion if required by  
law or by the relevant authorities or regulatory  
agencies to do so.  
You must not use the Service for any purposes  
other than those permitted under the Terms.  
Without limiting this restriction, you must not use  
the service for any illegal purposes, to make  
unsolicited offers or advertisements, to  
impersonate or falsely claim affiliation with any  
person or entity, to misrepresent, harass,  
defraud or defame others, to post obscene or  
unreasonably offensive material, to negatively  
present the Service, nor for any commercial  
purposes.  
Third Party Sites and Content  
The Service may allow access to sites on the  
Internet that are owned or operated by third  
parties. Access to such sites does not imply that  
Samsung endorses the site or the conduct,  
products or services on the site. Upon accessing  
any such site, you must review and agree to the  
rules of use of the relevant site before using the  
site.  
Except as expressly permitted by the Terms, and  
except to the extent that applicable laws prevent  
Samsung from restraining you from doing so,  
you are not allowed to disassemble, reverse  
engineer, tamper with the Service, transmit  
malicious code or collect information of other  
users through the Service.  
You acknowledge and agree that Samsung has  
no control over the content, products or services  
of third-party sites and does not assume any  
responsibility for or in respect of such content,  
products or services. Third party content and  
services may be terminated or interrupted at any  
time, and Samsung makes no representation or  
warranty that any content or service will remain  
available for any period of time. Samsung  
You may not take any action to interrupt the  
functionality of or tamper with the Service or any  
content or service contained in or provided  
through the Service, or any servers used in  
providing the Service, or to unreasonably affect  
others' enjoyment of the Service in any way.  
246  
expressly disclaims any responsibility or liability  
for any interruption or suspension of any third  
party content or service.  
you own initiative and at you own risk, and you  
are responsible for complying with all US  
federal, state and local laws, rules and  
regulations.  
In addition, Samsung is neither responsible nor  
liable for customer service related to third party  
sites. Any question or request for service relating  
to third party sites should be made directly to the  
relevant site operator.  
Dealings with Others  
You may interact with other users on or through  
the Service. You agree that any such interactions  
do not involve Samsung and are solely between  
you and the other user(s).  
Subscription Information  
Use of the Service may involve transmission of  
data through your service provider's network.  
Your network service provider may charge you  
for such data transmission. Samsung assumes  
no responsibility for the payment of any such  
charges.  
Intellectual Property  
The Service and related software are protected  
under international copyright laws and you are  
hereby notified that copyrights are claimed by  
Samsung.  
Subject to the Terms, Samsung retains all right,  
title and interest in the Service and in all  
Samsung's products, software and other  
properties provided to you or used by you  
through the Service.  
Availability  
The Service may be network dependent -  
contact your network service provider for more  
information. Samsung reserves the right, in its  
sole discretion, to change, improve and correct  
the Service. The Service may not be available  
during maintenance breaks and other times.  
Samsung may also decide to discontinue the  
Service or any part thereof in its sole discretion.  
In such case you will be provided with prior  
notification.  
Personal Data  
The Social Hub Privacy Policy and the following  
additional provisions govern the use of your  
personal information. When you access the  
Service, Samsung may ask for or otherwise  
collect certain personal information such as your  
email address along with your user name and  
password and, in certain cases, your mobile  
phone number so that we can communicate with  
you, for example to send notifications of  
Samsung does not represent or warrant that the  
Service, or any part thereof, is appropriate or  
available for use in any particular jurisdiction. If  
you choose to access the Service, you do so on  
incoming messages. When you use the Service,  
Warranty Information  
247  
certain technical information such as the type  
and serial number of your mobile device, Internet  
protocol address, your mobile network and  
country codes, timezone, technical details of  
your client as well as your transactions with  
Samsung, for example your acceptance of the  
Terms, will be automatically collected by  
Samsung.  
In connection with certain services accessible  
via the Service, Samsung may cooperate with  
your operator and other third parties. Samsung  
may receive from such third parties certain  
device specific non-personal information, such  
as device serial number of the devices sold by  
the operator with preinstalled software for the  
Service. Such information may be used for  
aanalyzing the activation of the Service.  
The purposes for which Samsung may use such  
data are explained in the Social Hub Privacy  
Policy. Samsung may also participate with your  
selected service providers in maintaining your  
contact lists.  
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY  
THE SERVICE IS PROVIDED ON "AS IS" AND "AS  
AVAILABLE" BASIS. TO THE FULLEST EXTENT  
PERMITTED BY THE LAW AND SUBJECT TO THE  
TERMS, SAMSUNG DOES NOT WARRANT THAT  
THE SERVICE WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR  
ERROR OR VIRUS-FREE.  
The third party services and content you access  
through the Service and the telecommunications  
carriers and the network through which you  
access the Service are provided and hosted by  
your selected third party content and service  
providers who typically has a privacy policy of its  
own. We recommend you familiarize yourself  
with your service provider's privacy policy.  
Samsung is not responsible for the privacy or  
any other practices of such service providers.  
Although your messages will be transmitted  
through Samsung's servers, Samsung will not  
process the content or headers of your  
TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY THE  
LAW AND SUBJECT TO THE TERMS, NO  
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR  
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO  
WARRANTIES OF TITLE OR NON-INFRINGEMENT  
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  
OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, IS  
MADE IN RELATION TO THE AVAILABILITY,  
ACCURACY, RELIABILITY, OF THE SERVICE,  
INCLUDING ANY INFORMATION OR CONTENT  
PROVIDED THROUGH THE SERVICE. YOU  
EXPRESSLY AGREE AND ACKNOWLEDGE THAT  
THE USE OF THE SERVICE IS AT YOUR SOLE RISK  
AND THAT YOU MAY BE EXPOSED TO CONTENT  
FROM VARIOUS SOURCES.  
messages for any purpose other than as  
necessary to deliver and manage your  
messages, unless otherwise required by law.  
248  
 
SAMSUNG SHALL NOT BE HELD RESPONSIBLE  
FOR ANY THIRD PARTY CONTENT OR SERVICE  
THAT MAY BE ACCESSED THROUGH THE  
SERVICE, NOR SHALL SAMSUNG BE HELD  
RESPONSIBLE FOR MALICIOUS CODE  
CONTAINED ON OR DISTRIBUTED THROUGH BY  
THIRD PARTIES.  
APPLY, TO THE EXTENT TO WHICH SAMSUNG IS  
ABLE TO DO SO, SAMSUNG LIMITS ITS LIABILITY  
UNDER THOSE PROVISIONS TO, AT ITS OPTION,  
IN THE CASE OF SERVICES (A) THE SUPPLYING  
OF THE SERVICES AGAIN; OR (B) THE PAYMENT  
OF THE COST OF HAVING THE SERVICES  
SUPPLIED AGAIN AND, IN THE CASE OF GOODS,  
(A) THE REPLACEMENT OF THE GOODS OR THE  
SUPPLY OF EQUIVALENT GOODS; (B) THE REPAIR  
OF THE GOODS; (C) THE PAYMENT OF THE COST  
OF REPLACING THE GOODS OR OF ACQUIRING  
EQUIVALENT GOODS; OR (D) THE PAYMENT OF  
THE COST OF HAVING THE GOODS REPAIRED.  
YOU ASSUME FULL RESPONSIBILITY FOR ANY  
DAMAGES, LOSSES, COSTS, OR HARM ARISING  
FROM YOUR USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THE  
SERVICE. TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY LAW,  
EXCEPT FOR LIABILITY FOR DEATH OR  
PERSONAL INJURY CAUSED BY GROSS  
NEGLIGENCE OR INTENTIONAL MISCONDUCT,  
SAMSUNG DISCLAIMS ALL LIABILITIES WITH  
RESPECT TO YOUR USE OF THE SERVICE  
(INCLUDING DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,  
PUNITIVE OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES).  
Indemnification  
You agree to defend, indemnify and hold  
harmless Samsung from and against any and all  
third party claims and all liabilities, assessments,  
losses, costs or damages resulting from or  
arising out of i) your breach of the Terms, ii) your  
infringement or violation of any intellectual  
property, other rights or privacy of a third party,  
iii) misuse of the Service by a third party where  
such misuse was made possible due to your  
failure to take reasonable measures to protect  
your username and password against misuse.  
IF THERE IS A CLAIM THAT WE HAVE BREACHED  
ANY OF THE PROVISIONS IN THE TERMS, THIS  
DOES NOT AFFECT OR INVALIDATE THE OTHER  
PROVISIONS.  
CERTAIN STATUTORY PROVISIONS UNDER  
APPLICABLE LAW MAY IMPLY WARRANTIES OR  
CONDITIONS OR IMPOSE OBLIGATIONS UPON  
SAMSUNG WHICH CANNOT BE EXCLUDED,  
RESTRICTED OR MODIFIED OR CANNOT BE  
EXCLUDED, RESTRICTED OR MODIFIED EXCEPT  
TO A LIMITED EXTENT. THE TERMS MUST BE  
READ SUBJECT TO THESE STATUTORY  
Choice of Law  
Except where prohibited by applicable law or  
provided otherwise herein, the Terms shall be  
governed by the laws of the State of New York  
without regard to its conflict of law provisions.  
PROVISIONS. IF THESE STATUTORY PROVISIONS  
Warranty Information  
249  
You and Samsung agree to submit to the  
non-exclusive jurisdiction of the competent  
courts in the State of New York to resolve any  
legal matters arising from the Terms.  
Notwithstanding this, you agree that Samsung  
shall still be allowed to apply for injunctive  
remedies (or equivalent type of urgent legal  
relief) in any jurisdiction.  
condition beyond the reasonable control of  
Samsung. If there is any conflict between these  
Social Hub Terms and Conditions and the Social  
Hub Privacy Policy, the provisions of these Social  
Hub Terms and Conditions shall prevail. The  
provisions of the Terms that are intended to or by  
their nature should survive termination of your  
use of the Service shall remain valid after any  
such termination.  
Miscellaneous  
Social Hub Privacy Policy  
The Terms (including all documents comprising  
the Terms) constitute the entire agreement  
between you and Samsung, and supersedes any  
prior agreement between you and Samsung,  
with respect to your use of the Service. Your use  
of any third-party content or service accessed  
via the Service will be governed by the terms and  
conditions furnished with, and applicable to that  
content or service. If any provision of the Terms  
is held invalid, illegal or unenforceable, that  
portion of the Terms shall be construed in a  
manner consistent with applicable law to reflect,  
as nearly as possible, the original intentions of  
the parties, and the remaining portion of the  
Terms shall remain in full force and effect.  
Samsung's failure to enforce any right or  
provision of the Terms will not constitute a  
waiver of such provision, or any other provision  
of the Terms.  
Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. ("Samsung") is  
committed to protecting the online privacy of  
visitors, users and customers to our Social Hub  
service. This privacy policy ( "Privacy Policy")  
forms part of the Terms which govern your use of  
Social Hub(excluding any third party content and  
services), and (if applicable) the website where  
you accessed this Privacy Policy, (collectively, the  
"Service"). The purpose of the Privacy Policy is  
to inform you about the types of information we  
gather about you when you access or use the  
Service, how we may use that information, and if  
and how we disclose it to third parties.  
All users of the Service are required to provide  
true, current, complete and accurate personal  
information when prompted and we will reject  
and delete any entry that we believe in good faith  
to be incorrect, false, falsified, or fraudulent, or  
inconsistent with or in violation of the Privacy  
Policy.  
Samsung will not be liable or responsible for any  
failure to fulfill any of its obligations under the  
Terms which failure is due to any cause or  
250  
 
We will provide you with an opportunity to give  
your consent in relation to your use of the  
Service. Separate from such consent, your  
access or use of the Service will be construed as  
your acceptance of the Privacy Policy and of our  
collection, use, disclosure, management and  
storage of your personal information as  
described below. We may, from time to time,  
transfer or merge any personal information  
collected off-line to our online databases or store  
off-line information in an electronic format. We  
may also combine personal information we  
collect online with information available from  
other sources, including information received  
from our affiliates, marketing companies, or  
advertisers. This Privacy Policy covers all such  
personal information and will remain in full force  
and effect as long as you are a user of the  
Service, even if your use of or participation in  
any particular service, feature, function or  
promotional activity terminates, expires, ceases,  
is suspended or deactivated for any reason.  
forms, surveys, and polls. In each such case, you  
will know what categories of information we  
collect because you will actively provide the  
information to us. You may not be able to fully  
utilize all of the features or components of the  
Service if you choose not to provide certain  
information. If you do choose to give us personal  
information through the Service, we will collect  
and retain that information.  
Non-Personal Information  
When you use the Service, we may also collect  
"non-personal" information. We consider  
"non-personal information" to be information  
that, by itself, cannot be used to identify or  
contact you personally, such as demographic  
information (your age, gender, income,  
education, profession, zip code, etc.).  
Non-personal information may also include  
technical information, such as your IP address  
and other anonymous data involving your use of  
the Service.  
Non-personal information may also include  
information that you provide us through your use  
of the Service, such as the terms you enter into  
the search functions of Social Hub, mail inbox  
and instant messenger. We reserve the right to  
use or disclose non-personal information in any  
way we see fit.  
INFORMATION THAT WE  
COLLECT  
Personal Information  
We may request that you supply us with  
"personal" information, such as your name,  
e-mail address, mailing address, home or work  
telephone number in the course of you accessing  
or using the Service, such as via registration  
Warranty Information  
251  
 
we believe may be of interest to you. You may  
have the opportunity to subscribe to an  
USE OF INFORMATION WE  
COLLECT  
electronic newsletter in which case information  
about the Service or our advertisers will be sent  
to your e-mail address. We will provide you with  
the option to change your preferences and  
opt-out of receiving those communications. You  
may request at any time that we not e-mail you  
in future by clicking the "unsubscribe" link which  
is included at the bottom of any e-mail that you  
receive from us. If you unsubscribe, we will  
make reasonable efforts to discontinue e-mail  
communications to you as soon as practicable.  
Our Services  
We use your personal information to provide you  
with any services that you may request or  
require, to communicate with you and to allow  
you to participate in online surveys. We use  
aggregated non-personal information about our  
users to understand the demographics of users  
of the Service, such as the percentage of male  
and female users, the geographic distribution of  
our users, the age ranges of our users, a  
combination of these and/or other  
demographics. We may also use the personal or  
non-personal information we collect to analyze  
how Service is being used, and to improve the  
content of the Service, and for marketing and  
promotional efforts.  
DISCLOSURE OF  
INFORMATION TO THIRD  
PARTIES  
Aggregate Information  
Except as specifically set forth in this Privacy  
Policy, we do not share your personal information  
with any third party without your permission. We  
may disclose aggregate information, such as  
demographic information, and our statistical  
analyses to third parties, including advertisers or  
other business partners. This aggregate  
information does not include your personal  
information.  
E-mail Communications  
If you send us an e-mail with questions or  
comments, we may use your personal  
information to respond to your questions or  
comments, and we may save your questions or  
comments for future reference. Aside from our  
reply to such an e-mail, it is not our standard  
practice to send you e-mail unless you request a  
particular service that involves e-mail  
communications. However, you consent to us  
contacting you by e-mail, and sending you  
information about products and services which  
Service Providers  
We sometimes engage unaffiliated businesses to  
assist us in providing you certain services. For  
example, we may use third parties to provide  
252  
   
advertising, marketing and promotional  
assistance, provide e-mail services, or facilitate  
our online services. In those instances, we may  
need to share your personal information with  
them.  
and using this information, you may visit each  
third party advertiser's website directly and  
opt-out.  
Other Disclosures  
We may disclose personal information when we  
are required or requested to do so by law, court  
order or other government or law enforcement  
authority or regulatory agency; to enforce or  
apply our rights and agreements; or when we  
believe in good faith that disclosing this  
information is necessary or advisable, including,  
for example, to protect the rights, property, or  
safety of the Service and Samsung, our users, or  
others.  
We require these companies to use your  
personal information only to provide the  
particular product or service and do not  
authorize them to use your personal information  
for any other reason. We sometimes offer  
promotions in conjunction with a third party  
sponsor.  
If you choose to participate in those promotions,  
we may share your information with the sponsor  
if they need it to send you a product or other  
special promotion they offer.  
CHILDREN  
The Service is not designed for use by children  
without their parent's supervision. We ask that  
anyone under the age of sixteen (16) not submit  
any personal information through the Service.  
We do not knowingly collect any personal  
information from children under the age of  
eighteen, and therefore we do not knowingly  
distribute such information to third parties.  
Third Party Advertisers  
We may use third-party advertising companies to  
deliver specific advertisements to you. These  
companies may collect non-personal information  
about your visits to Social Hub in order to provide  
advertisements about products and services that  
may be of interest to you.  
These companies may also aggregate your  
non-personal information for use in targeted  
advertising, marketing research, and other  
similar purposes. These companies may place  
their own cookies on your computer. If you want  
to prevent a third-party advertiser from collecting  
SECURITY OF THE  
INFORMATION WE COLLECT  
The security of your personal information is  
important to us. We maintain physical,  
electronic, and procedural safeguards to secure  
your personal information. However, there is  
always some risk in transmitting information  
Warranty Information  
253  
   
electronically. The personal information we  
collect is stored within databases that we  
control.  
delete the information from its active database.  
We maintain archives for disaster recovery, legal  
and other non-marketing purposes.  
As we deem appropriate, we use security  
measures consistent with industry standards,  
such as firewalls and encryption technology, to  
protect your information. However, we cannot  
guarantee the security of our databases, nor can  
we guarantee that information you supply won't  
be intercepted while being transmitted to us over  
the Internet.  
How can I update my profile?  
You can help us maintain the accuracy of your  
profile by notifying us when you change zip/  
postal code, country of residence, age range, or  
e-mail address. If at any time you wish to update  
your information or stop receiving  
communication from us, sign in to the Service  
and then select 'update your profile' to change  
your preferences.  
CHAT ROOMS AND OTHER  
PUBLIC AREAS  
Our third party service and content providers  
may offer chat, user reviews, bulletin boards, or  
other public functions and any posting by you is  
considered public information available to other  
users. Any posting is governed in accordance  
with the third party service and content  
providers' terms and conditions. You should take  
care not to use personal information in your  
screen name or other information that might be  
publicly available to other users.  
CONTESTS AND  
SWEEPSTAKES  
Registration may be required to enter promotions  
such as contests and sweepstakes on Social  
Hub. These registration or entry processes may  
require your submission of personal information  
such as your first and last name, street address,  
city, state and zip code, e-mail address,  
telephone number and date of birth. The entry  
page and/or rules for the promotion will provide  
the specific requirements for the promotion. You  
may also have the opportunity to opt-in to  
special offers from our advertisers in connection  
with these promotions.  
Archived Information  
We maintain archives of web logs, database, and  
other systems and information in relation to the  
Service. Please note that it is possible some of  
this information may remain archived after we  
254  
   
ACCURACY OF THE  
INFORMATION WE COLLECT  
CHANGES TO PRIVACY  
POLICY  
Any questions you may have regarding this  
Privacy Policy, the accuracy of your personal  
information or the use of your personal  
information, or any requests that we correct,  
update, or remove your information in our  
databases, should be directed via e-mail to  
s.dufresne@Samsung.com, or via regular mail  
to:  
This Privacy Policy is effective as of May 29,  
2010 and complies with Samsung's Corporate  
Privacy Policy. We reserve the right to change  
this Privacy Policy at any time, and will post any  
such changes to this Privacy Policy on the Social  
Hub website. Please refer back to the Social Hub  
website on a regular basis to obtain the most up  
to date Privacy Policy.  
Samsung Telecommunications America, LLC  
1301 E. Lookout Drive, Richardson, TX 75082  
Attn: Customer Support Department  
Social Hub End User License  
Agreement  
1. SOCIAL HUB  
After receiving a request to change your  
information, we will make reasonable efforts to  
ensure that all of your personal information  
stored in databases we actively use to operate  
the Service will be updated, corrected, changed  
or deleted, as appropriate, as soon as reasonably  
practicable. However, we reserve the right to  
retain in our archival files any information we  
remove from or change in our active databases.  
We may retain such information to resolve  
disputes, troubleshoot problems and enforce our  
Terms.  
This end user license ("License") allows you to  
use Social Hub ("Software") made available on  
your mobile device. This License is a legally  
binding agreement between you and Samsung  
Electronics Co. Ltd. the ("Licensor").  
2. LICENSE  
2.1 Licensor grants you for the term of this  
License a limited, personal, non-exclusive,  
non-transferable license to use the Software in  
object code executable only form on a single  
device for non-commercial uses.  
In addition, it is not technologically possible to  
remove each and every record of the information  
you have provided to us. A copy of your personal  
information may exist in a non-erasable form  
that will be difficult or impossible for us to locate.  
2.2 All rights not expressly granted to you under  
this License are reserved to Licensor, and you  
agree not to take or permit any action with  
respect to the Software that is not expressly  
authorised under this License. For the avoidance  
Warranty Information  
255  
     
of doubt, you have no right to use, incorporate  
into other products, copy, modify, translate or  
transfer to any third party the Software or any  
modification, adaptation or copy of the Software  
or any part thereof, nor to decompile, reverse  
engineer, or disassemble the binary code of the  
Software, either in whole or in part, except as  
expressly provided in this License.  
4. CONFIDENTIALITY  
4.1 The structure, organisation and source code  
of the Software are the valuable trade secrets  
and proprietary confidential information of  
Licensor and its licensors. You agree not to  
provide or disclose any such confidential  
information in the Software or derived from it to  
any third party.  
2.3 The Software is licensed to you only. You  
may not rent, lease, sub-license, sell, assign,  
pledge, transfer or otherwise dispose of the  
Software, on a temporary or permanent basis  
without the prior written consent of Licensor.  
4.2 The provisions of clause 4.1 will not apply to  
any information which is:  
4.2.1 lawfully obtained free of any duty of  
confidentiality (otherwise than directly or  
indirectly from Licensor); or  
3. OWNERSHIP OF INTELLECTUAL  
PROPERTY RIGHTS  
3.1 Your only right to use the Software is by  
virtue of this License and you acknowledge that  
all intellectual property rights in or relating to the  
Software and all parts of the Software are and  
shall remain the exclusive property of Licensor or  
its licensors.  
4.2.2 already in your possession, provided that  
Licensee can show such possession from written  
records (other than as a result of a breach of this  
clause 4); or  
4.2.3 which you can demonstrate is in the  
public domain (other than as a result of a breach  
of this clause 4).  
4.3 To the extent that any information is  
necessarily disclosed pursuant to a statutory or  
regulatory obligation or court order, such  
disclosure shall not be a breach of this clause 4  
provided you do what you can to prevent any  
such disclosure.  
3.2 You agree that you will not remove or alter  
any copyright notices or similar proprietary  
devices, including without limitation any  
electronic watermarks or other identifiers, that  
may be incorporated in the Software or any copy  
of the Software.  
256  
WHICH, BUT FOR SUCH EXCLUSION, WOULD OR  
MIGHT SUBSIST IN FAVOUR OF YOU. EXCEPT AS  
SET OUT IN THIS LICENSE YOU ASSUME THE  
ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND  
5. WARRANTY AND SUPPORT  
The Software is provided "as is" with no  
representation, guarantee or warranty of any  
kind as to its functionality or that it does not and  
will not infringe any third party rights (including  
intellectual property rights). Licensor has no  
obligation under this License to provide technical  
or other support to you.  
PERFORMANCE OF THE SOFTWARE.  
6.3 SUBJECT TO CLAUSE 6.1 LICENSOR WILL  
BE UNDER NO LIABILITY TO YOU WHATSOEVER  
(WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT (INCLUDING  
NEGLIGENCE), BREACH OF STATUTORY DUTY,  
RESTITUTION OR OTHERWISE) FOR ANY INJURY,  
DEATH, DAMAGE OR DIRECT, INDIRECT OR  
CONSEQUENTIAL LOSS (ALL THREE OF WHICH  
TERMS INCLUDE, WITHOUT LIMITATION, PURE  
ECONOMIC LOSS, LOSS OF PROFITS, LOSS OF  
BUSINESS, LOSS OF DATA, LOSS OF SAVINGS,  
DEPLETION OF GOODWILL AND LIKE LOSS)  
HOWSOEVER CAUSED ARISING OUT OF OR IN  
CONNECTION WITH:  
6. LIMITATION AND EXCLUSION OF  
LIABILITY  
6.1 Licensor does not exclude its liability (if any)  
to you:  
6.1.1 for personal injury or death resulting from  
Licensor's negligence;  
6.1.2 for fraud; or  
6.1.3 for any matter for which it would be illegal  
for Licensor to exclude or to attempt to exclude  
its liability.  
6.3.1 THE SOFTWARE, OR THE MANUFACTURE  
OR SALE OR SUPPLY, OR FAILURE OR DELAY IN  
SUPPLY, OF THE SOFTWARE BY LICENSOR OR ON  
THE PART OF LICENSOR'S EMPLOYEES, AGENTS  
OR SUB-CONTRACTORS;  
6.2 LICENSOR MAKES NO EXPRESS  
WARRANTIES WITH RESPECT TO THE SOFTWARE  
AND LICENSOR HEREBY EXCLUDES (TO THE  
FULLEST EXTENT PERMISSIBLE IN LAW), ALL  
CONDITIONS, WARRANTIES (INCLUDING  
WITHOUT LIMITATION ANY WARRANTY THAT THE  
SOFTWARE WILL MEET YOUR REQUIREMENTS  
OR THAT ITS OPERATION WILL BE  
6.3.2 ANY BREACH BY LICENSOR OF ANY OF  
THE EXPRESS OR IMPLIED TERMS OF THIS  
LICENSE;  
6.3.3 ANY USE MADE OF THE SOFTWARE; OR  
UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR FREE) AND  
STIPULATIONS, EXPRESS (OTHER THAN THOSE  
SET OUT IN THIS LICENSE) OR IMPLIED,  
STATUTORY, CUSTOMARY OR OTHERWISE  
6.3.4 ANY STATEMENT MADE OR NOT MADE, OR  
ADVICE GIVEN OR NOT GIVEN, BY OR ON BEHALF  
OF LICENSOR.  
Warranty Information  
257  
6.4 Disclaimer of Certain Damages. IN NO  
EVENT SHALL SAMSUNG BE LIABLE TO YOU OR  
ANY PARTY RELATED TO YOU FOR ANY INDIRECT,  
INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, SPECIAL,  
EXEMPLARY, OR PUNITIVE DAMAGES OR LOST  
PROFITS, EVEN IF SAMSUNG HAS BEEN ADVISED  
OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. THIS  
LIMITATION WILL APPLY REGARDLESS OF THE  
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER FRAUD,  
MISREPRESENTATION, BREACH OF CONTRACT,  
NEGILIGENCE, PERSONAL INJURY, PRODUCTS  
LIABILITY, INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY  
INFRINGEMENT, OR ANY OTHER THEORY  
REGARDLESS OF WHETHER OR NOT SAMSUNG  
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF  
SUCH DAMAGES. THIS MEANS THAT YOU WILL  
NOT SEEK, AND HEREBY WAIVE, ANY INDIRECT,  
SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, TREBLE, OR  
PUNITIVE DAMAGES FROM SAMSUNG. THIS  
LIMITATION AND WAIVER ALSO APPLIES TO ANY  
CLAIMS YOU MAY BRING AGAINST ANY OTHER  
PARTY TO THE EXTENT THAT SAMSUNG WOULD  
BE REQUIRED TO INDEMNIFY THAT PARTY FOR  
SUCH CLAIM.  
7. TERM AND TERMINATION  
7.1 This License shall commence upon the  
earlier of your acceptance of this License or your  
activation of the Software and shall continue  
until terminated in accordance with clause 7.2 or  
otherwise in accordance with this License.  
7.2 This License will terminate automatically if  
you fail to comply with any term or condition of  
this License or if you cease to use the Software  
for any reason.  
7.3 Upon termination of this License for any  
reason whatsoever Licensor retains the right to  
permanently disable your access to the  
Software.  
7.4 The termination of this License howsoever  
arising is without prejudice to the rights, duties  
and liabilities of either party accrued prior to  
termination. Clauses 2.2, 2.3, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7.3, 8,  
9 and 10 of this License will continue to be  
enforceable notwithstanding termination.  
8. GOVERNING LAW AND  
JURISDICTION  
8.1 The formation, existence, construction,  
performance, validity and all aspects whatsoever  
of this License or of any term of this License will  
be governed by the laws of the State of New  
York.  
6.5 You acknowledge that the above provisions  
of this clause 6 are reasonable for the Software  
and you will accept such risk and/or insure  
accordingly.  
6.6 Any rights that you have as a consumer are  
not affected by this clause 6.  
258  
8.2 The courts in New York City will have non-  
exclusive jurisdiction to settle any disputes  
which may arise out of or in connection with this  
License. The parties irrevocably agree to submit  
to that jurisdiction.  
10.2 No failure or delay by any party to exercise  
any right, power or remedy will operate as a  
waiver of it nor will any partial exercise preclude  
any further exercise of the same, or of some  
other right, power or remedy.  
10.3 The parties to this License do not intend  
that any of its terms will be enforceable by any  
person not a party to it.  
9. COMPLIANCE WITH APPLICABLE  
LAW  
You acknowledge and agree that  
10.4 This License contains all the terms which  
the parties have agreed in relation to the subject  
matter of this License and supersedes any prior  
written or oral agreements, representations or  
understandings between the parties in relation to  
such subject matter.  
notwithstanding the fact that this License is  
governed by the laws of the Republic of Korea,  
you may be subject to additional laws in other  
jurisdictions with respect to your use of the  
Software. You will comply with the laws of any  
jurisdiction that apply to the Software, including  
without limitation any applicable export laws or  
regulations.  
10.5 Licensor reserves the right to revise the  
terms of this License by updating the License on  
its web site, or by notifying you by post or by  
e-mail. You are advised to check the Licensor's  
website periodically for notices concerning  
revisions. Your continued use of the Software  
shall be deemed to constitute acceptance of any  
revised terms.  
10.GENERAL  
10.1 If any clause or part of this License is found  
by any court, tribunal, administrative body or  
authority of competent jurisdiction to be illegal,  
invalid or unenforceable then that provision will,  
to the extent required, be severed from this  
License and will be ineffective without, as far as  
is possible, modifying any other clause or part of  
this License and this will not affect any other  
provisions of this License which will remain in  
full force and effect.  
10.6 You will be deemed to have accepted the  
terms of this License by using the Software on  
any device.  
Warranty Information  
259  
Index  
Alarm Tone  
Set as 128  
Numerics  
2G Network  
Using 188  
3 Sec Pause  
Adding 54  
3G Network 188  
Using 188  
411 & More 132  
4G Network 188  
Using 188  
Alerts on Call 190  
AllShare  
Configuring Settings 133  
Receiving Media 133  
Transmitting Media 133  
Answer Vibration 190  
Answering a call 55  
Answering Key 190  
Application cache and data  
Clearing 145  
Application Menus  
Navigating through 33  
Applications 35  
411 & More 35  
Accounts and Sync 35  
AllShare 35  
Android Market 39, 143  
Bejeweled 2 35  
Blio 36  
A
Accesibility  
Activation 70  
Accessing  
Recently-used applications 34  
Voice mail 17  
Accounts 132  
Accounts and Sync 132  
Adding Contacts 92  
Add 3 Sec Pause 57  
Add to Favorites 97  
Adjusting  
Call volume 61  
Adobe PDF 154  
Alarm  
Bonus Apps 36  
Browser 160  
Calculator 36, 135  
Calendar 36  
Camera 36, 136  
Clock 37  
Contacts 37  
Setting 180  
Turning Off 181  
Downloads 37  
260  
   
Email 37, 137  
Files 37  
Gallery 37  
Google Books 36  
Google Mail 37, 137  
Google Maps 38, 141  
Google Search 37  
Highlight 38  
T-Mobile TV HD 41  
Using the Camcorder 121  
Using the Camera 115  
Video Chat 42  
Video Player 159  
Videos 42  
Visual Voicemail 42  
Voice Recorder 42, 159  
Voice Search 42, 159  
Web 42  
Kies air 38  
Latitude 38  
Lookout Anti-Virus 38  
Media Hub 39  
Memo 39, 146  
Messaging 39  
messaging 146  
More for Me 39  
Music 39  
Wi-Fi Calling 42  
Yelp 43, 160  
YouTube 43, 160  
Zinio Reader 43  
Applications and Development 132  
Auto Redial 191  
Auto Reject  
My Device 40  
Navigation 40  
News & Weather 40  
Places 40  
Configuration 55  
Auto Reject Mode 189  
Automatic Answering 190  
Auto-sync  
Polaris Office 40  
Settings 40  
Slacker 40  
Social Hub 41  
Task 41  
Task Manager 41  
TeleNav GPS 41, 157  
Tetris 42  
Enabling 203  
B
Back up  
My Data 205  
Background Color  
Text Messages 102  
Backup and Restore 205  
Battery  
T-Mobile Mall 41  
T-Mobile Name ID 41  
Charging 11  
Extending Life 13  
261  
Installing 11  
Low Battery Indicator 13  
Removal 11  
Saving Power 14  
Wall Charger 11  
Battery Cover  
Sending Contacts Via 171  
Sending Namecard 90  
Set Visibility 169  
Settings 168  
Status indicators 168  
Switching to Headset during call 62  
Turning on and off 168  
Visibility 185  
Removal 7  
Replace 8  
Battery Life  
Extending 13  
Bonus Apps 134  
Books 134  
Battery Usage 202  
Battery Use & Safety 220  
Bing  
Browser  
Adding bookmarks 165  
Deleting bookmarks 165  
Emptying cookies 165  
Entering a URL 163  
Navigation 162  
Set Search Engine 167  
Black List 56, 67  
Adding 56, 87  
Blio 134  
Options 162  
Block List 67  
Bluetooth 184  
Search Engine 167  
Settings 166  
About 168  
Bubble  
Activation 184  
Options 101  
Change Name 169  
Deleting a Paired Device 170  
Device Name 185  
Disable 168  
Disconnecting a Paired Device 170  
Enable 168  
Paring Devices 169  
Scan for Devices 169  
Scanning for other Devices 185  
Sending Contact Information 171  
C
Calculator  
Scientific Functions 135  
Calendar 179  
Creating an event 179  
Manually Sync Events 136  
Settings 179  
262  
Calibration 195  
Call Alert 190  
Camcorder 121  
Accessing the Video Folder 123  
Options 122  
Shooting Video 121  
Camera 115  
Camera Options 116  
Options 116  
Taking Pictures 115  
Care and Maintenance 226  
Charging battery 11  
Children and Cell Phones 216  
Clearing  
Application cache and data 145  
Configuration  
Initial 14  
Call Answering/Ending 190  
Call Barring 191  
Call Forwarding 190  
Configuring 190  
Call Functions 52  
Answering 55  
Ending 52  
Ending a Call 52  
Ending via Status Bar 53  
Making a Multi-Party Call 63  
Pause Dialing 56  
Redialing the last number 57  
Wait dialing 57  
Call Rejection 55, 189  
Call Settings 189  
Additional Settings 191  
General 189  
Connections  
Accessing the Internet 162  
Contact Entry  
Options 87  
Call Status Tones 190  
Call Volume  
Contact List  
Options 85  
Adjusting 61  
Contact Menus  
Call Waiting 65, 191  
Options 86  
Contacts  
Caller ID 191  
Caller Ringtone  
Set as 128  
Calls  
Adding a Number to Existing 85  
Adding Your Facebook Friends 93  
Additional Options 94  
As a default 89  
Making a 52  
Multi-party 63  
Black List 87  
Muting 62  
Copying 91  
Copying to microSD Card 91  
263  
Copying to SIM Card 91  
Creating a New 80  
Default Storage Location 95  
Deleting 85  
Customizing  
Home screens 43  
D
Data Roaming 187  
Display Options 92  
Displaying Contacts by Name 92  
Export List to microSD 172, 205  
Family Name First 92  
Filtering 92  
Given Name First 92  
Groups 95  
Joining 88  
Activate/Deactivate 187  
Deleting  
Message Thread 101  
Multiple messages 101  
Single message 101  
Deleting a contact 85  
Desk Clock  
Configuring 182  
Merge with Google 86  
New From Keypad 82  
Send Namecard Via 87  
Sending 90  
Sending All 90  
Setting Default Location 86  
Settings 94  
Contacts List 52  
Context Menus 84, 86  
Navigation 34  
Using 34  
Cookies  
Display  
Icons 23  
Settings 23  
Status Bar 23  
Display / Touch-Screen 223  
Displaying your phone number 52  
Do cell phones pose a health hazard? 213  
Downloading  
New application 143  
Downloads 136  
Internet Downloads 136  
Other Downloads 136  
E
EDGE Network 188  
Email 104  
Emptying 165  
Corporate Email  
Account Syncronization 204  
Add Account 204  
Creating a Playlist 129  
Creating and sending  
Messages 98  
Composing 106  
Configuring Settings 106  
Creating an Internet Account 104  
Internet Email 104  
264  
Opening 105  
Factory data reset 51  
Favorites Tab 97  
FCC Hearing Aid Compatibility (HAC)  
Regulations for Wireless Devices 230  
FCC Notice and Cautions 232  
Fixed Dialing Numbers 191  
Folder  
Opening Internet Email 105  
Out of Office Settings 111  
Refreshing Messages 105  
Sending 94  
Emergency Calls 225  
Making 53  
With SIM 53  
Without SIM 53  
Creating and Managing 48  
Deleting 48  
Emoticons 99  
Renaming 48  
Ending  
Font  
A call 52  
Style 194  
Entering Text 69  
Font Size  
Using SWYPE 70  
Caption 160  
Erasing files from  
Memory card 51  
Text Messages 102  
Freezing 22  
Event Notifications 195  
Exchange Email 107  
Account Setup 107  
Composing 109  
Configuring Settings 110  
Deleting Message 110  
Opening 109  
Refreshing Messages 109  
Exposure to Radio Frequency (RF) Signals 213  
F
Facebook  
G
Gallery  
Folder Options 119  
Image Options 119  
Opening 125  
Getting Started 6  
Battery 11  
Battery Cover 7  
Locking/Unlocking the Phone 15  
microSD card 10  
SIM Card 9  
Adding Contacts From 93  
Video Chat 158  
Switching Phone On/Off 15  
Voice Mail 17  
Factory Data Reset 205  
Prior To 205  
265  
Getting the Fastest Connection 188  
Gmail 111, 137  
Editing a Caller Group 96  
Removing an Entry 95  
Settings 96  
Composing a message 112  
Creating and Additional Account 113  
Opening 112  
GSM 188  
H
Health and Safety Information 213  
Hearing Aids 190  
Highlight  
Refreshing 112  
Signing In 111  
Viewing 112  
Google  
Settings 138  
Account Management Settings 204  
Account Syncronization 203  
Add Account 203  
Adding a Sync Account 203  
Create New Account 16  
Merge Contacts 86  
Hold  
Placing a call on hold 62  
Home 29  
Home Key 28  
Home Screen  
Overview 29  
Retrieving Password 17  
Set Search Engine 167  
Signing into Your Account 16  
Google Books 134  
Google mail  
see also Gmail 112  
Google Maps  
Enabling a location source 141  
Opening a map 142  
Wallpaper 194  
Home screens  
Customizing 43  
Homepage 162  
Horizontal Calibration 195  
HSPA+ 176, 185  
I
Icons  
Description 23  
Indicator 23  
Status 23  
Google Talk 41, 156  
GPS & AGPS 224  
Groups  
Images  
Adding an Member to an Existing Group 95  
Creating a new caller group 95  
Deleting 96  
Assigning as a Contact icon 120  
Assigning as wallpaper 121  
Transferring 172, 205  
Verifying 172, 205  
Deleting a Caller Group 96  
266  
Importing and Exporting  
To SIM card 94  
Accessing from Notifications 66  
Altering Numbers 68  
In call  
Erasing 68  
Options 61, 63  
Incoming Call Volume  
Setting 193  
Low battery indicator 13  
M
Making  
Indicator icons 23  
International Call 56  
International calls  
Making 56  
Internet 162  
Search 163  
Internet Call 82  
Internet Downloads 136  
Internet Email 104  
Emergency Calls 53  
International calls 56  
New call 52  
Manage Conference Call 64  
Managing Applications 200  
Clearing Application Cache 200  
Moving Third-party Applications to Card 201  
Uninstalling Third-party Applications 201  
Market 143  
J
Media Hub 125, 145  
Creating a New Account 126  
Using 126  
Joining  
Contact information 88  
Media Volume  
Setting 193  
K
Kies Air  
Before Using 172  
Kies air 138  
L
LinkedIn  
Adding Contacts From 93  
Live Wallpapers 194  
Lock Screen  
Memo  
Options 146  
Memory card  
Erasing files from the 51  
Memory Usage 202  
Merge Calls 63  
Merge with Google 86  
Message  
Viewing Missed Calls 68  
Wallpaper 195  
Logs 65  
Options 99  
Read 100  
Reply 100  
Accessing 65  
267  
Thread Options 100  
Threads 100  
Mobile NetworksUse Packet Data 187  
Mobile Web 162  
Message Search 102  
Message threads 100  
Messaging  
Creating and sending 98  
Creating and Sending Text Messages 98  
Deleting a message 101  
Google Mail 111  
Icons on the Status Bar 98  
Insert Smiley 99  
Options 99  
Entering Text in the Mobile Web Browser 163  
Navigating with the Mobile Web 162  
Using Bookmarks 164  
Motion Settings 204  
Mounting the SD card 50  
Move to SD card 201  
Multi-Party Call 63  
Dropping One Participant 64  
Private conversation 64  
Multi-party call  
Settings 102  
Setting up 63  
Signing into Google Mail 111  
Text Templates 103  
Types of Messages 98  
Viewing new 100  
microSD Card  
Insertion 10  
Multi-party calls 63  
Music 148  
Adding Music 129  
Creating a Playlist 129  
Editing a Playlist 130  
Making a Song a Ringtone 128  
Options 128  
Removal 10  
Microsoft Exchange 81, 104  
Player 127  
Playing Music 127  
Mini Diary  
Deleting an entry 147  
Options 147  
Removing Music 129  
Using Playlists 129  
Settings 147  
Music Files  
Missed Call  
Removing 130  
Viewing from Lock Screen 68  
Mobile Networks 187  
Data Roaming 187  
Transferring 130  
My Profile 94  
268  
Other Downloads 136  
Other Important Safety Information 232  
Outgoing Call Vibration 190  
Outlook 104  
Synchronizing 204  
Overview  
N
Namecard  
Send Via 90  
Sending 90  
Sending All 90  
Navigating  
Home Screen 29  
Application Menus 33  
Sub-Menus 34  
P
Pause Dialing 56  
People  
Video Chat 158  
Phone  
Through Screens 31  
Network connection  
Adding a new 175  
Network Mode  
2G Network 188  
Icons 23  
3G Network 188  
Switching on/off 15  
Phone number  
Finding 52  
Phone Options 193  
Phone Ringtone 194  
Set as 128  
New applications  
Downloading 143  
News & Weather 153  
Non-Market Applications 145  
Notification Bar 27  
Using 27  
Photos  
Notification Volume  
Setting 193  
Options 118, 119  
Sharing 118, 119  
Pico TTS 210  
Polaris Office 154  
Power Control 14  
Power Saving Mode 196  
Activate 196  
O
On/Off Switch 15  
Operating Environment 228  
Organizer  
Calculator 135  
Additional Parameters 196  
Setting Launch Levels 196  
Power Savings 14  
World Clock 181  
269  
Predictive Text  
Using XT9 78  
Ringtone  
Phone 194  
Predictive text  
Using XT9 77  
S
Samsung Keyboard  
Primary Shortcuts 30  
Adding and Deleting 44  
Proximity Sensor  
Activation 190  
Settings 208  
XT9 Advanced Settings 208  
Samsung Keypad 74  
ABC Mode 76  
Q
Changing the Input Type 75  
Enabling 74  
Quick Dialing 52  
Entering Symbols 77  
Symbol/Numeric Mode 76  
Samsung Mobile Products and Recycling 222  
Save a Number  
From Keypad 82  
Screen  
Home 29  
Navigation 31  
Screen Lock  
Changing 198  
R
Recently-used Applications  
Accessing 34  
Redialing the last number 57  
Reducing Exposure  
Hands-Free Kits and Other Accessories 215  
Reject Call  
Rejection Messages 190  
Reject Calls  
Managing 55  
Set Up 197  
Reject List 67, 190  
Screen Rotation  
Auto-Rotate 195  
Screen Timeout 195  
Screens  
Adding and Deleting 43  
Customizing 43  
Rearranging 44  
SD card  
Connecting to 50  
Mounting the 50  
Rejection List  
Assigning Multiple Numbers 56  
Assigning Single Numbers 56  
Rejection Messages 190  
Reset 205  
Device 22  
Responsible Listening 226  
Restore 205  
Restricting Children's Access to Your Mobile  
device 231  
270  
Unmounting 50  
Search Engine 167  
Select Language 207  
Sending a Namecard 90  
Set as  
Insertion 9  
Lock 199  
Removal 9  
SIM Card Lock  
Setting Up 199  
Contact icon 119  
Smart Practices While Driving 219  
Snooze 181  
SNS 92  
SNS Friends  
Viewing 86  
Home Screen Wallpaper 119  
Lock Screen Wallpaper 119  
Setting an alarm 180  
Setting up  
Voicemail 17  
Settings 183  
Browser 166  
Contact list 94  
Social Hub 243  
Social Network  
Adding Facebook Contacts 93  
Resync 93  
Display 23  
Social Networking  
Adding Contacts From 92  
Song  
Set as 128  
Speakerphone  
Enabling the GPS Satellites 197  
Enabling the sensor aiding 197  
Enabling wireless network locations 197  
Messaging 102  
Mini Diary 147  
Setup  
Initial 14  
Shortcuts  
Turning on and off 62  
Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) Certification  
Information 217  
Speed Dial  
Adding from Application Screen 45  
Adding from Home Screen 46  
Deleting from a Screen 46  
Managing 45  
Primary 30  
SIM Card  
Changing an entry 58  
Making a call 59  
Removing an entry 58  
Setting up entries 58  
Standard Limited Warranty 234  
Status Bar 23  
Changing Exisitng PIN 199  
Importing and Exporting 94  
Sub-Menus  
Navigation 34  
271  
Switching to a Bluetooth  
During a call 62  
SWYPE  
T-Mobile Contacts Backup 81  
T-Mobile Mall 155  
Tools  
123ABC Mode 73  
Swype  
Advanced Settings 70, 207  
Entering Text 70  
Help 208  
Camera 115  
Transferring Music Files 130  
Twitter  
Video Chat 158  
U
UL Certified Travel Charger 223  
Understanding Your Phone 20  
Back View 22  
Settings 70, 207  
Tutorial 208  
System Volume  
Setting 193  
Display 23  
T
Task 156  
Features 20  
Front View 21  
Tethering 176, 185  
Home 29  
Uninstalling  
Activating 176  
Active Icon 176  
Disconnecting 176  
Text Input  
Third-party applications 145  
Unknown Sources 145  
Unmounting  
Methods 69  
SD card 50  
Text Input Method  
Selecting 69  
Usage  
Battery 202  
Text Templates 103  
Create Your Own 103  
Text-to-speech  
Configuration 210  
Third-Party Applications 201  
Uninstalling 145  
Time Management  
Calendar 179  
Memory 202  
USB Connections  
As mass storage device 172  
USB Settings  
As mass storage device 172  
272  
Use GPS Satellites 141, 197  
Use Packet Data 187  
Use Sensor Aiding 141, 197  
Use Wireless Networks 141, 197  
Using Favorites  
Adding Favorites 165  
Deleting a Favorite 165  
Editing Favorites 165  
W
Wait 57  
Wait dialing 57  
Wallpapers  
Changing 48  
Managing 48  
Warranty Information 234  
WCDMA 188  
V
Vibration 193  
Web 162  
History 166  
Setup 193  
Web applications  
enable downloading 171  
Widget  
Power Savings 14  
Widgets  
Video Chat 158  
Recording Video 158  
Settings 158  
Video Conference 113  
Videos  
Adding and Removing 46  
Google Talk 41  
Options 118  
Voice Input Recognition 209  
Voice mail  
Accessing 17  
Mini Diary 39  
Moving to a Different Screen 47  
My Account 39  
Accessing from another phone 18  
Setting up 17  
Settings 40, 154  
Stopwatch 182  
Voice Output  
Wi-Fi  
Configuring 210  
Voicemail 192  
Volume Settings  
Adjusting 193  
VPN  
Adding 186  
About 174  
Activating 59, 174, 183  
Advanced settings 175  
Connecting to 174  
Deactivating 175  
Manually Adding Network 184  
Manually scan for network 175  
Settings 183  
Settings 186  
273  
Status icons 175  
WPS Button 184  
Wi-Fi Hotspot 176  
Activating 177  
Connecting 177  
Securing 178  
World Clock  
DST Settings 181  
WPA2 PSK 178  
Y
Z
Yahoo! 167  
YouTube  
High Qulaity 131  
Settings 160  
Video Chat 158  
Zinio Reader 161  
274  

Windmere WCM2025C User Manual
Wadia Digital 581 User Manual
Toshiba W7 User Manual
Seagate ST315005EXM101 RK User Manual
Seagate Constellation ST500NM0001 User Manual
Scotts CD Player SMV300 User Manual
Samsung SGH A767LBAATT User Manual
Pioneer DEH 24UB User Manual
Philips CDR 786 User Manual
Panasonic MN101C00 User Manual